Product Folder Order Now Technical Documents Tools & Software Support & Community DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DM505 SoC for Vision Analytics 15mm Package (ABF) Silicon Revision 2.0 1 Device Overview 1.1 Features 1 • Architecture Designed for Vision Analytics Applications • Video and Image Processing Support – Full-HD Video (1920 × 1080p, 60 fps) – Video Input and Video Output • Up to 2 C66x Floating-Point VLIW DSP – Fully Object-Code Compatible With C67x and C64x+ – Up to Thirty-two 16 × 16-Bit Fixed-Point Multiplies per Cycle • Up to 512kB of On-Chip L3 RAM • Level 3 (L3) and Level 4 (L4) Interconnects • Memory Interface (EMIF) Module – Supports DDR3/DDR3L up to DDR-1066 – Supports DDR2 up to DDR-800 – Supports LPDDR2 up to DDR-667 – Up to 2GB Supported • Dual ARM® Cortex®-M4 Image Processor (IPU) • Vision AccelerationPac – Embedded Vision Engine (EVE) • Display Subsystem – Display Controller With DMA Engine – CVIDEO / SD-DAC TV Analog Composite Output • Video Input Port (VIP) Module – Support for up to 4 Multiplexed Input Ports • On-chip Temperature Sensor That is Capable of Generating Temperature Alerts • General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) • Enhanced Direct Memory Access (EDMA) Controller • 3-Port (2 External) Gigabit Ethernet (GMAC) Switch • Controller Area Network (DCAN) Module – CAN 2.0B Protocol • Modular Controller Area Network (MCAN) Module – CAN 2.0B Protocol • Eight 32-Bit General-Purpose Timers • Three Configurable UART Modules • Four Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interfaces (McSPI) • Quad SPI Interface • Two Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Ports • Three Multichannel Audio Serial Ports (McASP) Modules • MultiMedia Card/Secure Digital/Secure Digital Input Output Interface (MMC/SD/SDIO) • Up to 126 General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) Pins • Power, Reset, and Clock Management • On-Chip Debug With CTools Technology • Automotive AEC-Q100 Qualified • 15 × 15mm, 0.65-mm Pitch, 367-Pin PBGA (ABF) • 8-Channel 10-bit ADC • MIPI CSI-2 Camera Serial Interface • PWMSS • Full HW Image Pipe: DPC, CFA, 3D-NF, RGBYUV – WDR, HW LDC and Perspective 1 An IMPORTANT NOTICE at the end of this data sheet addresses availability, warranty, changes, use in safety-critical applications, intellectual property matters and other important disclaimers. PRODUCTION DATA. DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 1.2 • • Applications Drones Robotics 1.3 www.ti.com • • Industrial Transportation (Forklift, Rail, Agriculture) Factory and Building Automation cameras Description The DM505 is a highly optimized device for Vision Analytics and Machine Vision processing in Industrial products such as drones, robots, forklifts, railroad and agriculture equipment. The Processor enables sophisticated embedded vision processing integrating an optimal mix of real time performance, low power, small form factor and camera processing for systems to interact in more intelligent, useful ways with the physical world and the people in it. The DM505 incorporates a heterogeneous, scalable architecture that includes a mix of TI’s fixed and floating-point TMS320C66x digital signal processor (DSP) generation cores, Vision AccelerationPac (EVE), and dual-Cortex-M4 processors. The device allows low power designs to meet demanding embedded system budgets without sacrificing real-time processing performance to enable small form factor designs. The DM505 also integrates a host of peripherals including interfaces for multi-camera input (both parallel and serial), display outputs, audio and serial I/O, CAN and GigB Ethernet AVB. TI provides application specific hardware and software through our Design Network Partners and a complete set of development tools for the ARM, and DSP, including C compilers with TI RTOS to accelerate time to market. Device Information 2 PART NUMBER PACKAGE BODY SIZE DM505 S-PBGA (367) 15.0 mm × 15.0 mm Device Overview Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 1.4 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Functional Block Diagram Figure 1-1 is functional block diagram of the superset. IPU with ECC DSP Subsystem x2 Dual Cortex M4 32KB ROM L1P 32KB L2 256KB Cache C66x L1D 32KB EDMA 2TC Display Subsystem Vision Accelerator DVOUT EVE 16MAC SD-DAC EDMA 2TC Video Front End up to 512KB RAM with ECC Video Input Port CAL LVDSRX CSI2 ISP OSD Resizing CSC Interconnect DM505 System Connectivity GMAC Serial Interfaces I2C x2 McASP x3 SPI x4 UART x3 QSPI x1 DCAN with ECC SDIO x1 MCAN(CAN-FD) with ECC EDMA Timer x8 GPIO x4 Mailbox/Spinlock PWMSSx1 10-bit ADC MMUx1 Control Module JTAG PLLs PRCM OSC Memory Controllers GPMC 8b/16b with up to 16b ECC LPDDR2 / DDR2/ DDR3 / DDR3L 32b with 8b ECC SPRS916_Intro_001 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Figure 1-1. DM505 Block Diagram Device Overview Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 3 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table of Contents 1 Device Overview ......................................... 1 6.6 Memory Subsystem ................................ 184 ............................................. 1 1.2 Applications ........................................... 2 1.3 Description ............................................ 2 1.4 Functional Block Diagram ........................... 3 Revision History ......................................... 5 Device Comparison ..................................... 6 3.1 Device Comparison Table ............................ 6 Terminal Configuration and Functions .............. 8 4.1 Pin Diagram .......................................... 8 4.2 Pin Attributes ......................................... 8 4.3 Signal Descriptions .................................. 39 4.4 Pin Multiplexing ..................................... 65 4.5 Connections for Unused Pins ....................... 76 Specifications ........................................... 77 5.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ......................... 77 5.2 ESD Ratings ........................................ 78 5.3 Power on Hour (POH) Limits........................ 78 5.4 Recommended Operating Conditions ............... 79 5.5 Operating Performance Points ...................... 81 5.6 Power Consumption Summary...................... 90 5.7 Electrical Characteristics ............................ 90 5.8 Thermal Characteristics ............................. 96 6.7 Interprocessor Communication 6.8 Interrupt Controller ................................. 188 1.1 2 3 4 5 6.9 EDMA .............................................. 188 6.10 Peripherals ......................................... 190 6.11 On-Chip Debug .................................... 202 Applications, Implementation, and Layout ...... 206 ........................................ 7.1 Introduction 7.2 Power Optimizations ............................... 207 7.3 Core Power Domains .............................. 218 7.4 Single-Ended Interfaces 7.5 Differential Interfaces 7.6 7.7 7.8 7.9 7.10 8 187 ........................... .............................. Clock Routing Guidelines .......................... LPDDR2 Board Design and Layout Guidelines.... DDR2 Board Design and Layout Guidelines....... DDR3 Board Design and Layout Guidelines....... 206 227 230 232 233 242 254 CVIDEO/SD-DAC Guidelines and Electrical Data/Timing ........................................ 277 Device and Documentation Support .............. 279 Device Nomenclature .............................. 279 8.2 Tools and Software ................................ 281 8.3 Documentation Support ............................ 281 8.4 Receiving Notification of Documentation Updates. 282 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics....................................... 98 8.5 Community Resources............................. 282 8.6 Trademarks ........................................ 282 Detailed Description.................................. 175 8.7 Electrostatic Discharge Caution 6.1 Description ......................................... 175 8.8 Export Control Notice .............................. 283 6.2 Functional Block Diagram 175 8.9 Glossary............................................ 283 6.3 DSP Subsystem 176 6.4 6.5 4 7 .................... 8.1 5.9 6 Features ......................... ................................... IPU ................................................. EVE ................................................ 181 9 ................... 283 Mechanical Packaging Information ............... 284 9.1 Mechanical Data ................................... 284 182 Table of Contents Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 2 Revision History Changes from May 6, 2017 to July 30, 2017 (from C Revision (May 2017) to D Revision) • • • • • • • • • Page Removed Safety IP information from Section 1.1, Figure 1-1 and Table 3-1 ................................................. 1 Updated descriptions for balls with single muxmode in Table 4-1 ............................................................ 10 Removed Safety IP information from Table 4-1, Table 4-26 and Table 4-28 ............................................... 10 Updated Voltage Domains Values Operating Performance Points in Table 5-3 ........................................... 81 Updated Source Clock Names for McASP in Table 5-5 ....................................................................... 82 Removed Safety IP information from Table 5-5 and Section 6.2 ............................................................. 82 Removed DPLLs Type A and Type B references from Section 5.9.4.3.1 .................................................. 109 Removed McASP AHCLKR references from Section 5.9.6.12 .............................................................. 154 Updated McASP Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics tables in Section 5.9.6.12 ..................... 154 Revision History Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 5 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 3 Device Comparison 3.1 Device Comparison Table Table 3-1 shows a comparison between devices, highlighting the differences. Table 3-1. Device Comparison Features Device DM505M DM505L 156 (0x9C65) 156 (0x9C5D) Features CTRL_WKUP_STD_FUSE_DIE_ID_2 [31:24] Base PN register bitfield value(3) Processors/ Accelerators Speed Grades C66x™ VLIW DSP Display Subsystem R R DSP1 Yes Yes DSP2 Yes No VOUT1 Yes Yes SD_DAC Yes Yes Embedded Vision Engine (EVE) EVE1 Yes Yes ARM Dual Cortex-M4 Image Processing Unit (IPU) IPU1 Yes Yes Imaging Subsystem Processor (ISS) with MIPI CSI-2 and CPI ports ISP Yes Yes WDR & Mesh LDC Yes Yes CAL_A Yes Yes CAL_B Yes Yes LVDS-RX Yes Yes CPI Yes Yes vin1a Yes Yes vin1b Yes Yes vin2a Yes Yes vin2b Yes Yes 512kB 256kB Yes Yes up to 2GB up to 2GB Yes Yes Video Input Port (VIP) VIP1 (1) Program/Data Storage On-Chip Shared Memory (RAM) OCMC_RAM1 General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) GPMC LPDDR2/DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller EMIF1 (optional with SECDED) Peripherals Controller Area Network Interface (CAN) DCAN1 MCAN Yes (2) Yes(2) Enhanced DMA (EDMA) EDMA Yes Yes Embedded 8 channel ADC ADC Yes Yes Ethernet Subsystem (Ethernet SS) GMAC_SW[0] RGMII Only RGMII Only GMAC_SW[1] RGMII Only RGMII Only Up to 126 Up to 126 2 2 General-Purpose IO (GPIO) GPIO Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface (I2C) I2C System Mailbox Module MAILBOX 2 2 Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) McASP1 16 serializers 16 serializers McASP2 6 serializers 6 serializers McASP3 6 serializers 6 serializers 6 Device Comparison Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 3-1. Device Comparison (continued) Features Device DM505M DM505L MultiMedia Card/Secure Digital/Secure Digital Input Output Interface (MMC/SD/SDIO) MMC 1x SDIO 4b 1x SDIO 4b Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (McSPI) McSPI 4 4 Quad SPI (QSPI) QSPI Yes Yes Spinlock Module SPINLOCK Yes Yes Timers, General-Purpose TIMER Pulse-Width Modulation Subsystem (PWMSS) PWMSS1 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) UART 8 8 Yes Yes 3 3 (1) Wide Dynamic Range and Lens Distortion Correction. (2) Device supports FD (Flexible Data Rate) (3) For more details about the CTRL_WKUP_STD_FUSE_DIE_ID_2 register and Base PN bitfield, see the DM50x Technical Reference Manual. Device Comparison Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 7 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 4 Terminal Configuration and Functions 4.1 Pin Diagram Figure 4-1 shows the ball locations for the 367 plastic ball grid array (PBGA) package and are used in conjunction with Table 4-1 through Table 4-27 to locate signal names and ball grid numbers. AB AA Y W V U T R P N M L K J H G F E D C B A 1 5 3 2 4 9 7 6 8 11 13 15 17 19 21 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 SPRS916_BALL_01 Figure 4-1. ABF S-PBGA-N367 Package (Bottom View) NOTE The following bottom balls are not connected: C4 / C7 / C9 / C11 / C13 / C15 / C19 / D4 / D5 / D9 / D11 / D13 / D17 / D18 / D19 / D20 / E4 / E5 / E6 / E9 / E11 / E13 / E15 / E18 / E19 / F5 / F9 / F11 / F18 / G13 / G15 / G17 / G20 / H3 / H4 / H5 / H6 / J8 / J9 / J12 / J13 / J14 / J18 / J19 / J20 / K3 / K4 / K5 / K6 / L9 / L10 / L11 / L13 / L14 / L17 / L18 / L19 / L20 / M3 / M4 / M5 / M6 / N9 / N11 / N13 / N14 / N17 / N18 / N19 / N20 / P3 / P4 / P5 / P6 / R8 / R10 / R11 / R13 / R14 / R15 / R17 / R18 / R19 / R20 / T3 / T6 / U5 / U10 / U12 / U14 / U18 / V4 / V5 / V6 / V8 / V10 / V12 / V14 / V17 / V18 / V19 / W3 / W4 / W5 / W10 / W12 / W14 / W18 / W19 / W20 / Y4 / Y7 / Y10 / Y12 / Y14 / Y16 / Y19. These balls do not exist on the package. 4.2 Pin Attributes Table 4-1 describes the terminal characteristics and the signals multiplexed on each ball. The following list describes the table column headers: 1. BALL NUMBER: Ball number(s) on the bottom side associated with each signal on the bottom. 2. BALL NAME: Mechanical name from package device (name is taken from muxmode 0). 3. SIGNAL NAME: Names of signals multiplexed on each ball (also notice that the name of the ball is the signal name in muxmode 0). NOTE Table 4-1 does not take into account the subsystem multiplexing signals. Subsystem multiplexing signals are described in Section 4.3, Signal Descriptions. NOTE In the Driver off mode, the buffer is configured in high-impedance. 8 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 4. MUXMODE: Multiplexing mode number: (a) MUXMODE 0 is the primary mode; this means that when MUXMODE=0 is set, the function mapped on the pin corresponds to the name of the pin. The primary muxmode is not necessarily the default muxmode. NOTE The default mode is the mode at the release of the reset; also see the RESET REL. MUXMODE column. (b) MUXMODE 1 through 15 are possible muxmodes for alternate functions. On each pin, some muxmodes are effectively used for alternate functions, while some muxmodes are not used. Only MUXMODE values which correspond to defined functions should be used. 5. TYPE: Signal type and direction: – I = Input – O = Output – IO = Input or Output – D = Open drain – DS = Differential Signaling – A = Analog – PWR = Power – GND = Ground – CAP = LDO Capacitor 6. BALL RESET STATE: The state of the terminal at power-on reset: – drive 0 (OFF): The buffer drives VOL (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – drive 1 (OFF): The buffer drives VOH (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – OFF: High-impedance – PD: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor – PU: High-impedance with an active pullup resistor 7. BALL RESET REL. STATE: The state of the terminal at the deactivation of the rstoutn signal (also mapped to the PRCM SYS_WARM_OUT_RST signal). – drive 0 (OFF): The buffer drives VOL (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – drive clk (OFF): The buffer drives a toggling clock (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – drive 1 (OFF): The buffer drives VOH (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – OFF: High-impedance – PD: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor – PU: High-impedance with an active pullup resistor NOTE For more information on the CORE_PWRON_RET_RST reset signal and its reset sources, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management / Reset Management Functional Description section of the Device TRM. 8. BALL RESET REL. MUXMODE: This muxmode is automatically configured at the release of the rstoutn signal (also mapped to the PRCM SYS_WARM_OUT_RST signal). 9. IO VOLTAGE VALUE: This column describes the IO voltage value (the corresponding power supply). 10. POWER: The voltage supply that powers the terminal IO buffers. 11. HYS: Indicates if the input buffer is with hysteresis: – Yes: With hysteresis – No: Without hysteresis An empty box means "Yes". Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 9 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com NOTE For more information, see the hysteresis values in Section 5.7, DC Electrical Characteristics. 12. BUFFER TYPE: Drive strength of the associated output buffer. NOTE For programmable buffer strength: – The default value is given in Table 4-1. – A note describes all possible values according to the selected muxmode. 13. PULL UP / DOWN TYPE: Denotes the presence of an internal pullup or pulldown resistor. Pullup and pulldown resistors can be enabled or disabled via software. 14. DSIS: The deselected input state (DSIS) indicates the state driven on the peripheral input (logic "0" or logic "1") when the peripheral pin function is not selected by any of the CTRL_CORE_PADx registers. – 0: Logic 0 driven on the peripheral's input signal port. – 1: Logic 1 driven on the peripheral's input signal port. – blank: Pin state driven on the peripheral's input signal port. NOTE Configuring two pins to the same input signal is not supported as it can yield unexpected results. This can be easily prevented with the proper software configuration (Hi-Z mode is not an input signal). NOTE When a pad is set into a multiplexing mode which is not defined by pin multiplexing, that pad’s behavior is undefined. This should be avoided. 10 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] POWER [10] HYS [11] BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] M19 adc_in0 adc_in0 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA M20 adc_in1 adc_in1 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA M21 adc_in2 adc_in2 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA M22 adc_in3 adc_in3 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA N22 adc_in4 adc_in4 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA N21 adc_in5 adc_in5 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA P19 adc_in6 adc_in6 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA P18 adc_in7 adc_in7 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA P20 adc_vrefp adc_vrefp 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_adc NA GPADC NA N15 cap_vddram_core1 cap_vddram_core1 CAP M15 cap_vddram_core2 cap_vddram_core2 CAP M14 cap_vddram_dspeve cap_vddram_dspeve A11 csi2_0_dx0 csi2_0_dx0 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD A12 csi2_0_dx1 csi2_0_dx1 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD A13 csi2_0_dx2 csi2_0_dx2 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD A15 csi2_0_dx3 csi2_0_dx3 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD A16 csi2_0_dx4 csi2_0_dx4 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD B11 csi2_0_dy0 csi2_0_dy0 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD B12 csi2_0_dy1 csi2_0_dy1 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD B13 csi2_0_dy2 csi2_0_dy2 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD B15 csi2_0_dy3 csi2_0_dy3 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD B16 csi2_0_dy4 csi2_0_dy4 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_csi Yes LVCMOS CSI2 PU/PD T18 cvideo_rset cvideo_rset 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_dac NA AVDAC NA T17 cvideo_tvout cvideo_tvout 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_dac NA AVDAC NA P17 cvideo_vfb cvideo_vfb 0 A OFF OFF 0 1.8 vdda_dac NA AVDAC NA N6 dcan1_rx dcan1_rx 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes gpio4_10 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I dcan1_tx 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes gpio4_9 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I N5 dcan1_tx DSIS [14] CAP Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 11 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] POWER [10] HYS [11] BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] F2 ddr1_casn ddr1_casn 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy G1 ddr1_ck ddr1_ck 0 O PD drive clk (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB13 ddr1_dqm_ecc ddr1_dqm_ecc 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB10 ddr1_dqsn_ecc ddr1_dqsn_ecc 0 IO PU PU 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA10 ddr1_dqs_ecc ddr1_dqs_ecc 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy G2 ddr1_nck ddr1_nck 0 O PD drive clk (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy F1 ddr1_rasn ddr1_rasn 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy N1 ddr1_rst ddr1_rst 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy E3 ddr1_wen ddr1_wen 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U4 ddr1_a0 ddr1_a0 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy C1 ddr1_a1 ddr1_a1 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy D3 ddr1_a2 ddr1_a2 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy R4 ddr1_a3 ddr1_a3 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy T4 ddr1_a4 ddr1_a4 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy N3 ddr1_a5 ddr1_a5 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy T2 ddr1_a6 ddr1_a6 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy N2 ddr1_a7 ddr1_a7 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy T1 ddr1_a8 ddr1_a8 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U1 ddr1_a9 ddr1_a9 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy D1 ddr1_a10 ddr1_a10 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy R3 ddr1_a11 ddr1_a11 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U2 ddr1_a12 ddr1_a12 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy C3 ddr1_a13 ddr1_a13 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy 12 Terminal Configuration and Functions DSIS [14] Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] POWER [10] HYS [11] BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] R2 ddr1_a14 ddr1_a14 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V1 ddr1_a15 ddr1_a15 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy B3 ddr1_ba0 ddr1_ba0 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy A3 ddr1_ba1 ddr1_ba1 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy D2 ddr1_ba2 ddr1_ba2 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy F3 ddr1_cke0 ddr1_cke0 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy B2 ddr1_csn0 ddr1_csn0 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr2 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA6 ddr1_d0 ddr1_d0 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA8 ddr1_d1 ddr1_d1 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y8 ddr1_d2 ddr1_d2 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA7 ddr1_d3 ddr1_d3 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB4 ddr1_d4 ddr1_d4 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y5 ddr1_d5 ddr1_d5 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA4 ddr1_d6 ddr1_d6 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y6 ddr1_d7 ddr1_d7 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA18 ddr1_d8 ddr1_d8 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y21 ddr1_d9 ddr1_d9 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA21 ddr1_d10 ddr1_d10 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y22 ddr1_d11 ddr1_d11 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA19 ddr1_d12 ddr1_d12 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB20 ddr1_d13 ddr1_d13 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y17 ddr1_d14 ddr1_d14 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB18 ddr1_d15 ddr1_d15 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy DSIS [14] Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 13 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] POWER [10] HYS [11] BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] AA3 ddr1_d16 ddr1_d16 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA2 ddr1_d17 ddr1_d17 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y3 ddr1_d18 ddr1_d18 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V2 ddr1_d19 ddr1_d19 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U3 ddr1_d20 ddr1_d20 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V3 ddr1_d21 ddr1_d21 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y2 ddr1_d22 ddr1_d22 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y1 ddr1_d23 ddr1_d23 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U21 ddr1_d24 ddr1_d24 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy T20 ddr1_d25 ddr1_d25 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy R21 ddr1_d26 ddr1_d26 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U20 ddr1_d27 ddr1_d27 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy R22 ddr1_d28 ddr1_d28 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V20 ddr1_d29 ddr1_d29 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W22 ddr1_d30 ddr1_d30 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy U22 ddr1_d31 ddr1_d31 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB8 ddr1_dqm0 ddr1_dqm0 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y18 ddr1_dqm1 ddr1_dqm1 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB3 ddr1_dqm2 ddr1_dqm2 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W21 ddr1_dqm3 ddr1_dqm3 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA5 ddr1_dqs0 ddr1_dqs0 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA20 ddr1_dqs1 ddr1_dqs1 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W1 ddr1_dqs2 ddr1_dqs2 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy 14 Terminal Configuration and Functions DSIS [14] Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] POWER [10] HYS [11] BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] T21 ddr1_dqs3 ddr1_dqs3 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB5 ddr1_dqsn0 ddr1_dqsn0 0 IO PU PU 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y20 ddr1_dqsn1 ddr1_dqsn1 0 IO PU PU 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W2 ddr1_dqsn2 ddr1_dqsn2 0 IO PU PU 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy T22 ddr1_dqsn3 ddr1_dqsn3 0 IO PU PU 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr3 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y11 ddr1_ecc_d0 ddr1_ecc_d0 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA12 ddr1_ecc_d1 ddr1_ecc_d1 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA11 ddr1_ecc_d2 ddr1_ecc_d2 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y9 ddr1_ecc_d3 ddr1_ecc_d3 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA13 ddr1_ecc_d4 ddr1_ecc_d4 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB11 ddr1_ecc_d5 ddr1_ecc_d5 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA9 ddr1_ecc_d6 ddr1_ecc_d6 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB9 ddr1_ecc_d7 ddr1_ecc_d7 0 IO PD PD 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy P2 ddr1_odt0 ddr1_odt0 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 0 1.35/1.5/1.8 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy H1 emu0 emu0 0 IO PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes gpio4_28 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I emu1 0 IO PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes gpio4_29 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I gpmc_ad0 0 IO OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes 1 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 rgmii1_rxd2 gpio1_14 14 IO sysboot0 15 I gpmc_ad1 0 IO 1 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 rgmii1_rxd1 gpio1_15 14 IO sysboot1 15 I H2 E8 A7 emu1 gpmc_ad0 gpmc_ad1 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 15 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F8 B7 A6 F7 E7 C6 16 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_ad2 gpmc_ad3 gpmc_ad4 gpmc_ad5 gpmc_ad6 gpmc_ad7 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] gpmc_ad2 0 IO rgmii1_rxd0 1 I gpio1_16 14 IO sysboot2 15 I gpmc_ad3 0 IO qspi1_rtclk 1 I gpio1_17 14 IO sysboot3 15 I gpmc_ad4 0 IO cam_strobe 1 O gpio1_18 14 IO sysboot4 15 I gpmc_ad5 0 IO uart2_txd 2 O timer6 3 IO spi3_d1 4 IO gpio1_19 14 IO sysboot5 mcasp2_aclkx 15 I mcasp2_aclkx 16 IO gpmc_ad6 0 IO uart2_rxd 2 I timer5 3 IO spi3_d0 4 IO gpio1_20 14 IO sysboot6 mcasp2_fsx 15 I mcasp2_fsx 16 IO gpmc_ad7 0 IO cam_shutter 1 O timer4 3 IO spi3_sclk 4 IO gpio1_21 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_ahclkx 15 I mcasp2_ahclkx 16 O BALL RESET STATE [6] OFF OFF BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] OFF OFF 15 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv2 vddshv2 HYS [11] Yes Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1 0 0 OFF OFF Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B6 A5 D6 C5 B5 D7 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_ad8 gpmc_ad9 gpmc_ad10 gpmc_ad11 gpmc_ad12 gpmc_ad13 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] gpmc_ad8 0 IO timer7 3 IO spi3_cs0 4 IO gpio1_22 14 IO sysboot8 mcasp2_aclkr 15 I mcasp2_aclkr 16 IO gpmc_ad9 0 IO eCAP1_in_PWM1_out 3 IO spi3_cs1 4 IO gpio1_23 14 IO sysboot9 mcasp2_fsr 15 I mcasp2_fsr 16 IO gpmc_ad10 0 IO timer2 3 IO gpio1_24 14 IO sysboot10 mcasp2_axr0 15 I mcasp2_axr0 16 IO gpmc_ad11 0 IO timer3 3 IO gpio1_25 14 IO sysboot11 mcasp2_axr1 15 I mcasp2_axr1 16 IO gpmc_ad12 0 IO gpio1_26 14 IO sysboot12 mcasp2_axr2 15 I mcasp2_axr2 16 IO gpmc_ad13 0 IO rgmii1_rxc 1 I gpio1_27 14 IO sysboot13 mcasp2_axr3 15 I mcasp2_axr3 16 IO BALL RESET STATE [6] OFF BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] OFF 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv2 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 1 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 1 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 17 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B4 A4 F12 D12 E12 C12 18 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_ad14 gpmc_ad15 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_ben0 gpmc_ben1 gpmc_clk SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] gpmc_ad14 0 IO spi2_cs1 4 IO gpio1_28 14 IO sysboot14 mcasp2_axr4 15 I mcasp2_axr4 16 IO gpmc_ad15 0 IO spi2_cs0 4 IO gpio1_29 14 IO sysboot15 mcasp2_axr5 15 I mcasp2_axr5 16 IO gpmc_advn_ale 0 O rgmii1_txd2 1 O ehrpwm1_tripzone_input 4 IO clkout1 5 O dma_evt4 6 I gpio1_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_ben0 0 O rgmii1_txctl 1 O ehrpwm1A 4 O dma_evt2 6 I gpio1_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_ben1 0 O rgmii1_txd3 1 O ehrpwm1B 4 O dma_evt3 6 I gpio1_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_clk 0 IO rgmii1_txc 1 O clkout0 5 O dma_evt1 6 I gpio1_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] OFF BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] OFF 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv2 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 1 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] C10 E10 D10 A9 B9 F10 C8 A10 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_cs0 gpmc_cs1 gpmc_cs2 gpmc_cs3 gpmc_cs4 gpmc_cs5 gpmc_cs6 gpmc_oen_ren SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] gpmc_cs0 0 O rgmii1_rxctl 1 I gpio1_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs1 0 O qspi1_cs0 1 IO gpio1_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs2 0 O qspi1_d3 1 IO gpio1_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs3 0 O qspi1_d2 1 IO gpio1_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs4 0 O qspi1_d0 1 IO gpio1_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs5 0 O qspi1_d1 1 IO gpio1_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs6 0 O qspi1_sclk 1 O gpio1_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_oen_ren 0 O rgmii1_txd1 1 O ehrpwm1_synci 4 I clkout2 5 O gpio1_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] PU PU PU PU PU PU BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PU PU PU PU PU PU 15 15 15 15 15 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv2 vddshv2 vddshv2 vddshv2 vddshv2 vddshv2 HYS [11] Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 19 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] D8 B10 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_wait0 gpmc_wen SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] gpmc_wait0 0 I rgmii1_rxd3 1 I qspi1_rtclk 2 I dma_evt4 6 I gpio1_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_wen 0 O rgmii1_txd0 1 O ehrpwm1_synco 4 O gpio1_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] PU BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PU 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv2 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 1 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS L3 i2c1_scl i2c1_scl 0 IO OFF OFF 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU LVCMOS I2C L4 i2c1_sda i2c1_sda 0 IO OFF OFF 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU LVCMOS I2C L6 i2c2_scl i2c2_scl 0 IO OFF OFF 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU LVCMOS I2C L5 i2c2_sda i2c2_sda 0 IO OFF OFF 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU LVCMOS I2C W6 mcan_rx mcan_rx 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes cam_nreset 1 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS vin2a_vsync0 2 I spi1_cs3 3 IO uart3_txd 4 O gpmc_cs7 5 O vin1b_vsync1 7 I gpio4_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcan_tx 0 IO vin2a_de0 1 I vin2a_hsync0 2 I spi1_cs2 3 IO 1 uart3_rxd 4 I 1 gpmc_wait1 6 I 1 vin1b_hsync1 7 I 0 vin1b_de1 8 I 0 gpio4_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I W7 20 mcan_tx 1 1 0 PU PU Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B17 B19 BALL NAME [2] mdio_d mdio_mclk SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] mdio_d 0 IO spi4_d0 4 IO gpio3_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I mdio_mclk 0 O spi4_d1 4 IO gpio3_17 14 IO BALL RESET STATE [6] PU PU BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PU PU 15 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv4 vddshv4 HYS [11] Yes Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 1 0 0 Driver off 15 I G5 nmin nmin 0 I PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS G3 porz porz 0 I OFF OFF 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes IHHV1833 G4 resetn resetn 0 I PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS B18 rgmii0_rxc rgmii0_rxc 0 I PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes cam_strobe 3 O Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS mmc_clk 5 IO gpio3_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxctl 0 I cam_shutter 3 O mmc_cmd 5 IO gpio3_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txc 0 O cam_strobe 3 O spi4_sclk 4 IO 0 mmc_clk 5 IO 1 gpio3_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txctl 0 O cam_shutter 3 O spi4_cs0 4 IO 1 mmc_cmd 5 IO 1 gpio3_20 14 IO Driver off 15 I C18 C16 C17 rgmii0_rxctl rgmii0_txc rgmii0_txctl PU/PD 0 1 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1 PD PD PD PD 15 15 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 vddshv4 Yes Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 21 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] A20 C20 B20 A19 F17 E17 D16 E16 BALL NAME [2] rgmii0_rxd0 rgmii0_rxd1 rgmii0_rxd2 rgmii0_rxd3 rgmii0_txd0 rgmii0_txd1 rgmii0_txd2 rgmii0_txd3 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] rgmii0_rxd0 0 I mmc_dat3 5 IO gpio3_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxd1 0 I mmc_dat2 5 IO gpio3_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxd2 0 I mmc_dat1 5 IO gpio3_28 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxd3 0 I mmc_dat0 5 IO gpio3_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd0 0 O mmc_dat3 5 IO gpio3_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd1 0 O mmc_dat2 5 IO gpio3_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd2 0 O eCAP1_in_PWM1_out 3 IO mmc_dat1 5 IO gpio3_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd3 0 O mmc_dat0 5 IO gpio3_21 14 IO BALL RESET STATE [6] PD PD PD PD PD PD PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD PD PD PD PD PD PD 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv4 vddshv4 vddshv4 vddshv4 vddshv4 vddshv4 vddshv4 HYS [11] Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I F4 rstoutn rstoutn 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS J6 rtck rtck 0 O PU vddshv1 Yes 14 IO drive clk (OFF) 1.8/3.3 gpio4_27 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I 22 DSIS [14] Terminal Configuration and Functions 0 1 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] M2 L1 R6 R5 T5 U6 L2 BALL NAME [2] spi1_sclk spi2_sclk spi1_cs0 spi1_cs1 spi1_d0 spi1_d1 spi2_cs0 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] spi1_sclk 0 IO uart3_rxd 1 I gpio4_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi2_sclk 0 IO uart3_rxd 1 I ehrpwm1A 2 O timer3 3 IO gpio4_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_cs0 0 IO uart3_txd 1 O gpio4_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_cs1 0 IO spi3_cs1 1 IO timer6 4 IO ehrpwm1_tripzone_input 7 IO gpio4_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_d0 0 IO uart3_rtsn 1 O gpio4_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_d1 0 IO uart3_ctsn 1 I gpio4_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi2_cs0 0 IO uart3_txd 1 O ehrpwm1B 2 O timer4 3 IO gpio4_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] PD PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD PD 15 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv1 vddshv1 HYS [11] Yes Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1 1 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 1 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes 1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 23 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] R7 N4 BALL NAME [2] spi2_d0 spi2_d1 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] spi2_d0 0 IO uart3_rtsn 1 O timer1 3 IO gpio4_7 14 IO sysboot7 15 I spi2_d1 0 IO uart3_ctsn 1 I timer5 3 IO eCAP1_in_PWM1_out 7 IO gpio4_6 14 IO BALL RESET STATE [6] BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] POWER [10] HYS [11] BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Driver off 15 I tclk tclk 0 I PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes IQ1833 J1 tdi tdi 0 I PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes gpio4_25 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Driver off 15 I tdo 0 O PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes gpio4_26 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS tdo 1 0 J2 J4 DSIS [14] PU/PD Driver off 15 I J3 tms tms 0 IO OFF OFF 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS J5 trstn trstn 0 I PD PD 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS F14 uart1_ctsn uart1_ctsn 0 I PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes xref_clk1 1 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS uart3_rxd 2 I gpmc_a16 3 O spi4_sclk 4 IO 0 spi1_cs2 5 IO 1 timer3 6 IO ehrpwm1_synci 7 I clkout0 8 O vin2a_hsync0 9 I gpmc_a12 10 O gpmc_clk 11 IO dcan1_tx 12 IO gpio4_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I 24 Terminal Configuration and Functions 1 1 0 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] C14 F13 E14 F15 BALL NAME [2] uart1_rtsn uart1_rxd uart1_txd uart2_ctsn SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PU BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PU 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv3 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] uart1_rtsn 0 O uart3_txd 2 O Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS gpmc_a17 3 O spi4_cs0 4 IO 1 spi1_cs3 5 IO 1 timer4 6 IO ehrpwm1_synco 7 O qspi1_rtclk 8 I vin2a_vsync0 9 I gpmc_a13 10 O dcan1_rx 12 IO gpio4_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart1_rxd 0 I spi4_d1 4 IO qspi1_rtclk 5 I gpmc_a12 10 O mcan_tx 12 IO gpio4_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart1_txd 0 O spi4_d0 4 IO gpmc_a13 10 O mcan_rx 12 IO gpio4_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart2_ctsn 0 I xref_clk1 2 I gpmc_a18 3 O spi3_sclk 4 IO 0 qspi1_cs1 5 IO 1 timer7 6 IO vin2a_hsync0 9 I gpmc_clk 10 IO 0 mcan_tx 12 IO 1 gpio4_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 0 0 1 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1 OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 25 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F16 BALL NAME [2] uart2_rtsn D14 uart2_rxd D15 uart2_txd SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] uart2_rtsn 0 O eCAP1_in_PWM1_out 1 IO gpmc_a19 3 O spi3_cs0 4 IO timer8 6 IO vin2a_vsync0 9 I mcan_rx 12 IO gpio4_20 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart2_rxd 0 I spi3_d1 4 IO timer1 6 IO ehrpwm1A 7 O gpmc_clk 10 IO gpmc_a12 11 O dcan1_tx 12 IO gpio4_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart2_txd 0 O spi3_d0 4 IO timer2 6 IO ehrpwm1B 7 O gpmc_a13 11 O dcan1_rx 12 IO gpio4_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I H12, H13, H7, J10, J11, J15, K12, L12, L15, N12, N16, P10, P14 vdd vdd PWR P22 vdda_adc vdda_adc PWR A14 vdda_csi vdda_csi PWR U19 vdda_dac vdda_dac PWR N8 vdda_ddr_dsp vdda_ddr_dsp PWR M8 vdda_gmac_core vdda_gmac_core PWR E21 vdda_osc vdda_osc PWR H14 vdda_per vdda_per PWR G12, J7, L16, P13, T11 vdds18v vdds18v PWR 26 BALL RESET STATE [6] PU BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PU 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv3 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 1 1 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1 0 0 PU PU Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] P7, T9 vdds18v_ddr1 vdds18v_ddr1 PWR G7 vdds18v_ddr2 vdds18v_ddr2 PWR T16, V21 vdds18v_ddr3 vdds18v_ddr3 PWR K2, K7, L7, M7 vddshv1 vddshv1 PWR B8, G11, G8, G9 vddshv2 vddshv2 PWR G14 vddshv3 vddshv3 PWR A18, E20 vddshv4 vddshv4 PWR H17, J16, J21 vddshv5 vddshv5 PWR AA16, T10, T12, T13 vddshv6 vddshv6 PWR AA1, AB6, R1, T7, vdds_ddr1 T8 vdds_ddr1 PWR C2, E2, G6 vdds_ddr2 vdds_ddr2 PWR AA22, AB19, T15 vdds_ddr3 vdds_ddr3 PWR K8, L8, M9, P11, P12, P8, P9 vdd_dspeve vdd_dspeve PWR F22 vin1a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 0 I cpi_pclk 1 I clkout0 4 O gpio1_30 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_aclkx 15 I mcasp3_aclkx 16 IO vin1a_d0 0 I cpi_data2 1 I gpio2_3 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_axr1 15 I mcasp3_axr1 16 IO vin1a_d1 0 I cpi_data3 1 I gpio2_4 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_axr2 15 I mcasp3_axr2 16 IO G18 G21 vin1a_d0 vin1a_d1 BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv5 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 27 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] G22 H18 H20 H19 H22 H21 28 BALL NAME [2] vin1a_d2 vin1a_d3 vin1a_d4 vin1a_d5 vin1a_d6 vin1a_d7 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] vin1a_d2 0 I cpi_data4 1 I gpio2_5 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_axr3 15 I mcasp3_axr3 16 IO vin1a_d3 0 I cpi_data5 1 I gpio2_6 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_axr4 15 I mcasp3_axr4 16 IO vin1a_d4 0 I cpi_data6 1 I gpio2_7 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_axr5 15 I mcasp3_axr5 16 IO vin1a_d5 0 I cpi_data7 1 I gpio2_8 14 IO xref_clk2 mcasp3_ahclkx 15 I mcasp3_ahclkx 16 O vin1a_d6 0 I cpi_data8 1 I gpio2_9 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_fsx 15 I mcasp3_fsx 16 IO vin1a_d7 0 I cpi_data9 1 I gpio2_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv5 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD PD PD 15 15 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 vddshv5 Yes Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 0 PD PD Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] J17 K22 K21 K18 K17 BALL NAME [2] vin1a_d8 vin1a_d9 vin1a_d10 vin1a_d11 vin1a_d12 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] vin1a_d8 0 I cpi_data10 1 I vin1b_d0 2 I gpmc_a8 3 O sys_nirq2 7 I gpio2_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_d9 0 I cpi_data11 1 I vin1b_d1 2 I gpmc_a9 3 O sys_nirq1 7 I gpio2_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_d10 0 I cpi_data12 1 I vin1b_d2 2 I gpmc_a10 3 O sys_nirq2 7 I gpio2_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_d11 0 I cpi_data13 1 I vin1b_d3 2 I gpmc_a11 3 O sys_nirq1 7 I gpio2_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_d12 0 I cpi_data14 1 I vin1b_d4 2 I gpmc_a12 3 O dma_evt1 6 I gpio2_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv5 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 29 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] K19 K20 L21 F21 F20 30 BALL NAME [2] vin1a_d13 vin1a_d14 vin1a_d15 vin1a_de0 vin1a_fld0 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] vin1a_d13 0 I cpi_wen 1 I vin1b_d5 2 I gpmc_a13 3 O dma_evt2 6 I gpio2_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_d14 0 I cpi_fid 1 IO vin1b_d6 2 I gpmc_a14 3 O gpio2_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_d15 0 I cpi_data15 1 I vin1b_d7 2 I gpmc_a15 3 O gpio2_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_de0 0 I cpi_hsync 1 IO vin1b_clk1 2 I clkout1 4 O gpio1_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin1a_fld0 0 I cpi_vsync 1 IO vin2b_clk1 2 I clkout2 4 O gpio2_0 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_aclkr 15 I mcasp3_aclkr 16 IO BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv5 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F19 G19 L22 M17 M18 AB17 BALL NAME [2] vin1a_hsync0 vin1a_vsync0 vin2a_clk0 vin2a_de0 vin2a_fld0 vout1_clk SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv5 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] vin1a_hsync0 0 I cpi_data0 1 I 0 vin1a_de0 2 I gpio2_1 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_fsr 15 I mcasp3_fsr 16 IO vin1a_vsync0 0 I cpi_data1 1 I gpio2_2 14 IO Driver off mcasp3_axr0 15 I mcasp3_axr0 16 IO vin2a_clk0 0 I gpio2_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_de0 0 I cam_strobe 1 O vin2b_hsync1 2 I 0 vin2b_de1 5 I 0 gpio4_21 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_fld0 0 I cam_shutter 1 O vin2b_vsync1 2 I gpio4_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_clk 0 O vin1a_d12 2 I clkout0 4 O vin2a_clk0 9 I gpio2_20 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 31 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] U17 W17 AA17 U16 W16 V16 32 BALL NAME [2] vout1_de vout1_fld vout1_hsync vout1_vsync vout1_d0 vout1_d1 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] vout1_de 0 O mcasp1_aclkx 1 IO vin1a_d13 2 I clkout1 4 O gpio2_21 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_fld 0 O mcasp1_fsx 1 IO vin1a_d14 2 I clkout2 4 O gpio2_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_hsync 0 O mcasp1_aclkr 1 IO vin1a_d15 2 I vin2a_de0 9 I gpio2_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_vsync 0 O mcasp1_fsr 1 IO vin2a_fld0 9 I gpio2_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d0 0 O mcasp1_axr0 1 IO mmc_clk 5 IO gpio2_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d1 0 O mcasp1_axr1 1 IO mmc_cmd 5 IO gpio2_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv6 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD PD PD 15 15 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 vddshv6 Yes Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 1 PD PD Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] U15 V15 Y15 W15 AA15 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d2 vout1_d3 vout1_d4 vout1_d5 vout1_d6 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] IO mcasp1_axr8 4 IO 0 mmc_dat0 5 IO 1 gpio2_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d3 0 O mcasp1_axr3 1 IO mcasp1_axr9 4 IO 0 mmc_dat1 5 IO 1 gpio2_28 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d4 0 O mcasp1_axr4 1 IO mcasp1_axr10 4 IO 0 mmc_dat2 5 IO 1 gpio2_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d5 0 O mcasp1_axr5 1 IO mcasp1_axr11 4 IO 0 mmc_dat3 5 IO 1 vin2a_clk0 9 I gpio2_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d6 0 O mcasp1_axr6 1 IO mcasp1_axr12 4 IO emu2 6 O vin2a_de0 9 I gpio2_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I PD PD PD PD PD PD 15 15 15 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 vddshv6 vddshv6 Yes Yes Yes Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] O vddshv6 Yes PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] 1 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 BUFFER TYPE [12] 0 15 1.8/3.3 HYS [11] mcasp1_axr2 PD 15 POWER [10] vout1_d2 PD PD I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 0 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 33 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AB15 AA14 AB14 U13 V13 34 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d7 vout1_d8 vout1_d9 vout1_d10 vout1_d11 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] IO eCAP1_in_PWM1_out 3 IO 0 mcasp1_axr13 4 IO 0 emu3 6 O vin2a_fld0 9 I gpio3_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d8 0 O mcasp1_axr8 1 IO vin2a_d0 2 I gpmc_a20 3 O emu4 6 O gpio3_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d9 0 O mcasp1_axr9 1 IO vin2a_d1 2 I gpmc_a21 3 O emu5 6 O gpio3_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d10 0 O mcasp1_axr10 1 IO vin2a_d2 2 I gpmc_a22 3 O emu6 6 O gpio3_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d11 0 O mcasp1_axr11 1 IO vin2a_d3 2 I gpmc_a23 3 O emu7 6 O gpio3_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] O vddshv6 Yes PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] 1 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 BUFFER TYPE [12] 0 15 1.8/3.3 HYS [11] mcasp1_axr7 PD 15 POWER [10] vout1_d7 PD PD I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] Y13 W13 U11 V11 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d12 vout1_d13 vout1_d14 vout1_d15 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] vout1_d12 0 O mcasp1_axr12 1 IO vin2a_d4 2 I gpmc_a24 3 O emu8 6 O gpio3_5 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_ahclkx 15 I mcasp2_ahclkx 16 O vout1_d13 0 O mcasp1_axr13 1 IO vin2a_d5 2 I gpmc_a25 3 O emu9 6 O gpio3_6 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_aclkr 15 I mcasp2_aclkr 16 IO vout1_d14 0 O mcasp1_axr14 1 IO vin2a_d6 2 I gpmc_a26 3 O emu10 6 O gpio3_7 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_aclkx 15 I mcasp2_aclkx 16 IO vout1_d15 0 O mcasp1_axr15 1 IO vin2a_d7 2 I gpmc_a27 3 O emu11 6 O gpio3_8 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_fsx 15 I mcasp2_fsx 16 IO BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv6 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 35 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] U9 W11 V9 W9 36 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d16 vout1_d17 vout1_d18 vout1_d19 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv6 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] vout1_d16 0 O mcasp1_ahclkx 1 O Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS vin2a_d8 2 I gpmc_a0 3 O mcasp1_axr8 4 IO 0 vin2b_d0 5 I 0 emu12 6 O gpio3_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d17 0 O vin2a_d9 2 I gpmc_a1 3 O mcasp1_axr9 4 IO 0 vin2b_d1 5 I 0 emu13 6 O gpio3_10 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_fsr 15 I mcasp2_fsr 16 IO vout1_d18 0 O vin2a_d10 2 I gpmc_a2 3 O mcasp1_axr10 4 IO 0 vin2b_d2 5 I 0 emu14 6 O gpio3_11 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_axr0 15 I mcasp2_axr0 16 IO vout1_d19 0 O vin2a_d11 2 I gpmc_a3 3 O mcasp1_axr11 4 IO 0 vin2b_d3 5 I 0 emu15 6 O gpio3_12 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_axr1 15 I mcasp2_axr1 16 IO 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] U8 W8 U7 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d20 vout1_d21 vout1_d22 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv6 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS DSIS [14] vout1_d20 0 O vin2a_d12 2 I gpmc_a4 3 O mcasp1_axr12 4 IO 0 vin2b_d4 5 I 0 emu16 6 O gpio3_13 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_axr2 15 I mcasp2_axr2 16 IO vout1_d21 0 O vin2a_d13 2 I gpmc_a5 3 O mcasp1_axr13 4 IO 0 vin2b_d5 5 I 0 emu17 6 O gpio3_14 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_axr3 15 I mcasp2_axr3 16 IO vout1_d22 0 O vin2a_d14 2 I gpmc_a6 3 O mcasp1_axr14 4 IO 0 vin2b_d6 5 I 0 emu18 6 O gpio3_15 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_axr4 15 I mcasp2_axr4 16 IO 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 37 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] V7 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d23 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv6 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS vout1_d23 0 O vin2a_d15 2 I gpmc_a7 3 O mcasp1_axr15 4 IO 0 vin2b_d7 5 I 0 emu19 6 O gpio3_16 14 IO Driver off mcasp2_axr5 15 I mcasp2_axr5 16 IO 0 0 A1, A17, A22, A8, vss AB1, AB12, AB16, AB2, AB21, AB22, AB7, B22, E1, G10, G16, H10, H11, H15, H16, H8, H9, J22, K1, K10, K11, K13, K14, K15, K16, K9, M10, M11, M12, M13, M16, N10, N7, P1, P15, P16, R12, R16, R9, T14, V22 vss GND P21 vssa_adc vssa_adc GND B14 vssa_csi vssa_csi GND T19 vssa_dac vssa_dac GND D21 vssa_osc0 vssa_osc0 GND C22 vssa_osc1 vssa_osc1 E22 xi_osc0 xi_osc0 0 I 0 1.8 vdda_osc Yes LVCMOS Analog PD B21 xi_osc1 xi_osc1 0 I 0 1.8 vdda_osc Yes LVCMOS Analog PD D22 xo_osc0 xo_osc0 0 O 0 1.8 vdda_osc Yes LVCMOS Analog PD C21 xo_osc1 xo_osc1 0 A 0 1.8 vdda_osc Yes LVCMOS Analog PD 38 DSIS [14] GND Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-1. Pin Attributes(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] M1 BALL NAME [2] xref_clk0 SIGNAL NAME [3] MUXMODE [4] TYPE [5] BALL RESET STATE [6] PD BALL BALL RESET REL. RESET REL. MUXMODE STATE [7] [8] PD 15 I/O VOLTAGE VALUE [9] 1.8/3.3 POWER [10] vddshv1 HYS [11] Yes BUFFER TYPE [12] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [13] DSIS [14] xref_clk0 0 I clkout0 1 O Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS spi3_cs0 4 IO 1 spi2_cs1 5 IO 1 spi1_cs0 6 IO 1 spi1_cs1 7 IO 1 gpio3_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I (1) NA in this table stands for Not Applicable. (2) For more information on recommended operating conditions, see , Recommended Operating Conditions. (3) The pullup or pulldown block strength is equal to: minimum = 50 μA, typical = 100 μA, maximum = 250 μA. (4) The output impedance settings of this IO cell are programmable; by default, the value is DS[1:0] = 10, this means 40 Ω. For more information on DS[1:0] register configuration, see the Device TRM. (5) In PUx / PDy, x and y = 60 to 300 μA. The output impedance settings (or drive strengths) of this IO are programmable (60 Ω, 80 Ω, 120 Ω) depending on the values of the I[2:0] registers. 4.3 Signal Descriptions Many signals are available on multiple pins, according to the software configuration of the pin multiplexing options. 1. SIGNAL NAME: The name of the signal passing through the pin. NOTE The subsystem multiplexing signals are not described in Table 4-1 and Table 4-28. 2. DESCRIPTION: Description of the signal 3. TYPE: Signal direction and type: – I = Input – O = Output – IO = Input or output – D = Open Drain – DS = Differential – A = Analog – PWR = Power – GND = Ground 4. BALL: Associated ball(s) bottom Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 39 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com NOTE For more information, see the Control Module / Control Module Register Manual section of the device TRM. 4.3.1 VIP NOTE For more information, see the Video Input Port (VIP) section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid for VIN1 and VIN2 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-29 and Table 5-30. Table 4-2. VIP Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Video Input 1 Port A Clock input. Input clock for 8-bit 16-bit or 24-bit Port A video capture. Input data is sampled on the CLK0 edge. I F22 vin1a_d0 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I G18 vin1a_d1 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I G21 vin1a_d2 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I G22 vin1a_d3 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I H18 vin1a_d4 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I H20 vin1a_d5 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I H19 vin1a_d6 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I H22 vin1a_d7 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I H21 vin1a_d8 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I J17 vin1a_d9 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I K22 vin1a_d10 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I K21 vin1a_d11 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I K18 vin1a_d12 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AB17, K17 vin1a_d13 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I K19, U17 vin1a_d14 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I K20, W17 vin1a_d15 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AA17, L21 Video Input 1 vin1a_clk0 40 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-2. VIP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL vin1a_de0 Video Input 1 Port A Field ID input I F19, F21 vin1a_fld0 Video Input 1 Port A Field ID input I F20 vin1a_hsync0 Video Input 1 Port A Horizontal Sync input I F19 vin1a_vsync0 Video Input 1 Port A Vertical Sync input I G19 vin1b_clk1 Video Input 1 Port B Clock input I F21 vin1b_d0 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I J17 vin1b_d1 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I K22 vin1b_d2 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I K21 vin1b_d3 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I K18 vin1b_d4 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I K17 vin1b_d5 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I K19 vin1b_d6 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I K20 vin1b_d7 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I L21 vin1b_de1 Video Input 1 Port B Field ID input I W7 vin1b_hsync1 Video Input 1 Port B Horizontal Sync input I W7 vin1b_vsync1 Video Input 1 Port B Vertical Sync input I W6 vin2a_clk0 Video Input 2 Port A Clock input I AB17, L22, W15 vin2a_d0 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I AA14 vin2a_d1 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I AB14 vin2a_d2 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I U13 vin2a_d3 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I V13 vin2a_d4 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I Y13 vin2a_d5 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I W13 vin2a_d6 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I U11 vin2a_d7 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I V11 vin2a_d8 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I U9 vin2a_d9 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I W11 vin2a_d10 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I V9 vin2a_d11 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I W9 vin2a_d12 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I U8 vin2a_d13 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I W8 vin2a_d14 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I U7 Video Input 2 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 41 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-2. VIP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME 42 DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL vin2a_d15 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I V7 vin2a_de0 Video Input 2 Port A Field ID input I AA15, AA17, M17, W7 vin2a_fld0 Video Input 2 Port A Field ID input I AB15, M18, U16 vin2a_hsync0 Video Input 2 Port A Horizontal Sync input I F14, F15, W7 vin2a_vsync0 Video Input 2 Port A Vertical Sync input I C14, F16, W6 vin2b_clk1 Video Input 2 Port B Clock input I F20 vin2b_d0 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I U9 vin2b_d1 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I W11 vin2b_d2 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I V9 vin2b_d3 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I W9 vin2b_d4 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I U8 vin2b_d5 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I W8 vin2b_d6 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I U7 vin2b_d7 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I V7 vin2b_de1 Video Input 2 Port B Field ID input I M17 vin2b_hsync1 Video Input 2 Port B Horizontal Sync input I M17 vin2b_vsync1 Video Input 2 Port B Vertical Sync input I M18 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 4.3.2 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DSS Table 4-3. DSS Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL DPI Video Output 1 vout1_clk Video Output 1 Clock output O AB17 vout1_d0 Video Output 1 Data output O W16 vout1_d1 Video Output 1 Data output O V16 vout1_d2 Video Output 1 Data output O U15 vout1_d3 Video Output 1 Data output O V15 vout1_d4 Video Output 1 Data output O Y15 vout1_d5 Video Output 1 Data output O W15 vout1_d6 Video Output 1 Data output O AA15 vout1_d7 Video Output 1 Data output O AB15 vout1_d8 Video Output 1 Data output O AA14 vout1_d9 Video Output 1 Data output O AB14 vout1_d10 Video Output 1 Data output O U13 vout1_d11 Video Output 1 Data output O V13 vout1_d12 Video Output 1 Data output O Y13 vout1_d13 Video Output 1 Data output O W13 vout1_d14 Video Output 1 Data output O U11 vout1_d15 Video Output 1 Data output O V11 vout1_d16 Video Output 1 Data output O U9 vout1_d17 Video Output 1 Data output O W11 vout1_d18 Video Output 1 Data output O V9 vout1_d19 Video Output 1 Data output O W9 vout1_d20 Video Output 1 Data output O U8 vout1_d21 Video Output 1 Data output O W8 vout1_d22 Video Output 1 Data output O U7 vout1_d23 Video Output 1 Data output O V7 vout1_de Video Output 1 Data Enable output O U17 vout1_fld Video Output 1 Field ID output.This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O W17 vout1_hsync Video Output 1 Horizontal Sync output.This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O AA17 vout1_vsync Video Output 1 Vertical Sync output.This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O U16 4.3.3 SD_DAC NOTE For more information, see theVideo Encoder / Video Encoder Overview of the device TRM. Table 4-4. CVIDEO SD_DAC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME cvideo_tvout DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL SD_DAC TV analog composite output A T17 cvideo_vfb SD_DAC input feedback thru resistor to out A P17 cvideo_rset SD_DAC input reference current resistor setting A T18 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 43 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 4.3.4 www.ti.com ADC NOTE For more information, see the ADC / ADC Overview of the device TRM. Table 4-5. ADC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL adc_in0 ADC analog channel input 0 A M19 adc_in1 ADC analog channel input 1 A M20 adc_in2 ADC analog channel input 2 A M21 adc_in3 ADC analog channel input 3 A M22 adc_in4 ADC analog channel input 4 A N22 adc_in5 ADC analog channel input 5 A N21 adc_in6 ADC analog channel input 6 A P19 adc_in7 ADC analog channel input 7 A P18 ADC positive reference voltage A P20 adc_vrefp 4.3.5 DESCRIPTION Camera Control NOTE For more information, see the Imaging Subsystem (ISS) section of the device TRM. Table 4-6. Camera Control Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL O A6, B18, C16, M17 Camera mechanical shutter control O C6, C18, C17, M18 Camera sensor reset IO W6 TYPE BALL I F22 cam_strobe Camera flash activation trigger cam_shutter cam_nreset 4.3.6 CPI Table 4-7. CPI Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME cpi_pclk 44 DESCRIPTION Camera pixel clock cpi_hsync Camera horizontal synchonization IO F21 cpi_vsync Camera vertical synchonization IO F20 cpi_data0 Camera parallel data 0 I F19 cpi_data1 Camera parallel data 1 I G19 cpi_data2 Camera parallel data 2 I G18 cpi_data3 Camera parallel data 3 I G21 cpi_data4 Camera parallel data 4 I G22 cpi_data5 Camera parallel data 5 I H18 cpi_data6 Camera parallel data 6 I H20 cpi_data7 Camera parallel data 7 I H19 cpi_data8 Camera parallel data 8 I H22 cpi_data9 Camera parallel data 9 I H21 cpi_data10 Camera parallel data 10 I J17 cpi_data11 Camera parallel data 11 I K22 cpi_data12 Camera parallel data 12 I K21 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-7. CPI Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL cpi_data13 Camera parallel data 13 I K18 cpi_data14 Camera parallel data 14 I K17 cpi_data15 Camera parallel data 15 I L21 Camera parallel external write enable I K19 IO K20 cpi_wen cpi_fid DESCRIPTION Camera parallel field identification for interlaced sensors (i mode) Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 45 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 4.3.7 www.ti.com CSI2 NOTE For more information, see the Imaging Subsystem of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-32. Table 4-8. CSI 2 Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL csi2_0_dx0 Serial Differential data/clock positive input - lane 0 (position 1) I A11 csi2_0_dy0 Serial Differential data/clock negative input - lane 0 (position 1) I B11 csi2_0_dx1 Serial Differential data/clock positive input - lane 1 (position 2) I A12 csi2_0_dy1 Serial Differential data/clock negative input - lane 1 (position 2) I B12 csi2_0_dx2 Serial Differential data/clock positive input - lane 2 (position 3) I A13 csi2_0_dy2 Serial Differential data/clock negative input - lane 2 (position 3) I B13 csi2_0_dx3 Serial Differential data/clock positive input - lane 3 (position 4) I A15 csi2_0_dy3 Serial Differential data/clock negative input - lane 3 (position 4) I B15 csi2_0_dx4 Serial Differential data positive input only - lane 4 (position 5) (1) I A16 I B16 csi2_0_dy4 DESCRIPTION Serial Differential data negative input only - lane 4 (position 5) (1) (1) Lane 4 (position 5) supports only data. For more information see Imaging Subsystem of the device TRM. 4.3.8 EMIF NOTE For more information, see the Memory Subsystem / EMIF Controller section of the device TRM. NOTE The index number 1 which is part of the EMIF1 signal prefixes (ddr1_*) listed in Table 4-9, EMIF Signal Descriptions, column "SIGNAL NAME" is not to be confused with DDR1 type of SDRAM memories. Table 4-9. EMIF Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL EMIF1 Clock Enable 0 O F3 ddr1_nck EMIF1 Negative Clock O G2 ddr1_odt0 EMIF1 On-Die Termination for Chip Select 0 O P2 ddr1_rasn EMIF1 Row Address Strobe; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as to ddr1_ca0 O F1 EMIF1 Reset output O N1 ddr1_wen EMIF1 Write Enable; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca2 O E3 ddr1_csn0 EMIF1 Chip Select 0 O B2 EMIF1 Clock O G1 ddr1_rst ddr1_ck 46 DESCRIPTION ddr1_cke0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-9. EMIF Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL ddr1_casn DESCRIPTION EMIF1 Column Address Strobe; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca1 O F2 ddr1_ba0 EMIF1 Bank Address; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca7 O B3 ddr1_ba1 EMIF1 Bank Address; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca8 O A3 ddr1_ba2 EMIF1 Bank Address; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca9 O D2 ddr1_a0 EMIF1 Address Bus O U4 ddr1_a1 EMIF1 Address Bus; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca5 O C1 ddr1_a2 EMIF1 Address Bus; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca6 O D3 ddr1_a3 EMIF1 Address Bus O R4 ddr1_a4 EMIF1 Address Bus O T4 ddr1_a5 EMIF1 Address Bus O N3 ddr1_a6 EMIF1 Address Bus O T2 ddr1_a7 EMIF1 Address Bus O N2 ddr1_a8 EMIF1 Address Bus O T1 ddr1_a9 EMIF1 Address Bus O U1 ddr1_a10 EMIF1 Address Bus; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca4 O D1 ddr1_a11 EMIF1 Address Bus O R3 ddr1_a12 EMIF1 Address Bus O U2 ddr1_a13 EMIF1 Address Bus; When LPDDR2 is used this signal functions as ddr1_ca3 O C3 ddr1_a14 EMIF1 Address Bus O R2 ddr1_a15 EMIF1 Address Bus O V1 ddr1_d0 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA6 ddr1_d1 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA8 ddr1_d2 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y8 ddr1_d3 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA7 ddr1_d4 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AB4 ddr1_d5 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y5 ddr1_d6 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA4 ddr1_d7 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y6 ddr1_d8 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA18 ddr1_d9 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y21 ddr1_d10 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA21 ddr1_d11 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y22 ddr1_d12 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA19 ddr1_d13 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AB20 ddr1_d14 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y17 ddr1_d15 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AB18 ddr1_d16 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA3 ddr1_d17 EMIF1 Data Bus IO AA2 ddr1_d18 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y3 ddr1_d19 EMIF1 Data Bus IO V2 ddr1_d20 EMIF1 Data Bus IO U3 ddr1_d21 EMIF1 Data Bus IO V3 ddr1_d22 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y2 ddr1_d23 EMIF1 Data Bus IO Y1 ddr1_d24 EMIF1 Data Bus IO U21 ddr1_d25 EMIF1 Data Bus IO T20 ddr1_d26 EMIF1 Data Bus IO R21 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 47 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-9. EMIF Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL ddr1_d27 EMIF1 Data Bus IO U20 ddr1_d28 EMIF1 Data Bus IO R22 ddr1_d29 EMIF1 Data Bus IO V20 ddr1_d30 EMIF1 Data Bus IO W22 ddr1_d31 U22 EMIF1 Data Bus IO ddr1_ecc_d0 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO Y11 ddr1_ecc_d1 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO AA12 ddr1_ecc_d2 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO AA11 ddr1_ecc_d3 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO Y9 ddr1_ecc_d4 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO AA13 ddr1_ecc_d5 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO AB11 ddr1_ecc_d6 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO AA9 ddr1_ecc_d7 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus IO AB9 ddr1_dqm0 EMIF1 Data Mask IO AB8 ddr1_dqm1 EMIF1 Data Mask IO Y18 ddr1_dqm2 EMIF1 Data Mask IO AB3 ddr1_dqm3 EMIF1 Data Mask IO W21 ddr1_dqm_ecc EMIF1 ECC Data Mask IO AB13 ddr1_dqs0 Data strobe 0 input/output for byte 0 of the 32-bit data bus. This signal is output to the EMIF1 memory when writing and input when reading. IO AA5 ddr1_dqs1 Data strobe 1 input/output for byte 1 of the 32-bit data bus. This signal is output to the EMIF1 memory when writing and input when reading. IO AA20 ddr1_dqs2 Data strobe 2 input/output for byte 2 of the 32-bit data bus. This signal is output to the EMIF1 memory when writing and input when reading. IO W1 ddr1_dqs3 Data strobe 3 input/output for byte 3 of the 32-bit data bus. This signal is output to the EMIF1 memory when writing and input when reading. IO T21 ddr1_dqsn0 Data strobe 0 invert IO AB5 ddr1_dqsn1 Data strobe 1 invert IO Y20 ddr1_dqsn2 Data strobe 2 invert IO W2 ddr1_dqsn3 Data strobe 3 invert IO T22 ddr1_dqsn_ecc EMIF1 ECC Complementary Data strobe IO AB10 ddr1_dqs_ecc EMIF1 ECC Data strobe input/output. This signal is output to the EMIF1 memory when writing and input when reading. IO AA10 4.3.9 GPMC NOTE For more information, see the Memory Subsystem / General-Purpose Memory Controller section of the device TRM. Table 4-10. GPMC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME 48 DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL gpmc_ad0 GPMC Data 0 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 1 in A/D multiplexed mode IO E8 gpmc_ad1 GPMC Data 1 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 2 in A/D multiplexed mode IO A7 gpmc_ad2 GPMC Data 2 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 3 in A/D multiplexed mode IO F8 gpmc_ad3 GPMC Data 3 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 4 in A/D multiplexed mode IO B7 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-10. GPMC Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpmc_ad4 DESCRIPTION GPMC Data 4 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 5 in A/D multiplexed mode IO A6 gpmc_ad5 GPMC Data 5 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 6 in A/D multiplexed mode IO F7 gpmc_ad6 GPMC Data 6 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 7 in A/D multiplexed mode IO E7 gpmc_ad7 GPMC Data 7 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 8 in A/D multiplexed mode IO C6 gpmc_ad8 GPMC Data 8 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 9 in A/D multiplexed mode IO B6 gpmc_ad9 GPMC Data 9 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 10 in A/D multiplexed mode IO A5 gpmc_ad10 GPMC Data 10 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 11 in A/D multiplexed mode IO D6 gpmc_ad11 GPMC Data 11 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 12 in A/D multiplexed mode IO C5 gpmc_ad12 GPMC Data 12 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 13 in A/D multiplexed mode IO B5 gpmc_ad13 GPMC Data 13 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 14 in A/D multiplexed mode IO D7 gpmc_ad14 GPMC Data 14 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 15 in A/D multiplexed mode IO B4 gpmc_ad15 GPMC Data 15 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 16 in A/D multiplexed mode IO A4 gpmc_a0 GPMC Address 0. Only used to effectively address 8-bit data nonmultiplexed memories O U9 gpmc_a1 GPMC address 1 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 17 in A/D multiplexed mode O W11 gpmc_a2 GPMC address 2 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 18 in A/D multiplexed mode O V9 gpmc_a3 GPMC address 3 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 19 in A/D multiplexed mode O W9 gpmc_a4 GPMC address 4 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 20 in A/D multiplexed mode O U8 gpmc_a5 GPMC address 5 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 21 in A/D multiplexed mode O W8 gpmc_a6 GPMC address 6 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 22 in A/D multiplexed mode O U7 gpmc_a7 GPMC address 7 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 23 in A/D multiplexed mode O V7 gpmc_a8 GPMC address 8 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 24 in A/D multiplexed mode O J17 gpmc_a9 GPMC address 9 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 25 in A/D multiplexed mode O K22 gpmc_a10 GPMC address 10 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 26 in A/D multiplexed mode O K21 gpmc_a11 GPMC address 11 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O K18 gpmc_a12 GPMC address 12 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O D14, F13, F14, K17 gpmc_a13 GPMC address 13 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O C14, D15, E14, K19 gpmc_a14 GPMC address 14 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O K20 gpmc_a15 GPMC address 15 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O L21 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 49 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-10. GPMC Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpmc_a16 GPMC address 16 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O F14 gpmc_a17 GPMC address 17 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O C14 gpmc_a18 GPMC address 18 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O F15 gpmc_a19 GPMC address 19 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O F16 gpmc_a20 GPMC address 20 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O AA14 gpmc_a21 GPMC address 21 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O AB14 gpmc_a22 GPMC address 22 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O U13 gpmc_a23 GPMC address 23 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O V13 gpmc_a24 GPMC address 24 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O Y13 gpmc_a25 GPMC address 25 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O W13 gpmc_a26 GPMC address 26 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O U11 gpmc_a27 GPMC address 27 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 27 in A/D multiplexed mode O V11 gpmc_cs0 GPMC Chip Select 0 (active low) O C10 gpmc_cs1 GPMC Chip Select 1 (active low) O E10 gpmc_cs2 GPMC Chip Select 2 (active low) O D10 gpmc_cs3 GPMC Chip Select 3 (active low) O A9 gpmc_cs4 GPMC Chip Select 4 (active low) O B9 gpmc_cs5 GPMC Chip Select 5 (active low) O F10 gpmc_cs6 GPMC Chip Select 6 (active low) O C8 gpmc_cs7 GPMC Chip Select 7 (active low) O W6 GPMC Clock output IO C12, D14, F14, F15 gpmc_advn_ale GPMC address valid active low or address latch enable O F12 gpmc_oen_ren GPMC output enable active low or read enable O A10 gpmc_wen GPMC write enable active low O B10 gpmc_ben0 GPMC lower-byte enable active low O D12 gpmc_ben1 GPMC upper-byte enable active low O E12 gpmc_wait0 GPMC external indication of wait 0 I D8 gpmc_wait1 GPMC external indication of wait 1 I W7 gpmc_clk(1) DESCRIPTION (1) The gpio6_16.clkout0 signal can be used as an “always-on” alternative to gpmc_clk provided that the external device can support the associated timing. See Table 5-34 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load and Table 5-36 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads for timing information. 4.3.10 Timers NOTE For more information, see the Timers section of the device TRM. 50 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-11. Timers Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL timer1 DESCRIPTION PWM output/event trigger input IO D14, R7 timer2 PWM output/event trigger input IO D15, D6 timer3 PWM output/event trigger input IO C5, F14, L1 timer4 PWM output/event trigger input IO C14, C6, L2 timer5 PWM output/event trigger input IO E7, N4 timer6 PWM output/event trigger input IO F7, R5 timer7 PWM output/event trigger input IO B6, F15 timer8 PWM output/event trigger input IO F16 4.3.11 I2C NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / Multimaster I2C Controller / I2C Environment / I2C Pins for Typical Connections in I2C Mode section of the device TRM. Table 4-12. I2C Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface (I2C1) i2c1_scl I2C1 Clock IOD L3 i2c1_sda I2C1 Data IOD L4 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface (I2C2) i2c2_scl I2C2 Clock IOD L6 i2c2_sda I2C2 Data IOD L5 4.3.12 UART NOTE For more information see the Serial Communication Interface UART section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-45. Table 4-13. UART Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART1) uart1_ctsn UART1 clear to send active low I F14 uart1_rtsn UART1 request to send active low O C14 uart1_rxd UART1 Receive Data I F13 uart1_txd UART1 Transmit Data O E14 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART2) uart2_ctsn UART2 clear to send active low I F15 uart2_rtsn UART2 request to send active low O F16 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 51 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-13. UART Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL uart2_rxd DESCRIPTION UART2 Receive Data I D14, E7 uart2_txd UART2 Transmit Data O D15, F7 N4, U6 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART3) uart3_ctsn UART3 clear to send active low I uart3_rtsn UART3 request to send active low O R7, T5 uart3_rxd UART3 Receive Data I F14, L1, M2, W7 uart3_txd UART3 Transmit Data O C14, L2, R6, W6 4.3.13 McSPI NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (McSPI) section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are applicable for all combinations of signals for SPI2 and SPI4. However, the timings are only valid for SPI1 and SPI3 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-48. Table 4-14. SPI Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Serial Peripheral Interface 1 spi1_sclk SPI1 Clock IO M2 spi1_d0 SPI1 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO T5 spi1_d1 SPI1 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO U6 spi1_cs0 SPI1 Chip Select IO M1, R6 spi1_cs1 SPI1 Chip Select IO M1, R5 spi1_cs2 SPI1 Chip Select IO F14, W7 spi1_cs3 SPI1 Chip Select IO C14, W6 Serial Peripheral Interface 2 spi2_sclk SPI2 Clock IO L1 spi2_d0 SPI2 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO R7 spi2_d1 SPI2 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO N4 spi2_cs0 SPI2 Chip Select IO A4, L2 spi2_cs1 SPI2 Chip Select IO B4, M1 SPI3 Clock IO C6, F15 spi3_d0 SPI3 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO D15, E7 spi3_d1 SPI3 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO D14, F7 spi3_cs0 SPI3 Chip Select IO B6, F16, M1 spi3_cs1 SPI3 Chip Select IO A5, R5 SPI4 Clock IO C16, F14 SPI4 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO B17, E14 Serial Peripheral Interface 3 spi3_sclk Serial Peripheral Interface 4 spi4_sclk spi4_d0 52 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-14. SPI Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL spi4_d1 DESCRIPTION SPI4 Data. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO B19, F13 spi4_cs0 SPI4 Chip Select IO C14, C17 4.3.14 QSPI NOTE For more information see the Serial Communication Interface / Quad Serial Peripheral Interface section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-51. Table 4-15. QSPI Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL qspi1_sclk DESCRIPTION QSPI1 Serial Clock O C8 qspi1_rtclk QSPI1 Return Clock Input.Must be connected from QSPI1_SCLK on PCB. Refer to PCB Guidelines for QSPI1 I B7, C14, D8, F13 qspi1_d0 QSPI1 Data[0]. This pin is output data for all commands/writes and for dual read and quad read modes it becomes input data pin during read phase. IO B9 qspi1_d1 QSPI1 Data[1]. Input read data in all modes. IO F10 qspi1_d2 QSPI1 Data[2]. This pin is used only in quad read mode as input data pin during read phase IO A9 qspi1_d3 QSPI1 Data[3]. This pin is used only in quad read mode as input data pin during read phase IO D10 qspi1_cs0 QSPI1 Chip Select[0]. This pin is used for QSPI1 boot modes. IO E10 qspi1_cs1 QSPI1 Chip Select[1] IO F15 4.3.15 McASP NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-58. Table 4-16. McASP Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Multichannel Audio Serial Port 1 mcasp1_axr0 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO W16 mcasp1_axr1 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO V16 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 53 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-16. McASP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL mcasp1_axr2 DESCRIPTION McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO U15 mcasp1_axr3 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO V15 mcasp1_axr4 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO Y15 mcasp1_axr5 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO W15 mcasp1_axr6 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO AA15 mcasp1_axr7 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO AB15 mcasp1_axr8 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO AA14, U15, U9 AB14, V15, W11 mcasp1_axr9 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO mcasp1_axr10 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO U13, V9, Y15 mcasp1_axr11 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO V13, W15, W9 mcasp1_axr12 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO AA15, U8, Y13 mcasp1_axr13 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO AB15, W13, W8 mcasp1_axr14 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO K20, U11, U7 mcasp1_axr15 McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data IO L21, V11, V7 mcasp1_fsx McASP1 Transmit Frame Sync IO W17 McASP1 Receive Bit Clock IO AA17 McASP1 Receive Frame Sync IO U16 mcasp1_aclkr mcasp1_fsr mcasp1_ahclkx McASP1 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock O U9 mcasp1_aclkx McASP1 Transmit Bit Clock IO U17 Multichannel Audio Serial Port 2 mcasp2_axr0 McASP2 Transmit/Receive Data IO D6, V9 mcasp2_axr1 McASP2 Transmit/Receive Data IO C5, W9 mcasp2_axr2 McASP2 Transmit/Receive Data IO B5, U8 mcasp2_axr3 McASP2 Transmit/Receive Data IO D7, W8 mcasp2_axr4 McASP2 Transmit/Receive Data IO B4, U7 mcasp2_axr5 McASP2 Transmit/Receive Data IO A4, V7 mcasp2_fsx McASP2 Transmit Frame Sync IO E7, V11 McASP2 Receive Bit Clock IO B6, W13 McASP2 Receive Frame Sync IO A5, W11 mcasp2_ahclkx McASP2 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock O C6, Y13 mcasp2_aclkx McASP2 Transmit Bit Clock IO F7, U11 mcasp2_aclkr mcasp2_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 3 mcasp3_axr0 McASP3 Transmit/Receive Data IO G19 mcasp3_axr1 McASP3 Transmit/Receive Data IO G18 mcasp3_axr2 McASP3 Transmit/Receive Data IO G21 mcasp3_axr3 McASP3 Transmit/Receive Data IO G22 mcasp3_axr4 McASP3 Transmit/Receive Data IO H18 mcasp3_axr5 McASP3 Transmit/Receive Data IO H20 mcasp3_fsx McASP3 Transmit Frame Sync IO H22 mcasp3_ahclkx McASP3 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock O H19 mcasp3_aclkx McASP3 Transmit Bit Clock IO F22 mcasp3_aclkr McASP3 Receive Bit Clock IO F20 McASP3 Receive Frame Sync IO F19 mcasp3_fsr 54 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 4.3.16 DCAN and MCAN NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / DCAN section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-61. Table 4-17. DCAN and MCAN Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL DCAN 1 dcan1_rx DCAN1 receive data pin IO C14, D15, N6 dcan1_tx DCAN1 transmit data pin IO D14, F14, N5 mcan_rx MCAN receive data pin IO E14, F16, W6 mcan_tx MCAN transmit data pin IO F13, F15, W7 MCAN 4.3.17 GMAC_SW NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interfaces / Gigabit Ethernet Switch (GMAC_SW) section of the device TRM. Table 4-18. GMAC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL rgmii0_rxc RGMII0 Receive Clock I B18 rgmii0_rxctl RGMII0 Receive Control I C18 rgmii0_rxd0 RGMII0 Receive Data I A20 rgmii0_rxd1 RGMII0 Receive Data I C20 rgmii0_rxd2 RGMII0 Receive Data I B20 rgmii0_rxd3 RGMII0 Receive Data I A19 rgmii0_txc RGMII0 Transmit Clock O C16 rgmii0_txctl RGMII0 Transmit Enable O C17 rgmii0_txd0 RGMII0 Transmit Data O F17 rgmii0_txd1 RGMII0 Transmit Data O E17 rgmii0_txd2 RGMII0 Transmit Data O D16 rgmii0_txd3 RGMII0 Transmit Data O E16 rgmii1_rxc RGMII1 Receive Clock I D7 C10 rgmii1_rxctl RGMII1 Receive Control I rgmii1_rxd0 RGMII1 Receive Data I F8 rgmii1_rxd1 RGMII1 Receive Data I A7 rgmii1_rxd2 RGMII1 Receive Data I E8 rgmii1_rxd3 RGMII1 Receive Data I D8 RGMII1 Transmit Clock O C12 rgmii1_txc Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 55 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-18. GMAC Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL rgmii1_txctl RGMII1 Transmit Enable O D12 rgmii1_txd0 RGMII1 Transmit Data O B10 rgmii1_txd1 RGMII1 Transmit Data O A10 rgmii1_txd2 RGMII1 Transmit Data O F12 rgmii1_txd3 RGMII1 Transmit Data O E12 Management Data IO B17 Management Data Serial Clock O B19 mdio_d mdio_mclk DESCRIPTION 4.3.18 SDIO Controller NOTE For more information, see the SDIO Controller section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-76. Table 4-19. SDIO Controller Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL MMC1 clock IO B18, C16, W16 Multi Media Card 1 mmc_clk mmc_cmd MMC1 command IO C17, C18, V16 mmc_dat0 MMC1 data bit 0 IO A19, E16, U15 mmc_dat1 MMC1 data bit 1 IO B20, D16, V15 mmc_dat2 MMC1 data bit 2 IO C20, E17, Y15 mmc_dat3 MMC1 data bit 3 IO A20, F17, W15 4.3.19 GPIO NOTE For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface section of the device TRM. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-77. Table 4-20. GPIOs Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL GPIO 1 56 gpio1_0 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C12 gpio1_1 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D12 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-20. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio1_2 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output IO E12 gpio1_3 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F12 gpio1_4 General-Purpose Input/Output IO A10 gpio1_5 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B10 gpio1_6 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C10 gpio1_7 General-Purpose Input/Output IO E10 gpio1_8 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D10 A9 gpio1_9 General-Purpose Input/Output IO gpio1_10 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B9 gpio1_11 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F10 gpio1_12 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C8 gpio1_13 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D8 gpio1_14 General-Purpose Input/Output IO E8 gpio1_15 General-Purpose Input/Output IO A7 gpio1_16 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F8 gpio1_17 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B7 gpio1_18 General-Purpose Input/Output IO A6 gpio1_19 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F7 gpio1_20 General-Purpose Input/Output IO E7 gpio1_21 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C6 gpio1_22 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B6 gpio1_23 General-Purpose Input/Output IO A5 gpio1_24 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D6 gpio1_25 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C5 gpio1_26 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B5 gpio1_27 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D7 gpio1_28 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B4 gpio1_29 General-Purpose Input/Output IO A4 gpio1_30 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F22 gpio1_31 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F21 gpio2_0 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F20 gpio2_1 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F19 gpio2_2 General-Purpose Input/Output IO G19 gpio2_3 General-Purpose Input/Output IO G18 gpio2_4 General-Purpose Input/Output IO G21 gpio2_5 General-Purpose Input/Output IO G22 gpio2_6 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H18 gpio2_7 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H20 gpio2_8 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H19 gpio2_9 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H22 gpio2_10 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H21 gpio2_11 General-Purpose Input/Output IO J17 gpio2_12 General-Purpose Input/Output IO K22 gpio2_13 General-Purpose Input/Output IO K21 gpio2_14 General-Purpose Input/Output IO K18 gpio2_15 General-Purpose Input/Output IO K17 GPIO 2 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 57 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-20. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio2_16 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output IO K19 gpio2_17 General-Purpose Input/Output IO K20 gpio2_18 General-Purpose Input/Output IO L21 gpio2_19 General-Purpose Input/Output IO L22 gpio2_20 General-Purpose Input/Output IO AB17 gpio2_21 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U17 gpio2_22 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W17 gpio2_23 General-Purpose Input/Output IO AA17 gpio2_24 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U16 gpio2_25 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W16 gpio2_26 General-Purpose Input/Output IO V16 gpio2_27 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U15 gpio2_28 General-Purpose Input/Output IO V15 gpio2_29 General-Purpose Input/Output IO Y15 gpio2_30 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W15 gpio2_31 General-Purpose Input/Output IO AA15 gpio3_0 General-Purpose Input/Output IO AB15 gpio3_1 General-Purpose Input/Output IO AA14 gpio3_2 General-Purpose Input/Output IO AB14 gpio3_3 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U13 gpio3_4 General-Purpose Input/Output IO V13 gpio3_5 General-Purpose Input/Output IO Y13 gpio3_6 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W13 gpio3_7 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U11 gpio3_8 General-Purpose Input/Output IO V11 gpio3_9 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U9 gpio3_10 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W11 gpio3_11 General-Purpose Input/Output IO V9 gpio3_12 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W9 gpio3_13 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U8 gpio3_14 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W8 gpio3_15 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U7 gpio3_16 General-Purpose Input/Output IO V7 gpio3_17 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B19 gpio3_18 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B17 gpio3_19 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C16 gpio3_20 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C17 gpio3_21 General-Purpose Input/Output IO E16 gpio3_22 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D16 gpio3_23 General-Purpose Input/Output IO E17 gpio3_24 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F17 gpio3_25 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B18 gpio3_26 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C18 gpio3_27 General-Purpose Input/Output IO A19 gpio3_28 General-Purpose Input/Output IO B20 gpio3_29 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C20 GPIO 3 58 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-20. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio3_30 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output IO A20 gpio3_31 General-Purpose Input/Output IO M1 gpio4_0 General-Purpose Input/Output IO M2 gpio4_1 General-Purpose Input/Output IO U6 gpio4_2 General-Purpose Input/Output IO T5 gpio4_3 General-Purpose Input/Output IO R6 gpio4_4 General-Purpose Input/Output IO R5 gpio4_5 General-Purpose Input/Output IO L1 gpio4_6 General-Purpose Input/Output IO N4 gpio4_7 General-Purpose Input/Output IO R7 gpio4_8 General-Purpose Input/Output IO L2 gpio4_9 General-Purpose Input/Output IO N5 gpio4_10 General-Purpose Input/Output IO N6 gpio4_11 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W7 gpio4_12 General-Purpose Input/Output IO W6 gpio4_13 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F13 gpio4_14 General-Purpose Input/Output IO E14 gpio4_15 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F14 gpio4_16 General-Purpose Input/Output IO C14 gpio4_17 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D14 gpio4_18 General-Purpose Input/Output IO D15 gpio4_19 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F15 gpio4_20 General-Purpose Input/Output IO F16 gpio4_21 General-Purpose Input/Output IO M17 gpio4_22 General-Purpose Input/Output IO M18 gpio4_25 General-Purpose Input/Output IO J1 gpio4_26 General-Purpose Input/Output IO J4 gpio4_27 General-Purpose Input/Output IO J6 gpio4_28 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H1 gpio4_29 General-Purpose Input/Output IO H2 GPIO 4 4.3.20 ePWM NOTE For more information, see Pulse Width Modulation Subsystem (PWMSS) section of the device TRM. Table 4-21. PWM Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL PWMSS1 ehrpwm1A EHRPWM1 Output A O D12, D14, L1 ehrpwm1B EHRPWM1 Output B O D15, E12, L2 EHRPWM1 Trip Zone Input IO F12, R5 ECAP1 Capture Input / PWM Output IO A5, AB15, D16, F16, N4 I A10, F14 ehrpwm1_tripzone_input eCAP1_in_PWM1_out ehrpwm1_synci EHRPWM1 Sync Input Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 59 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-21. PWM Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION ehrpwm1_synco EHRPWM1 Sync Output TYPE BALL O B10, C14 4.3.21 Emulation and Debug Subsystem NOTE For more information, see the On-Chip Debug Support section of the device TRM. Table 4-22. Debug Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL rtck JTAG return clock O J6 tclk JTAG test clock I J2 tdi JTAG test data I J1 tdo JTAG test port data O J4 tms JTAG test port mode select. An external pullup resistor should be used on this ball. IO J3 trstn JTAG test reset I J5 emu0 Emulator pin 0 IO H1 emu1 Emulator pin 1 IO H2 emu2 Emulator pin 2 O AA15 emu3 Emulator pin 3 O AB15 emu4 Emulator pin 4 O AA14 emu5 Emulator pin 5 O AB14 emu6 Emulator pin 6 O U13 emu7 Emulator pin 7 O V13 emu8 Emulator pin 8 O Y13 emu9 Emulator pin 9 O W13 emu10 Emulator pin 10 O U11 emu11 Emulator pin 11 O V11 emu12 Emulator pin 12 O U9 emu13 Emulator pin 13 O W11 emu14 Emulator pin 14 O V9 emu15 Emulator pin 15 O W9 emu16 Emulator pin 16 O U8 emu17 Emulator pin 17 O W8 emu18 Emulator pin 18 O U7 emu19 Emulator pin 19 O V7 4.3.22 System and Miscellaneous 4.3.22.1 Sysboot NOTE For more information, see the Initialization (ROM Code) section of the device TRM. 60 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-23. Sysboot Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL sysboot0 DESCRIPTION Boot Mode Configuration 0. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I E8 sysboot1 Boot Mode Configuration 1. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I A7 sysboot2 Boot Mode Configuration 2. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I F8 sysboot3 Boot Mode Configuration 3. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I B7 sysboot4 Boot Mode Configuration 4. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I A6 sysboot5 Boot Mode Configuration 5. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I F7 sysboot6 Boot Mode Configuration 6. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I E7 sysboot7 Boot Mode Configuration 7. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I R7 sysboot8 Boot Mode Configuration 8. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I B6 sysboot9 Boot Mode Configuration 9. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I A5 sysboot10 Boot Mode Configuration 10. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I D6 sysboot11 Boot Mode Configuration 11. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I C5 sysboot12 Boot Mode Configuration 12. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I B5 sysboot13 Boot Mode Configuration 13. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I D7 sysboot14 Boot Mode Configuration 14. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I B4 sysboot15 Boot Mode Configuration 15. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I A4 4.3.22.2 Power, Reset and Clock Management (PRCM) NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management section of the device TRM. Table 4-24. PRCM Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL clkout0 Device Clock output 1. Can be used externally for devices with non-critical timing requirements, or for debug, or as a reference clock on GPMC as described in Table 5-34 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load and Table 5-36 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads. O AB17, C12, F14, F22, M1 clkout1 Device Clock output 2. Can be used as a system clock for other devices. O F12, F21, U17 clkout2 Device Clock output 3. Can be used as a system clock for other devices. O A10, F20, W17 rstoutn Reset out (Active low). This pin asserts low in response to any global reset condition on the device. O F4 resetn Device Reset Input I G4 Power on Reset (active low). This pin must be asserted low until all device supplies are valid (see reset sequence/requirements). I G3 External Reference Clock 0. For Audio and other Peripherals. I M1 porz xref_clk0 DESCRIPTION Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 61 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-24. PRCM Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL xref_clk1 DESCRIPTION External Reference Clock 1. For Audio and other Peripherals. I F14, F15 xref_clk2 External Reference Clock 2. For Audio and other Peripherals. I H19 xi_osc0 System Oscillator OSC0 Crystal input / LVCMOS clock input. Functions as the input connection to a crystal when the internal oscillator OSC0 is used. Functions as an LVCMOS-compatible input clock when an external oscillator is used. I E22 xi_osc1 Auxiliary Oscillator OSC1 Crystal input / LVCMOS clock input. Functions as the input connection to a crystal when the internal oscillator OSC1 is used. Functions as an LVCMOS-compatible input clock when an external oscillator is used I B21 xo_osc0 System Oscillator OSC0 Crystal output O D22 xo_osc1 Auxiliary Oscillator OSC1 Crystal output O C21 4.3.22.3 Enhanced Direct Memory Access (EDMA) NOTE For more information, see the DMA Controllers / Enhanced DMA section of the device TRM. Table 4-25. EDMA Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL dma_evt1 DESCRIPTION Enhanced DMA Event Input 1 I C12, K17 dma_evt2 Enhanced DMA Event Input 2 I D12, K19 dma_evt3 Enhanced DMA Event Input 3 I E12 dma_evt4 Enhanced DMA Event Input 4 I F12, D8 TYPE BALL Non maskable interrupt input - active-low. This pin can be optionally routed to the DSP NMI input or as generic input to the ARM cores. I G5 sys_nirq1 External interrupt event to any device INTC I K18, K22 sys_nirq2 External interrupt event to any device INTC I J17, K21 4.3.22.4 Interrupt Controllers (INTC) NOTE For more information, see the Interrupt Controllers section of the device TRM. Table 4-26. INTC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME nmin DESCRIPTION 4.3.23 Power Supplies NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Subsystem Environment / External Voltage Inputs section of the device TRM. Table 4-27. Power Supply Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME vdd 62 DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Core voltage domain supply PWR H7 , H12 , H13 , J10 , J11 , J15 , K12 , L12 , L15 , N12 , N16 , P10 , P14 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-27. Power Supply Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME vss vdd_dspeve vdda_per vdda_ddr_dsp vdda_gmac_core DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Ground GND A1 , A8 , A17 , A22 , B22 , E1 , G10 , G16 , H8 , H9 , H10 , H11 , H15 , H16 , J22 , K1 , K9 , K10 , K11 , K13 , K14 , K15 , K16 , M10 , M11 , M12 , M13 , M16 , N7 , N10 , P1 , P15 , P16 , R9 , R12 , R16 , T14 , V22 , AB1 , AB2 , AB7 , AB12 , AB16 , AB21 , AB22 DSP-EVE voltage domain supply PWR K8 , L8 , M9 , P8 , P9 , P11 , P12 PER PLL and PER HSDIVIDER analog power supply PWR H14 EVE PLL, DPLL_DDR and DDR HSDIVIDER analog power supply PWR N8 GMAC PLL, GMAC HSDIVIDER, DPLL_CORE and CORE HSDIVIDER analog power supply PWR M8 vdda_osc IO supply for oscillator section PWR E21 vssa_osc0 OSC0 analog ground GND D21 vssa_osc1 OSC1 analog ground GND C22 vdda_csi CSI analog power supply PWR A14 vssa_csi CSI analog ground GND B14 vdda_dac DAC analog power supply PWR U19 vssa_dac DAC analog ground GND T19 vdda_adc ADC analog power supply PWR P22 vssa_adc ADC analog ground GND P21 vdds18v 1.8V power supply and Power Group bias supply PWR G12, J7, L16, P13, T11 vdds18v_ddr1 1.8v bias supply for Byte0, Byte2, ECC Byte, Addr Cmd PWR P7, T9 vdds18v_ddr2 1.8v bias supply for Addr Cmd PWR G7 vdds18v_ddr3 1.8v bias supply for Byte1, Byte3 PWR T16, V21 vdds_ddr1 IO power supply for Byte0, Byte2, ECC Byte, Addr Cmd PWR R1, T7, T8, AA1, AB6 vdds_ddr2 IO power supply for Addr Cmd PWR C2, E2, G6 vdds_ddr3 IO power supply for Byte1, Byte3 PWR T15, AA22, AB19 vddshv1 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the GENERAL Power Group pins PWR K2, K7, L7, M7 vddshv2 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the GPMC Power Group pins PWR G8, G9, G11, B8 vddshv3 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the UART1 and UART2 Power Group pins PWR G14 vddshv4 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the RGMII Power Group pins PWR A18, E20 vddshv5 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VIN1 Power Group pins PWR H17, J16, J21 vddshv6 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VOUT1 Power Group pins PWR T10, T12, T13, AA16 cap_vddram_core1(1) SRAM array supply for core voltage domain memories CAP N15 cap_vddram_core2(1) SRAM array supply for core voltage domain memories CAP M15 SRAM array supply for DSP-EVE memories CAP M14 cap_vddram_dspeve(1) Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 63 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to vss. 64 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 4.4 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Pin Multiplexing Table 4-28 describes the device pin multiplexing (no characteristics are provided in this table). NOTE Table 4-28, Pin Multiplexing doesn't take into account subsystem multiplexing signals. Subsystem multiplexing signals are described in Section 4.3, Signal Descriptions. NOTE For more information, see the Control Module / Control Module Functional Description / Pad Configuration Registers section of the Device TRM. NOTE Configuring two pins to the same input signal is not supported as it can yield unexpected results. This can be easily prevented with the proper software configuration (Hi-Z mode is not an input signal). NOTE When a pad is set into a pin multiplexing mode which is not defined by pin multiplexing, that pad’s behavior is undefined. This should be avoided. NOTE In some cases Table 4-28 may present more than one signal per muxmode for the same ball. First signal in the list is the dominant function as selected via CTRL_CORE_PAD_* register. All other signals are virtual functions that present alternate multiplexing options. This virtual functions are controlled via CTRL_CORE_ALT_SELECT_MUX or CTRL_CORE_VIP_MUX_SELECT register. For more information on how to use this options, please refer to Device TRM, Chapter Control Module, Section Pad Configuration Registers. CAUTION The IO timings provided in Section 5.9, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the corresponding tables. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 65 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing ADDRESS 66 REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 E22 xi_osc0 N2 ddr1_a7 AB4 ddr1_d4 W1 ddr1_dqs2 U3 ddr1_d20 C1 ddr1_a1 M19 adc_in0 U1 ddr1_a9 Y6 ddr1_d7 A15 csi2_0_dx3 V1 ddr1_a15 AA2 ddr1_d17 T1 ddr1_a8 R3 ddr1_a11 AA3 ddr1_d16 Y1 ddr1_d23 Y17 ddr1_d14 AA20 ddr1_dqs1 AA6 ddr1_d0 F3 ddr1_cke0 Y20 ddr1_dqsn1 N21 adc_in5 T2 ddr1_a6 W2 ddr1_dqsn2 E3 ddr1_wen P18 adc_in7 AA11 ddr1_ecc_d 2 B3 ddr1_ba0 T17 cvideo_tvout W22 ddr1_d30 B21 xi_osc1 V3 ddr1_d21 T20 ddr1_d25 A11 csi2_0_dx0 G2 ddr1_nck U21 ddr1_d24 Y9 ddr1_ecc_d 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 Terminal Configuration and Functions 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 R21 ddr1_d26 U4 ddr1_a0 AB18 ddr1_d15 A3 ddr1_ba1 D2 ddr1_ba2 B15 csi2_0_dy3 AA21 ddr1_d10 AA8 ddr1_d1 B13 csi2_0_dy2 AB8 ddr1_dqm0 M22 adc_in3 D1 ddr1_a10 Y3 ddr1_d18 C21 xo_osc1 M20 adc_in1 R22 ddr1_d28 AA9 ddr1_ecc_d 6 N3 ddr1_a5 P2 ddr1_odt0 T4 ddr1_a4 AB10 ddr1_dqsn_ ecc AB3 ddr1_dqm2 AA12 ddr1_ecc_d 1 AA4 ddr1_d6 T18 cvideo_rset N22 adc_in4 R4 ddr1_a3 V20 ddr1_d29 AB13 ddr1_dqm_e cc AA5 ddr1_dqs0 A16 csi2_0_dx4 R2 ddr1_a14 Y2 ddr1_d22 Y21 ddr1_d9 W21 ddr1_dqm3 P20 adc_vrefp 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 15 67 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS 68 REGISTER NAME MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS BALL NUMBER 0 Y5 ddr1_d5 F2 ddr1_casn AB20 ddr1_d13 B11 csi2_0_dy0 AB9 ddr1_ecc_d 7 D22 xo_osc0 U2 ddr1_a12 P19 adc_in6 AA18 ddr1_d8 U22 ddr1_d31 Y18 ddr1_dqm1 A13 csi2_0_dx2 T22 ddr1_dqsn3 G1 ddr1_ck P17 cvideo_vfb G3 porz T21 ddr1_dqs3 Y22 ddr1_d11 AA19 ddr1_d12 AB5 ddr1_dqsn0 U20 ddr1_d27 AA13 ddr1_ecc_d 4 B16 csi2_0_dy4 F1 ddr1_rasn D3 ddr1_a2 AA10 ddr1_dqs_e cc AA7 ddr1_d3 B2 ddr1_csn0 N1 ddr1_rst V2 ddr1_d19 Y8 ddr1_d2 B12 csi2_0_dy1 C3 ddr1_a13 A12 csi2_0_dx1 AB11 ddr1_ecc_d 5 M21 adc_in2 1 2 3 4 5 6 Terminal Configuration and Functions 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER Y11 MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 ddr1_ecc_d 0 0x1400 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C12 GPMC_CLK gpmc_clk rgmii1_txc 0x1404 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D12 GPMC_BEN0 gpmc_ben0 rgmii1_txctl 0x1408 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E12 GPMC_BEN1 0x140C dma_evt1 gpio1_0 Driver off ehrpwm1A dma_evt2 gpio1_1 Driver off gpmc_ben1 rgmii1_txd3 ehrpwm1B dma_evt3 gpio1_2 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F12 GPMC_ADVN_ALE gpmc_advn_ rgmii1_txd2 ale ehrpwm1_tri clkout1 pzone_input dma_evt4 gpio1_3 Driver off 0x1410 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A10 GPMC_OEN_REN gpmc_oen_r rgmii1_txd1 en ehrpwm1_sy clkout2 nci gpio1_4 Driver off 0x1414 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B10 GPMC_WEN gpmc_wen rgmii1_txd0 ehrpwm1_sy nco gpio1_5 Driver off 0x1418 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C10 GPMC_CS0 gpmc_cs0 rgmii1_rxctl gpio1_6 Driver off 0x141C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E10 GPMC_CS1 gpmc_cs1 qspi1_cs0 gpio1_7 Driver off 0x1420 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D10 GPMC_CS2 gpmc_cs2 qspi1_d3 gpio1_8 Driver off 0x1424 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A9 GPMC_CS3 gpmc_cs3 qspi1_d2 gpio1_9 Driver off 0x1428 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B9 GPMC_CS4 gpmc_cs4 qspi1_d0 gpio1_10 Driver off 0x142C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F10 GPMC_CS5 gpmc_cs5 qspi1_d1 gpio1_11 Driver off 0x1430 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C8 GPMC_CS6 gpmc_cs6 qspi1_sclk gpio1_12 Driver off 0x1434 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D8 GPMC_WAIT0 gpmc_wait0 rgmii1_rxd3 qspi1_rtclk gpio1_13 Driver off 0x1438 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E8 GPMC_AD0 gpmc_ad0 rgmii1_rxd2 gpio1_14 sysboot0 0x143C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A7 GPMC_AD1 gpmc_ad1 rgmii1_rxd1 gpio1_15 sysboot1 0x1440 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F8 GPMC_AD2 gpmc_ad2 rgmii1_rxd0 gpio1_16 sysboot2 0x1444 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B7 GPMC_AD3 gpmc_ad3 qspi1_rtclk gpio1_17 sysboot3 0x1448 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A6 GPMC_AD4 gpmc_ad4 cam_strobe gpio1_18 sysboot4 0x144C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F7 GPMC_AD5 gpmc_ad5 uart2_txd timer6 spi3_d1 gpio1_19 sysboot5 mcasp2_acl kx 0x1450 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E7 GPMC_AD6 gpmc_ad6 uart2_rxd timer5 spi3_d0 gpio1_20 sysboot6 mcasp2_fsx 0x1454 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C6 GPMC_AD7 gpmc_ad7 timer4 spi3_sclk gpio1_21 Driver off mcasp2_ahc lkx cam_shutter clkout0 dma_evt4 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 69 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 0x1458 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B6 GPMC_AD8 gpmc_ad8 timer7 spi3_cs0 gpio1_22 sysboot8 mcasp2_acl kr 0x145C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A5 GPMC_AD9 gpmc_ad9 eCAP1_in_P spi3_cs1 WM1_out gpio1_23 sysboot9 mcasp2_fsr 0x1460 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D6 GPMC_AD10 gpmc_ad10 timer2 gpio1_24 sysboot10 mcasp2_axr 0 0x1464 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C5 GPMC_AD11 gpmc_ad11 timer3 gpio1_25 sysboot11 mcasp2_axr 1 0x1468 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B5 GPMC_AD12 gpmc_ad12 gpio1_26 sysboot12 mcasp2_axr 2 0x146C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D7 GPMC_AD13 gpmc_ad13 rgmii1_rxc gpio1_27 sysboot13 mcasp2_axr 3 0x1470 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B4 GPMC_AD14 gpmc_ad14 spi2_cs1 gpio1_28 sysboot14 mcasp2_axr 4 0x1474 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A4 GPMC_AD15 gpmc_ad15 spi2_cs0 gpio1_29 sysboot15 mcasp2_axr 5 0x1478 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F22 VIN1A_CLK0 vin1a_clk0 cpi_pclk clkout0 gpio1_30 Driver off mcasp3_acl kx 0x147C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F21 VIN1A_DE0 vin1a_de0 cpi_hsync vin1b_clk1 clkout1 gpio1_31 Driver off 0x1480 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F20 VIN1A_FLD0 vin1a_fld0 cpi_vsync vin2b_clk1 clkout2 gpio2_0 Driver off mcasp3_acl kr 0x1484 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F19 VIN1A_HSYNC0 vin1a_hsync cpi_data0 0 vin1a_de0 gpio2_1 Driver off mcasp3_fsr 0x1488 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ G19 VIN1A_VSYNC0 vin1a_vsync cpi_data1 0 gpio2_2 Driver off mcasp3_axr 0 0x148C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ G18 VIN1A_D0 vin1a_d0 cpi_data2 gpio2_3 Driver off mcasp3_axr 1 0x1490 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ G21 VIN1A_D1 vin1a_d1 cpi_data3 gpio2_4 Driver off mcasp3_axr 2 0x1494 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ G22 VIN1A_D2 vin1a_d2 cpi_data4 gpio2_5 Driver off mcasp3_axr 3 0x1498 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H18 VIN1A_D3 vin1a_d3 cpi_data5 gpio2_6 Driver off mcasp3_axr 4 0x149C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H20 VIN1A_D4 vin1a_d4 cpi_data6 gpio2_7 Driver off mcasp3_axr 5 70 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 0x14A0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H19 VIN1A_D5 vin1a_d5 cpi_data7 gpio2_8 xref_clk2 mcasp3_ahc lkx 0x14A4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H22 VIN1A_D6 vin1a_d6 cpi_data8 gpio2_9 Driver off mcasp3_fsx 0x14A8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H21 VIN1A_D7 vin1a_d7 cpi_data9 gpio2_10 Driver off 0x14AC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J17 VIN1A_D8 vin1a_d8 cpi_data10 vin1b_d0 gpmc_a8 sys_nirq2 gpio2_11 Driver off 0x14B0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ K22 VIN1A_D9 vin1a_d9 cpi_data11 vin1b_d1 gpmc_a9 sys_nirq1 gpio2_12 Driver off 0x14B4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ K21 VIN1A_D10 vin1a_d10 cpi_data12 vin1b_d2 gpmc_a10 sys_nirq2 gpio2_13 Driver off 0x14B8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ K18 VIN1A_D11 vin1a_d11 cpi_data13 vin1b_d3 gpmc_a11 sys_nirq1 gpio2_14 Driver off 0x14BC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ K17 VIN1A_D12 vin1a_d12 cpi_data14 vin1b_d4 gpmc_a12 dma_evt1 gpio2_15 Driver off 0x14C0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ K19 VIN1A_D13 vin1a_d13 cpi_wen vin1b_d5 gpmc_a13 dma_evt2 gpio2_16 Driver off 0x14C4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ K20 VIN1A_D14 vin1a_d14 cpi_fid vin1b_d6 gpmc_a14 gpio2_17 Driver off 0x14C8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L21 VIN1A_D15 vin1a_d15 cpi_data15 vin1b_d7 gpmc_a15 gpio2_18 Driver off 0x14CC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L22 VIN2A_CLK0 vin2a_clk0 gpio2_19 Driver off 0x14D0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ M17 VIN2A_DE0 vin2a_de0 cam_strobe vin2b_hsync 1 gpio4_21 Driver off 0x14D4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ M18 VIN2A_FLD0 vin2a_fld0 cam_shutter vin2b_vsync 1 gpio4_22 Driver off 0x14D8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ AB17 VOUT1_CLK vout1_clk vin1a_d12 clkout0 gpio2_20 Driver off 0x14DC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U17 VOUT1_DE vout1_de mcasp1_acl vin1a_d13 kx clkout1 gpio2_21 Driver off 0x14E0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W17 VOUT1_FLD vout1_fld mcasp1_fsx vin1a_d14 clkout2 gpio2_22 Driver off 0x14E4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ AA17 VOUT1_HSYNC vout1_hsync mcasp1_acl vin1a_d15 kr vin2a_de0 gpio2_23 Driver off 0x14E8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U16 VOUT1_VSYNC vout1_vsync mcasp1_fsr vin2a_fld0 gpio2_24 Driver off 0x14EC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W16 VOUT1_D0 vout1_d0 mcasp1_axr 0 mmc_clk gpio2_25 Driver off 0x14F0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ V16 VOUT1_D1 vout1_d1 mcasp1_axr 1 mmc_cmd gpio2_26 Driver off 0x14F4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U15 VOUT1_D2 vout1_d2 mcasp1_axr 2 mcasp1_axr mmc_dat0 8 gpio2_27 Driver off 0x14F8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ V15 VOUT1_D3 vout1_d3 mcasp1_axr 3 mcasp1_axr mmc_dat1 9 gpio2_28 Driver off vin2b_de1 vin2a_clk0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 71 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 1 2 3 4 5 0x14FC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ Y15 VOUT1_D4 vout1_d4 mcasp1_axr 4 mcasp1_axr mmc_dat2 10 0x1500 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W15 VOUT1_D5 vout1_d5 mcasp1_axr 5 mcasp1_axr mmc_dat3 11 0x1504 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ AA15 VOUT1_D6 vout1_d6 mcasp1_axr 6 mcasp1_axr 12 0x1508 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ AB15 VOUT1_D7 vout1_d7 mcasp1_axr 7 0x150C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ AA14 VOUT1_D8 vout1_d8 0x1510 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ AB14 VOUT1_D9 0x1514 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 gpio2_29 Driver off vin2a_clk0 gpio2_30 Driver off emu2 vin2a_de0 gpio2_31 Driver off eCAP1_in_P mcasp1_axr WM1_out 13 emu3 vin2a_fld0 gpio3_0 Driver off mcasp1_axr vin2a_d0 8 gpmc_a20 emu4 gpio3_1 Driver off vout1_d9 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d1 9 gpmc_a21 emu5 gpio3_2 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U13 VOUT1_D10 vout1_d10 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d2 10 gpmc_a22 emu6 gpio3_3 Driver off 0x1518 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ V13 VOUT1_D11 vout1_d11 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d3 11 gpmc_a23 emu7 gpio3_4 Driver off 0x151C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ Y13 VOUT1_D12 vout1_d12 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d4 12 gpmc_a24 emu8 gpio3_5 Driver off mcasp2_ahc lkx 0x1520 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W13 VOUT1_D13 vout1_d13 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d5 13 gpmc_a25 emu9 gpio3_6 Driver off mcasp2_acl kr 0x1524 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U11 VOUT1_D14 vout1_d14 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d6 14 gpmc_a26 emu10 gpio3_7 Driver off mcasp2_acl kx 0x1528 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ V11 VOUT1_D15 vout1_d15 mcasp1_axr vin2a_d7 15 gpmc_a27 emu11 gpio3_8 Driver off mcasp2_fsx 0x152C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U9 VOUT1_D16 vout1_d16 mcasp1_ahc vin2a_d8 lkx gpmc_a0 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d0 8 emu12 gpio3_9 Driver off 0x1530 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W11 VOUT1_D17 vout1_d17 vin2a_d9 gpmc_a1 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d1 9 emu13 gpio3_10 Driver off mcasp2_fsr 0x1534 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ V9 VOUT1_D18 vout1_d18 vin2a_d10 gpmc_a2 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d2 10 emu14 gpio3_11 Driver off mcasp2_axr 0 0x1538 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W9 VOUT1_D19 vout1_d19 vin2a_d11 gpmc_a3 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d3 11 emu15 gpio3_12 Driver off mcasp2_axr 1 0x153C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U8 VOUT1_D20 vout1_d20 vin2a_d12 gpmc_a4 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d4 12 emu16 gpio3_13 Driver off mcasp2_axr 2 0x1540 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W8 VOUT1_D21 vout1_d21 vin2a_d13 gpmc_a5 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d5 13 emu17 gpio3_14 Driver off mcasp2_axr 3 0x1544 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U7 VOUT1_D22 vout1_d22 vin2a_d14 gpmc_a6 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d6 14 emu18 gpio3_15 Driver off mcasp2_axr 4 0x1548 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ V7 VOUT1_D23 vout1_d23 vin2a_d15 gpmc_a7 mcasp1_axr vin2b_d7 15 emu19 gpio3_16 Driver off mcasp2_axr 5 72 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS 0 1 2 3 4 0x154C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W7 MCAN_TX mcan_tx vin2a_de0 vin2a_hsync spi1_cs2 0 uart3_rxd 0x1550 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ W6 MCAN_RX mcan_rx cam_nreset vin2a_vsync spi1_cs3 0 uart3_txd 0x1554 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B19 MDIO_MCLK mdio_mclk 0x1558 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B17 MDIO_D mdio_d 0x155C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C16 RGMII0_TXC rgmii0_txc cam_strobe spi4_sclk 0x1560 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C17 RGMII0_TXCTL rgmii0_txctl cam_shutter spi4_cs0 0x1564 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E16 RGMII0_TXD3 rgmii0_txd3 0x1568 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D16 RGMII0_TXD2 rgmii0_txd2 0x156C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E17 RGMII0_TXD1 0x1570 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 gpio4_11 Driver off gpio4_12 Driver off spi4_d1 gpio3_17 Driver off spi4_d0 gpio3_18 Driver off mmc_clk gpio3_19 Driver off mmc_cmd gpio3_20 Driver off mmc_dat0 gpio3_21 Driver off mmc_dat1 gpio3_22 Driver off rgmii0_txd1 mmc_dat2 gpio3_23 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F17 RGMII0_TXD0 rgmii0_txd0 mmc_dat3 gpio3_24 Driver off 0x1574 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B18 RGMII0_RXC rgmii0_rxc cam_strobe mmc_clk gpio3_25 Driver off 0x1578 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C18 RGMII0_RXCTL rgmii0_rxctl cam_shutter mmc_cmd gpio3_26 Driver off 0x157C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A19 RGMII0_RXD3 rgmii0_rxd3 mmc_dat0 gpio3_27 Driver off 0x1580 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ B20 RGMII0_RXD2 rgmii0_rxd2 mmc_dat1 gpio3_28 Driver off 0x1584 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C20 RGMII0_RXD1 rgmii0_rxd1 mmc_dat2 gpio3_29 Driver off 0x1588 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ A20 RGMII0_RXD0 rgmii0_rxd0 mmc_dat3 gpio3_30 Driver off 0x158C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ M1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 clkout0 gpio3_31 Driver off 0x1590 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ M2 SPI1_SCLK spi1_sclk uart3_rxd gpio4_0 Driver off 0x1594 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ U6 SPI1_D1 spi1_d1 uart3_ctsn gpio4_1 Driver off 0x1598 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ T5 SPI1_D0 spi1_d0 uart3_rtsn gpio4_2 Driver off 0x159C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ R6 SPI1_CS0 spi1_cs0 uart3_txd gpio4_3 Driver off 0x15A0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ R5 SPI1_CS1 spi1_cs1 spi3_cs1 gpio4_4 Driver off 0x15A4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L1 SPI2_SCLK spi2_sclk uart3_rxd gpio4_5 Driver off 0x15A8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ N4 SPI2_D1 spi2_d1 uart3_ctsn gpio4_6 Driver off eCAP1_in_P WM1_out spi3_cs0 timer6 ehrpwm1A gpmc_wait1 vin1b_hsync vin1b_de1 1 gpmc_cs7 spi2_cs1 vin1b_vsync 1 spi1_cs0 spi1_cs1 ehrpwm1_tri pzone_input timer3 timer5 eCAP1_in_P WM1_out Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 73 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS BALL NUMBER 0 1 0x15AC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ R7 SPI2_D0 spi2_d0 uart3_rtsn 0x15B0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L2 SPI2_CS0 spi2_cs0 uart3_txd 0x15B8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ N6 DCAN1_RX 0x15C4 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 timer1 gpio4_7 sysboot7 timer4 gpio4_8 Driver off dcan1_rx gpio4_10 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD_ N5 DCAN1_TX dcan1_tx gpio4_9 Driver off 0x15BC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F13 UART1_RXD uart1_rxd spi4_d1 0x15C0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ E14 UART1_TXD uart1_txd spi4_d0 0x15C4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F14 UART1_CTSN uart1_ctsn 0x15C8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ C14 UART1_RTSN uart1_rtsn 0x15CC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D14 UART2_RXD uart2_rxd 0x15D0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ D15 UART2_TXD uart2_txd 0x15D4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F15 UART2_CTSN uart2_ctsn 0x15D8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F16 UART2_RTSN uart2_rtsn 0x15DC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L4 I2C1_SDA i2c1_sda 0x15E0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L3 I2C1_SCL i2c1_scl 0x15E4 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L5 I2C2_SDA i2c2_sda 0x15E8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ L6 I2C2_SCL i2c2_scl 0x15EC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J3 TMS tms 0x15F0 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J1 TDI 0x15F4 xref_clk1 ehrpwm1B qspi1_rtclk gpmc_a12 mcan_tx gpio4_13 Driver off gpmc_a13 mcan_rx gpio4_14 Driver off dcan1_tx gpio4_15 Driver off dcan1_rx gpio4_16 Driver off gpmc_a12 dcan1_tx gpio4_17 Driver off gpmc_a13 dcan1_rx gpio4_18 Driver off uart3_rxd gpmc_a16 spi4_sclk spi1_cs2 timer3 ehrpwm1_sy clkout0 nci vin2a_hsync gpmc_a12 0 uart3_txd gpmc_a17 spi4_cs0 spi1_cs3 timer4 ehrpwm1_sy qspi1_rtclk nco vin2a_vsync gpmc_a13 0 spi3_d1 timer1 ehrpwm1A spi3_d0 timer2 ehrpwm1B timer7 vin2a_hsync gpmc_clk 0 mcan_tx gpio4_19 Driver off timer8 vin2a_vsync 0 mcan_rx gpio4_20 Driver off tdi gpio4_25 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J4 TDO tdo gpio4_26 Driver off 0x15F8 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J2 TCLK tclk 0x15FC CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J5 TRSTN trstn 0x1600 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ J6 RTCK rtck gpio4_27 Driver off 0x1604 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H1 EMU0 emu0 gpio4_28 Driver off 0x1608 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ H2 EMU1 emu1 gpio4_29 Driver off 74 xref_clk1 eCAP1_in_P WM1_out gpmc_a18 spi3_sclk gpmc_a19 spi3_cs0 qspi1_cs1 gpmc_clk gpmc_clk Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 4-28. Pin Multiplexing (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME MUXMODE[15:0] SETTINGS BALL NUMBER 0 0x160C CTRL_CORE_PAD_ G4 RESETN resetn 0x1610 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ G5 NMIN nmin 0x1614 CTRL_CORE_PAD_ F4 RSTOUTN rstoutn 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 1. NA in table stands for Not Applicable. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 75 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 4.5 www.ti.com Connections for Unused Pins This section describes the connection requirements of the unused and reserved balls. NOTE The following balls are reserved: A2 / F6 / A21 / B1 These balls must be left unconnected. NOTE All unused power supply balls must be supplied with the voltages specified in the Section 5.4, Recommended Operating Conditions, unless alternative tie-off options are included in Section 4.3, Signal Descriptions. Table 4-29. Unused Balls Specific Connection Requirements Balls Connection Requirements B21 / E22 / J5/ AA10 These balls must be connected to GND through an external pull resistor if unused J2 / G5 / G4 / L3 / L4 / AB10 / J3 These balls must be connect to the corresponding power supply through an external pull resistor if unused M19 / M20 / M21 / M22 / N22 / N21 / P19 / P18 / P20 These balls must be connected together to GND through a single external 10k-ohm resistor if unused. NOTE All other unused signal balls with a Pad Configuration Register can be left unconnected with their internal pullup or pulldown resistor enabled. NOTE All other unused signal balls without Pad Configuration Register can be left unconnected. 76 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5 Specifications NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset and Clock Management / PRCM Subsystem Environment / External Voltage Inputs or Initialization / Preinitialization / Power Requirements section of the Device TRM. NOTE The index number 1 which is part of the EMIF1 signal prefixes (ddr1_*) listed in Section 4.3.8, EMIF, column "SIGNAL NAME" are not to be confused with DDR1 type of SDRAM memories. NOTE Audio Back End (ABE) module is not supported for this family of devices, but “ABE” name is still present in some clock or DPLL names. CAUTION All IO Cells are NOT Fail-safe compliant and should not be externally driven in absence of their IO supply. 5.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER(3) VSUPPLY (Steady-State) VIO (Steady-State) Supply Voltage Ranges (SteadyState) Input and Output Voltage Ranges (Steady-State) MIN MAX UNIT Core (vdd, vdd_dspeve) -0.3 1.5 V Analog (vdda_per, vdda_ddr_dsp, vdda_gmac_core, vdda_osc, vdda_csi, vdda_dac, vdda_adc) -0.3 2.0 V vdds_ddr1, vdds_ddr2, vdds_ddr3 (1.35V mode) -0.3 1.65 V vdds_ddr1, vdds_ddr2, vdds_ddr3 (1.5V mode) -0.3 1.8 V vdds18v, vdds18v_ddr1, vdds18v_ddr2, vdds18v_ddr3 -0.3 2.1 V vddshv1-6 (1.8V mode) -0.3 2.1 V vddshv1-6 (3.3V mode) -0.3 3.8 V Core I/Os -0.3 1.5 V Analog I/Os -0.3 2.0 V I/O 1.35V -0.3 1.65 V I/O 1.5V -0.3 1.8 V 1.8V I/Os -0.3 2.1 V 3.3V I/Os -0.3 3.8 V 105 V/s 0.2*VDD V -40 +125 °C -55 +150 °C I-test(5), All I/Os (if different levels then one line per level) -100 100 mA Over-voltage Test(6), All supplies (if different levels then one line per level) N/A 1.5*Vsup ply max V SR Maximum slew rate, all supplies VIO (Transient Overshoot / Undershoot) Input and Output Voltage Ranges (Transient Overshoot / Undershoot) Note: valid for up to 20% of the signal period TJ Operating junction temperature range TSTG Storage temperature range after soldered onto PC Board Latch-up I-Test Latch-up OV-Test Automotive (4) Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 77 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) Stresses beyond those listed as absolute maximum ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those listed under Section 5.4, Recommended Operating Conditions, is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. (2) All voltage values are with respect to VSS, unless otherwise noted. (3) See I/Os supplied by this power pin in Table 4-1 Ball Characteristics. (4) VDD is the voltage on the corresponding power-supply pin(s) for the IO. (5) Per JEDEC JESD78 at 125°C with specified I/O pin injection current and clamp voltage of 1.5 times maximum recommended I/O voltage and negative 0.5 times maximum recommended I/O voltage. (6) Per JEDEC JESD78 at 125°C. 5.2 ESD Ratings VALUE Human-Body model (HBM), per AEC Q100-002(1) VESD Electrostatic discharge Charged-device model (CDM), per AEC Q100-011 UNIT ±1000 All pins ±250 Corner pins (A1, AB1, A22, AB22) ±750 V (1) AEC Q100-002 indicates that HBM stressing shall be in accordance with the ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001 specification. 5.3 Power on Hour (POH) Limits IP Duty Cycle Voltage Domain All 100% All Voltage (V) (max) Frequency (MHz) (max) All Support OPPs Tj(°C) POH Automotive Profile(1) 20000 (1) Automotive profile is defined as 20000 power on hours with junction temperature as follows: 5%@-40°C, 65%@70°C, 20%@110°C, 10%@125°C. (2) The information in this section is provided solely for your convenience and does not extend or modify the warranty provided under TI’s standard terms and conditions for TI semiconductor products. (3) POH is a functional of voltage, temperature and time. Usage at higher voltages and temperatures will result in a reduction in POH to achieve the same reliability performance. For assessment of alternate use cases, contact your local TI representative. 78 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 5.4 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Recommended Operating Conditions over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN (2) NOM MAX DC (3) MAX (2) UNIT Input Power Supply Voltage Range vdd Core voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 vdd_dspeve DSP-EVE voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 vdda_per PER PLL and PER HSDIVIDER analog power supply 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_ddr_dsp EVE PLL, DPLL_DDR and DDR HSDIVIDER analog power supply GMAC PLL, GMAC HSDIVIDER, DPLL_CORE and CORE HSDIVIDER analog power supply I/O supply for oscillator section CSI analog power supply DAC analog power supply ADC analog power supply 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 1.8V power supply and Power Group bias supply 1.8v bias supply for Byte0, Byte2, ECC Byte, Addr Cmd 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 1.8v bias supply for Addr Cmd 1.71 1.80 1.8v bias supply for Byte1, Byte3 1.71 1.80 1.89 V mVPPmax V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 1.836 1.89 1.836 1.89 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds_ddr1 1.836 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds18v_ddr3 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds18v_ddr2 1.836 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds18v_ddr1 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds18v 1.836 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_adc 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_dac 1.836 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_csi 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_osc V 1.836 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_gmac_core V V mVPPmax 50 V mVPPmax EMIF power supply (1.5V for DDR3 mode / 1.35V DDR3L mode) 1.35-V Mode 1.28 1.35 1.377 1.42 1.5-V Mode 1.43 1.50 1.53 1.57 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.35-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 1.5-V Mode vdds_ddr2 EMIF power supply (1.5V for DDR3 mode / 1.35V DDR3L mode) 1.35-V Mode 1.28 1.35 1.377 1.42 1.5-V Mode 1.43 1.50 1.53 1.57 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.35-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 1.5-V Mode vdds_ddr3 EMIF power supply (1.5V for DDR3 mode / 1.35V DDR3L mode) 1.35-V Mode 1.28 1.35 1.377 1.42 1.5-V Mode 1.43 1.50 1.53 1.57 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.35-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 1.5-V Mode Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 79 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER vddshv1 vddshv2 vddshv3 vddshv4 vddshv5 vddshv6 DESCRIPTION MIN (2) NOM MAX DC (3) MAX (2) UNIT V Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the GENERAL Power Group pins 1.8-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.3-V Mode 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.8-V Mode 50 mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for 3.3-V Mode the GPMC Power Group pins 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.8-V Mode 50 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the UART1 and UART2 Power Group pins 1.8-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.3-V Mode 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the RGMII Power Group pins 1.8-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.3-V Mode 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VIN1 Power Group pins 1.8-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.3-V Mode 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VOUT1 Power Group pins 1.8-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.3-V Mode 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.8-V Mode V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode vss Ground supply 0 V vssa_osc0 OSC0 analog ground 0 V vssa_osc1 OSC1 analog ground 0 V vssa_csi CSI analog ground supply 0 V vssa_dac DAC analog ground supply 0 V vssa_adc ADC analog ground supply 0 V (1) TJ Operating junction temperature range Automotive -40 125 °C (1) Refer to Power on Hours table for limitations. (2) The voltage at the device ball should never be below the MIN voltage or above the MAX voltage for any amount of time. This requirement includes dynamic voltage events such as AC ripple, voltage transients, voltage dips, etc. (3) The DC voltage at the device ball should never be above the MAX DC voltage to avoid impact on device reliability and lifetime POH (Power-On-Hours). The MAX DC voltage is defined as the highest allowed DC regulated voltage, without transients, seen at the ball. (4) Logic functions and parameter values are not assured out of the range specified in the recommended operating conditions. 80 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 5.5 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Operating Performance Points This section describes the operating conditions of the device. This section also contains the description of each OPP (operating performance point) for processor clocks and device core clocks. Table 5-1 describes the maximum supported frequency per speed grade for the devices. Table 5-1. Speed Grade Maximum Frequency Device Speed Maximum frequency (MHz) DM505xxR 5.5.1 DSP EVE IPU ISS L3 DDR3/DDR3L DDR2 LPDDR2 ADC 745 667 212.8 212.8 266 532 (DDR-1066) 400 (DDR-800) 333 (DDR-667) 20 AVS Requirements Adaptive Voltage Scaling (AVS) is required on most of the vdd_* supplies as defined in Table 5-2. Table 5-2. AVS Requirements per vdd_* Supply 5.5.2 Supply AVS Required? vdd Yes, for all OPPs vdd_dspeve Yes, for all OPPs Voltage And Core Clock Specifications Table 5-3 shows the recommended OPP per voltage domain. Table 5-3. Voltage Domains Operating Performance Points DOMAIN CONDITION BOOT (Before AVS is enabled) (4) VD_CORE (V) After AVS is enabled (4) BOOT (Before AVS is enabled) (4) VD_DSPEVE (V) After AVS is enabled (4) OPP_NOM OPP_OD NOM (1) MAX (2) 1.02 1.06 1.11 Not Applicable Not Applicable AVS Voltage 1.11 Not Applicable Not Applicable 1.06 1.11 Not Applicable Not Applicable AVS Voltage (5) – 3.5% 1.02 AVS Voltage (5) – 3.5% (5) AVS Voltage (5) 1.11 MIN (2) AVS Voltage (5) – 3.5% NOM (1) OPP_HIGH MIN (2) AVS Voltage (5) MAX (2) AVS Voltage (5) + 5% MIN (2) AVS Voltage (5) – 3.5% NOM (1) MAX DC (3) AVS Voltage (5) AVS Voltage (5) + 2% MAX (2) AVS Voltage + 5% (5) (1) In a typical implementation, the power supply should target the NOM voltage. (2) The voltage at the device ball should never be below the MIN voltage or above the MAX voltage for any amount of time. This requirement includes dynamic voltage events such as AC ripple, voltage transients, voltage dips, etc. (3) The DC voltage at the device ball should never be above the MAX DC voltage to avoid impact on device reliability and lifetime POH (Power-On-Hours). The MAX DC voltage is defined as the highest allowed DC regulated voltage, without transients, seen at the ball. (4) For all OPPs, AVS must be enabled to avoid impact on device reliability, lifetime POH (Power-On-Hours), and device power. (5) The AVS voltages are device-dependent, voltage domain-dependent, and OPP-dependent. They must be read from the STD_FUSE_OPP. For information about STD_FUSE_OPP Registers address, please refer to Control Module Section of the TRM. The power supply should be adjustable over the following ranges for each required OPP: – OPP_NOM: 0.85V - 1.06V – OPP_OD: 0.94V - 1.15V – OPP_HIGH: 1.05V - 1.25V The AVS Voltages will be within the above specified ranges. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 81 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-4 describes the standard processor clocks speed characteristics vs OPP of the device. Table 5-4. Supported OPP vs Max Frequency(2) DESCRIPTION OPP_NOM OPP_OD OPP_HIGH Max Freq. (MHz) Max Freq. (MHz) Max Freq. (MHz) DSP_CLK 500 709 745 EVE_FCLK 500 667 667 CORE_IPU1_CLK 212.8 N/A N/A ISS 212.8 N/A N/A 266 N/A N/A DDR3 / DDR3L 532 (DDR-1066) N/A N/A DDR2 400 (DDR-800) N/A N/A LPPDR2 333 (DDR-667) N/A N/A 20 N/A N/A VD_DSPEVE VD_CORE L3_CLK ADC (1) N/A in this table stands for Not Applicable. (2) Maximum supported frequency is limited according to the Device Speed Grade (see Table 5-1). 5.5.3 Maximum Supported Frequency Device modules either receive their clock directly from an external clock input, directly from a PLL, or from a PRCM. Table 5-5 lists the clock source options for each module on this device, along with the maximum frequency that module can accept. To ensure proper module functionality, the device PLLs and dividers must be programmed not to exceed the maximum frequencies listed in this table. 82 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name ADC OCP_CLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ADC_CLK Func 20 ADC_GFCLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE CSI2 SCPCLK Int & Func 106.4 ISS_MAIN_FCLK CORE_ISS_MAIN_ CLK DPLL_CORE COUNTER_32K COUNTER_32K_F CLK Func 0.032 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_CLK1/610 OSC1 COUNTER_32K_I CLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 CTRL_MODULE_ L3INSTR_TS_GCL BANDGAP K Int 5 L3INSTR_TS_GCL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 CTRL_MODULE_ L4CFG_L4_GICLK CORE Int 133 L4CFG_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE CTRL_MODULE_ WKUP WKUPAON_GICL K Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 DCAN1 DCAN1_FCLK Func 20 DCAN1_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 SYS_CLK2 OSC1 SYS_CLK1 OSC0 MCAN DCAN1_ICLK Int 133 WKUPAON_GICL K MCAN_FCLK Func 20 MCAN_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 MCAN_ICLK Int 133 L4PER2_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE DLL EMIF_DLL_FCLK Func 266 EMIF_DLL_GCLK EMIF_DLL_GCLK DPLL_DDR DSP1 DSP1_FICLK Int & Func DSP_CLK DSP1_GFCLK DSP_GFCLK DPLL_DSP DSP2 DSP2_FICLK Int & Func DSP_CLK DSP2_GFCLK DSP_GFCLK DPLL_DSP DSS DSS_FCK_CLK Int & Func 192 DSS_GFCLK DSS_GFCLK DPLL_PER DSS_VP_CLK Func 165 VID_PIX_CLK VID_PIX_CLK DPLL_EVE_VID_D SP DISPC_FCK_CLK Int & Func 192 DSS_GFCLK DSS_GFCLK DPLL_PER DISPC_CLK1 Int 165 VID_PIX_CLK VID_PIX_CLK DPLL_EVE_VID_D SP ocp_clk Int 133 CUSTEFUSE_L4_ GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE sys_clk Func 38.4 CUSTEFUSE_SYS _GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ELM_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE DSS DISPC EFUSE_CTRL_C UST ELM EMIF_OCP_FW EMIF_PHY EMIF EVE L3_CLK Int 266 EMIF_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_CLKEN Int 133 EMIF_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE EMIF_PHY1_FCLK Func DDR EMIF_PHY_GCLK EMIF_PHY_GCLK DPLL_DDR DPLL_CORE EMIF_ICLK Int 266 EMIF_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK EMIF_L3_ICLK Int 266 L3_EOCP_GICLK - - EMIF_PHY_FCLK Func 532 EMIF_PHY_GCLK EMIF_PHY_GCLK DPLL_DDR EMIF_DLL_FCLK Int 266 EMIF_DLL_GCLK - DPLL_DDR EVE_FCLK Func EVE_FCLK EVE_GFCLK EVE_GCLK DPLL_DSP EVE_GFCLK DPLL_EVE Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 83 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name GMAC_SW CPTS_RFT_CLK Func 266 GMAC_RFT_CLK L3_ICLK DPLL_CORE MAIN_CLK Int 125 GMAC_MAIN_CLK GMAC_250M_CLK DPLL_GMAC MHZ_250_CLK Func 250 GMII_250MHZ_CL K DPLL_GMAC SYS_CLK1 GPIO1 GPIO2 GPIO3 GPIO4 GPMC I2C1 I2C2 GMII_250MHZ_CL K OSC0 MHZ_5_CLK Func 5 RGMII_5MHZ_CLK RGMII_5MHZ_CLK MHZ_50_CLK Func 50 RMII_50MHZ_CLK GMAC_RMII_HS_ CLK DPLL_GMAC RMII_CLK GPIO1_ICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 GPIO1_DBCLK Func 0.032 WKUPAON_SYS_ GFCLK WKUPAON_32K_ GFCLK OSC0 DPLL_CORE GPIO2_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK GPIO2_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 GPIO3_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE GPIO3_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 GPIO4_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE GPIO4_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 GPMC_ICLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GIC LK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE I2C1_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE I2C1_FCLK Func 96 PER_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER DPLL_CORE I2C2_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK I2C2_FCLK Func 96 PER_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER IEEE1500_2_OC P PI_L3CLK Int & Func 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE IPU1 IPU1_GFCLK Int & Func IPU_CLK IPU1_GFCLK L3_INSTR 84 SYS_CLK1 OSC0 CORE_IPU_ISS_B OOST_CLK DPLL_CORE L3_CLK Int L3_CLK L3INSTR_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_CFG L4_CFG_CLK Int 133 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_PER1 L4_PER1_CLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_PER2 L4_PER2_CLK Int 133 L4PER2_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_PER3 L4_PER3_CLK Int 133 L4PER3_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_WKUP L4_WKUP_CLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 MAILBOX1 MAILBOX1_FLCK Int 133 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX2 MAILBOX2_FLCK Int 133 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name MCASP1 MCASP1_AHCLK R Func 100 MCASP1_AHCLK R ABE_24M_GFCLK DPLL_DDR MCASP1_AHCLKX MCASP1_FCLK MCASP1_ICLK Func Func Int 100 10 133 ABE_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 FUNC_24M_GFCL K DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ATL_CLK0 Module ATL ATL_CLK1 Module ATL ATL_CLK2 Module ATL ATL_CLK3 Module ATL SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 REF_CLKIN0 XREF_CLK1 REF_CLKIN1 XREF_CLK2 REF_CLKIN2 MCASP1_AHCLKX ABE_24M_GFCLK MCASP1_AUX_GF CLK IPU_L3_GICLK DPLL_DDR ABE_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 FUNC_24M_GFCL K DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ATL_CLK0 Module ATL ATL_CLK1 Module ATL ATL_CLK2 Module ATL ATL_CLK3 Module ATL SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 REF_CLKIN0 XREF_CLK1 REF_CLKIN1 XREF_CLK2 REF_CLKIN2 L4_ICLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC0 CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 85 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name MCASP2 MCASP2_AHCLK R Func 100 MCASP6_AHCLK R ABE_24M_GFCLK DPLL_DDR MCASP2_AHCLKX MCASP2_FCLK MCASP2_ICLK 86 Func Func Int 100 10 133 ABE_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 FUNC_24M_GFCL K DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ATL_CLK0 Module ATL ATL_CLK1 Module ATL ATL_CLK2 Module ATL ATL_CLK3 Module ATL SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 REF_CLKIN0 XREF_CLK1 REF_CLKIN1 XREF_CLK2 REF_CLKIN2 MCASP4_AHCLKX ABE_24M_GFCLK MCASP4_AUX_GF CLK IPU_L3_GICLK Specifications DPLL_DDR ABE_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 FUNC_24M_GFCL K DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ATL_CLK0 Module ATL ATL_CLK1 Module ATL ATL_CLK2 Module ATL ATL_CLK3 Module ATL SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 REF_CLKIN0 XREF_CLK1 REF_CLKIN1 XREF_CLK2 REF_CLKIN2 L4_ICLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC0 CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name MCASP3 MCASP3_AHCLK R Func 100 MCASP7_AHCLK R ABE_24M_GFCLK DPLL_DDR MCASP3_AHCLKX MCASP3_FCLK McSPI1 McSPI2 McSPI3 McSPI4 MMC1 Func Func 100 10 SYS_CLK1 DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ATL_CLK0 Module ATL ATL_CLK1 Module ATL ATL_CLK2 Module ATL ATL_CLK3 Module ATL SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 REF_CLKIN0 XREF_CLK1 REF_CLKIN1 XREF_CLK2 REF_CLKIN2 MCASP5_AHCLKX ABE_24M_GFCLK MCASP5_AUX_GF CLK DPLL_DDR ABE_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 FUNC_24M_GFCL K DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC0 ATL_CLK0 Module ATL ATL_CLK1 Module ATL ATL_CLK2 Module ATL ATL_CLK3 Module ATL SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 REF_CLKIN0 XREF_CLK1 REF_CLKIN1 XREF_CLK2 REF_CLKIN2 L4_ICLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC0 MCASP3_ICLK Int 133 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER SPI1_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER SPI1_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER SPI1_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER MMC1_CLK_32K Func 0.032 L3INIT_32K_GFCL K FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 MMC1_FCLK Func 192 MMC1_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER 128 MMU_EDMA ABE_SYS_CLK FUNC_24M_GFCL K FUNC_128M_CLK DPLL_PER MMC1_ICLK1 Int 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC1_ICLK2 Int 266 L3INIT_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMU1_CLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GIC LK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 87 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name OCMC_RAM1 OCMC_L3_CLK_1 Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GIC LK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCP_WP_NOC PICLKOCPL3 Int 266 L3INSTR_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCP2SCP1 L4CFG_ADAPTER _CLKIN_1 Int 133 L3INIT_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE PWMSS1 PWMSS1_GICLK Int & Func 133 L4PER2_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE QSPI QSPI_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE QSPI_FCLK Func 128 QSPI_GFCLK FUNC_128M_CLK DPLL_PER PER_QSPI_CLK DPLL_PER VID_PIX_CLK DPLL_EVE_VID_D SP SD_DAC CLKDAC Func 50 VID_PIX_CLK SL2 piclk Int IVA_GCLK IVA_GCLK IVA_GFCLK DPLL_IVA SMARTREFLEX_ CORE MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GI CLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 SMARTREFLEX_ DSPEVE MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GI CLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 SPINLOCK SPINLOCK_ICLK Int 133 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER1 TIMER1_ICLK Int 133 WKUPAON_GICL K SYS_CLK1 OSC0 TIMER1_FCLK Func 38.4 TIMER1_GFCLK TIMER2 TIMER3 TIMER4 88 TIMER2_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK TIMER2_FCLK Func 100 TIMER2_GFCLK TIMER3_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK TIMER3_FCLK Func 100 TIMER3_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 TIMER4_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER4_FCLK Func 100 TIMER4_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K Specifications SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-5. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) Module Clock Sources Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name TIMER5 TIMER5_ICLK Int 133 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER5_FCLK Func 100 TIMER5_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 CLKOUTMUX0_CL CLKOUTMUX0_CL K K TIMER6 TIMER6_ICLK Int 133 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER6_FCLK Func 100 TIMER6_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 CLKOUTMUX0_CL CLKOUTMUX0_CL K K TIMER7 TIMER7_ICLK Int 133 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER7_FCLK Func 100 TIMER7_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 CLKOUTMUX0_CL CLKOUTMUX0_CL K K TIMER8 TIMER8_ICLK Int 133 IPU_L3_GICLK TIMER8_FCLK Func 100 TIMER8_GFCLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC0 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC0 SYS_CLK2 OSC1 XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 CLKOUTMUX0_CL CLKOUTMUX0_CL K K TPCC TPCC_GCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GIC LK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TPTC1 TPTC0_GCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GIC LK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TPTC2 TPTC1_GCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GIC LK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART1 UART1_FCLK Func 48 UART1_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART1_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART2 UART2_FCLK Func 48 UART2_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART2_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART3 UART3_FCLK Func 48 UART3_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART3_ICLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE VIP1 L3_CLK_PROC_C LK Int & Func 266 VIP1_GCLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE CORE_ISS_MAIN_ CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 89 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.6 www.ti.com Power Consumption Summary NOTE Maximum power consumption for this SoC depends on the specific use conditions for the end system. Contact your TI representative for assistance in estimating maximum power consumption for the end system use case. 5.7 Electrical Characteristics NOTE The data specified in Table 5-6 through Table 5-11 are subject to change. NOTE The interfaces or signals described in Table 5-6 through Table 5-11 correspond to the interfaces or signals available in multiplexing mode 0 (Function 1). All interfaces or signals multiplexed on the balls described in these tables have the same DC electrical characteristics, unless multiplexing involves a PHY/GPIO combination in which case different DC electrical characteristics are specified for the different multiplexing modes (Functions). Table 5-6. LVCMOS DDR DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0 (Single-Ended Signals) ABF: ddr1_d[31:0], ddr1_a[15:0], ddr1_dqm[3:0], ddr1_ba[2:0], ddr1_csn[1:0], ddr1_cke[1:0], ddr1_odt[0], ddr1_casn, ddr1_rasn, ddr1_wen, ddr1_rst, ddr1_ecc_d[7:0], ddr1_dqm_ecc; Driver Mode VOH High-level output threshold (IOH = 0.1 mA) VOL Low-level output threshold (IOL = 0.1 mA) CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) ZO Output impedance (drive strength) 0.9*VDDS V l[2:0] = 000 (Imp80) 80 l[2:0] = 001 (Imp60) 60 l[2:0] = 010 (Imp48) 48 l[2:0] = 011 (Imp40) 40 l[2:0] = 100 (Imp34) 34 0.1*VDDS V 3 pF Ω Single-Ended Receiver Mode VIH High-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L VREF+0.1 VDDS+0.2 V VIL Low-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L -0.2 VREF-0.1 V VCM Input common-mode voltage VREF -1%VDDS VREF+ 1%VDDS V CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) pF Signal Names in MUXMODE 0 (Differential Signals): ddr1_dqs[3:0], ddr1_dqsn[3:0], ddr1_ck, ddr1_nck, ddr1_dqs_ecc, ddr1_dqsn_ecc; Driver Mode 90 VOH High-level output threshold (IOH = 0.1 mA) VOL Low-level output threshold (IOL = 0.1 mA) CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 0.9*VDDS Specifications V 0.1*VDDS V 3 pF Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-6. LVCMOS DDR DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER ZO Output impedance (drive strength) MIN NOM l[2:0] = 000 (Imp80) 80 l[2:0] = 001 (Imp60) 60 l[2:0] = 010 (Imp48) 48 l[2:0] = 011 (Imp40) 40 l[2:0] = 100 (Imp34) 34 MAX UNIT Ω Single-Ended Receiver Mode VIH High-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L VREF+0.1 VDDS+0.2 V VIL Low-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L -0.2 VREF-0.1 V VCM Input common-mode voltage VREF -1%VDDS VREF+ 1%VDDS V CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 3 pF 0.4*vdds 0.6*vdds V VREF -1%VDDS VREF+ 1%VDDS V 3 pF Differential Receiver Mode VSWING Input voltage swing DDR3/DDR3L VCM Input common-mode voltage CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply (i.e. vdds_ddr1 or vdds_ddr2). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-1, POWER [10] column. (2) For more information on the I/O cell configurations (i[2:0], sr[1:0]), see Control Module section of the Device TRM. Table 5-7. Dual Voltage LVCMOS I2C DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: i2c2_scl; i2c1_scl; i2c1_sda; i2c2_sda; Balls ABF: L3, L4, L6, L5; I2C Standard Mode – 1.8 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS 0.1*VDDS V V II Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS 12 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) at each IO pin. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 12 µA CI Input capacitance 10 pF VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.2*VDDS tOF 0.2*VDDS 3 Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 5 pF to 400 pF V mA 250 ns I2C Fast Mode – 1.8 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis II 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS V 12 µA 0.1*VDDS Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS V Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 91 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-7. Dual Voltage LVCMOS I2C DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) at each IO pin. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ CI Input capacitance VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.2*VDDS tOF Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 10 pF to 400 pF NOM MAX UNIT 12 µA 10 pF 0.2*VDDS 3 V mA 20+0.1*Cb 250 ns I2C Standard Mode – 3.3 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS 0.05*VDD S V V II Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS 31 80 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) at each IO pin. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 31 80 µA CI pF Input capacitance 10 VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current 0.4 IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.4V 3 IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.6V for full drive load (400pF/400KHz) 6 tOF V mA mA Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 5 pF to 400 pF 250 ns I2C Fast Mode – 3.3 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS 0.05*VDD S V V II Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS 31 80 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) at each IO pin. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 31 80 µA CI Input capacitance 10 pF VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current 0.4 V IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.4V 3 IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.6V for full drive load (400pF/400KHz) 6 tOF Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 10 pF to 200 pF (Proper External Resistor Value should be used as per I2C spec) Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 300 pF to 400 pF (Proper External Resistor Value should be used as per I2C spec) mA mA 20+0.1*Cb 250 40 290 ns (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply (i.e. vddshv3). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-1, POWER [10] column. (2) For more information on the I/O cell configurations, see the Control Module section of the Device TRM. Table 5-8. IQ1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: tclk; Balls ABF: J2; 92 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-8. IQ1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold 0.75 * VDDS VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) V 0.25 * VDDS V 100 mV 2 11 µA 1 pF 3.3-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold 2.0 VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) V 0.6 V 400 mV 5 11 µA 1 pF (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply (i.e. vddshv1). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-1, POWER [10] column. Table 5-9. IHHV1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: porz; Balls ABF: G3; 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold 1.2 VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) V 0.4 V 40 mV 0.02 1 µA 1 pF 3.3-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold 1.2 VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage 40 IIN Input current at each I/O pin 5 CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) V 0.4 V mV 8 µA 1 pF Table 5-10. LVCMOS Analog OSC Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: xi_osc0, xo_osc0, xi_osc1, xo_osc1; Balls ABF: E22, D22, B21, C21; VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold IOH IOL VHYS Input hysteresis voltage 0.65*VDDS V 0.35*VDDS V hfenable=0 1.18 mA hfenable=1 2 mA hfenable=0 2 mA hfenable=1 3.2 mA MODE-1 150 mV Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 93 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-10. LVCMOS Analog OSC Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER CPAD DESCRIPTION MIN Capacitance connected on input and output Pad on Board, CL1=CL2 NOM 12 MAX UNIT 24 pF (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply (i.e. vdda_osc). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-1, POWER [10] column. Table 5-11. LVCMOS CSI2 DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT 1350 mV 550 mV 880 mV Signals MUXMODE0 : csi2_0_dx[4:0]; csi2_0_dy[4:0]; Bottom Balls: A11 / B11 / A12 / B12 / A13 / B13 / A15 / B15 / A16 / B16 MIPI D-PHY Mode Low-Power Receiver (LP-RX) VIH Input high-level voltage VIL Input low-level voltage 880 VITH Input high-level threshold VITL Input low-level threshold 550 mV VHYS Input hysteresis 25 mV MIPI D-PHY Mode Ultralow Power Receiver (ULP-RX) VIH Input high-level voltage VIL Input low-level voltage 880 mV VITH Input high-level threshold VITL Input low-level threshold 300 mV VHYS Input hysteresis 25 mV 300 mV 880 mV MIPI D-PHY Mode High-Speed Receiver (HS-RX) VIDTH Differential input high-level threshold VIDTL Differential input low-level threshold –70 mV VIDMAX Maximum differential input voltage 270 mV VIHHS Single-ended input high voltage 460 mV VILHS Single-ended input low voltage –40 Differential input common-mode voltage 70 Differential input impedance 80 VCMRXDC ZID 70 mV mV 100 330 mV 125 Ω (1) VITH is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a high state in the input signal. (2) VITL is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a low state in the input signal. VITL is larger than the maximum single-ended line high voltage during HS transmission. Therefore, both low-power (LP) receivers will detect low during HS signaling. (3) To reduce noise sensitivity on the received signal, the LP receiver is required to incorporate a hysteresis, VHYST. VHYST is the difference between the VITH threshold and the VITL threshold. (4) VITL is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a low state in the input signal. Specification is relaxed for detecting 0 during ultralow power (ULP) state. The LP receiver is not required to detect HS single-ended voltage as 0 in this state. (5) Excluding possible additional RF interference of 200 mVPP beyond 450 MHz. (6) This value includes a ground difference of 50 mV between the transmitter and the receiver, the static common-mode level tolerance and variations below 450 MHz. (7) This number corresponds to the VODMAX transmitter. (8) Common mode is defined as the average voltage level of X and Y: VCMRX = (VX + VY) / 2. (9) Common mode ripple may be due to tR or tF and transmission line impairments in the PCB. (10) For more information regarding the pin name (or ball name) and corresponding signal name, see Table 4-8 CSI 2 Signal Descriptions. 94 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-12. Dual Voltage LVCMOS DC Electrical Characteristics over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN NOM MAX UNIT 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH = 2 mA) VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 2 mA) IDRIVE 0.65*VDDS IIN Input current at each I/O pin IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) at each IO pin. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ IIN with pullup enabled CPAD V 100 mV VDDS-0.45 V 0.45 Pin Drive strength at PAD Voltage = 0.45V or VDDS0.45V IIN with pulldown enabled V 0.35*VDDS 6 V mA 16 µA 11.5 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pulldown enabled measured when PAD = VDDS 60 120 200 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pullup enabled measured when PAD = 0 60 120 210 µA 4 pF Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) ZO Output impedance (drive strength) VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH =100µA) VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 100µA) 40 Ω 3.3-V Mode IDRIVE 2 V 0.8 200 V mV VDDS-0.2 V 0.2 Pin Drive strength at PAD Voltage = 0.45V or VDDS0.45V 6 V mA IIN Input current at each I/O pin 64 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) at each IO pin. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 64 µA IIN with pulldown enabled IIN with pullup enabled CPAD Input current at each I/O pin with weak pulldown enabled measured when PAD = VDDS 10 100 290 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pullup enabled measured when PAD = 0 40 100 200 µA 4 pF Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) ZO Output impedance (drive strength) 40 Ω (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply. For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-1, POWER [10] column. Table 5-13. Analog-to-Digital ADC Subsystem Electrical Specifications over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER CONDITIONS MIN NOM MAX UNIT Analog Input Full-scale Input Range Vref adc_vrefp Should be less than or equal to vdds_18v. Differential Non-Linearity (DNL) V 1.62 vdds_18v V -1 1 LSB ±2 LSB Integral Non-Linearity (INL) adc_vrefp = vdds_18v Gain Error adc_vrefp = vdds_18v ±4 LSB Offset Error adc_vrefp = vdds_18v ±3 LSB Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 95 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-13. Analog-to-Digital ADC Subsystem Electrical Specifications (continued) over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER CONDITIONS MIN Input Sampling Capacitance Input Frequency adc_in[7:0] NOM MAX 3.2 5 pF 30 kHz 0 UNIT Signal-to-Noise Ratio (SNR) Input Signal: 30 kHz sine wave at -0.5 dB Full Scale 50 dB Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) 1.8 Vpp, 30 kHz sine wave 60 dB Spurious Free Dynamic Range 1.8 Vpp, 30 kHz sine wave 60 dB Signal-to-Noise Plus Distortion 1.8 Vpp, 30 kHz sine wave 50 dB 20 Ω adc_vrefp Input Impedance Sampling Dynamics Time from Start to Start Conversion Time + Error Correction Acquisition time 17 Clock Cycles 10 + 1 Clock Cycles 4 Throughput Rate Clock Cycles CLK = 20 MHz (Pin : clk) 1 Channel to Channel Isolation MSPS 90 dB See Table 5-1 ADC Clock Frequency MHz (1) Connect adc_vrefp to vdda_adc when not using a positive external reference voltage. (2) This parameter is valid when the respective AIN terminal is configured to operate as a general-purpose ADC input. (3) The maximum sample rate assumes a conversion time of 13 ADC clock cycles with the acquisition time configured for the minimum of 2 ADC clock cycles, where it takes a total of 15 ADC clock cycles to sample the analog input and convert it to a positive binary weighted digital value. 5.8 Thermal Characteristics For reliability and operability concerns, the maximum junction temperature of the Device has to be at or below the TJ value identified in , Recommended Operating Conditions. A BCI compact thermal model for this Device is available and recommended for use when modeling thermal performance in a system. Therefore, it is recommended to perform thermal simulations at the system level with the worst case device power consumption. 5.8.1 Package Thermal Characteristics Table 5-14 provides the thermal resistance characteristics for the package used on this device. NOTE Power dissipation of 4.14 W and an ambient temperature of 65ºC is assumed for ABF package. Table 5-14. Thermal Resistance Characteristics PARAMET ER DESCRIPTION °C/W(1) AIR FLOW (m/s)(2) T1 RΘJC Junction-to-case 1.41 N/A T2 RΘJB Junction-to-board 5.96 N/A NO. 96 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-14. Thermal Resistance Characteristics (continued) NO. PARAMET ER T3 T4 T5 DESCRIPTION Junction-to-free air RΘJA Junction-to-moving air T6 T7 T8 T9 Junction-to-free air ΨJT Junction-to-package top T10 T11 T12 T13 Junction-to-free air ΨJB Junction-to-board T14 °C/W(1) AIR FLOW (m/s)(2) 15.4 0 13.1 1 12.2 2 11.6 3 0.94 0 0.94 1 0.94 2 0.94 3 5.12 0 4.78 1 4.63 2 4.52 3 (1) These values are based on a JEDEC defined 2S2P system (with the exception of the Theta JC [RΘJC] value, which is based on a JEDEC defined 1S0P system) and will change based on environment as well as application. For more information, see these EIA/JEDEC standards: – JESD51-2, Integrated Circuits Thermal Test Method Environment Conditions - Natural Convection (Still Air) – JESD51-3, Low Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages – JESD51-6, Integrated Circuit Thermal Test Method Environmental Conditions - Forced Convection (Moving Air) – JESD51-7, High Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages – JESD51-9, Test Boards for Area Array Surface Mount Packages (2) m/s = meters per second Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 97 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.9 www.ti.com Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics 5.9.1 Timing Parameters and Information The timing parameter symbols used in the timing requirement and switching characteristic tables are created in accordance with JEDEC Standard 100. To shorten the symbols, some of pin names and other related terminologies have been abbreviated as follows: Table 5-15. Timing Parameters SUBSCRIPTS 5.9.2 SYMBOL PARAMETER c Cycle time (period) d Delay time dis Disable time en Enable time h Hold time su Setup time START Start bit t Transition time v Valid time w Pulse duration (width) X Unknown, changing, or don't care level F Fall time H High L Low R Rise time V Valid IV Invalid AE Active Edge FE First Edge LE Last Edge Z High impedance Interface Clock Specifications 5.9.2.1 Interface Clock Terminology The interface clock is used at the system level to sequence the data and/or to control transfers accordingly with the interface protocol. 5.9.2.2 Interface Clock Frequency The two interface clock characteristics are: • The maximum clock frequency • The maximum operating frequency The interface clock frequency documented in this document is the maximum clock frequency, which corresponds to the maximum frequency programmable on this output clock. This frequency defines the maximum limit supported by the Device IC and does not take into account any system consideration (PCB, peripherals). The system designer will have to consider these system considerations and the Device IC timing characteristics as well to define properly the maximum operating frequency that corresponds to the maximum frequency supported to transfer the data on this interface. 98 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 5.9.3 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Power Supply Sequences This section describes the power-up and power-down sequence required to ensure proper device operation. Figure 5-1 and Figure 5-2, describes the Device Power Sequencing. I/O Buffer Voltages vdds18v, vdds18v_ddr1, vdds18v_ddr2, vdds18v_ddr3 Note 3 PLL and Analog PHY Voltages Note 4 EMIF Voltages vdda_adc, vdda_csi, vdda_dac, vdda_ddr_dsp, vdda_gmac_core, vdda_osc, vdda_per vdds_ddr1, vdds_ddr2, vdds_ddr3 Note 5 CORE AVS Voltage vdd Note 6 DSPEVE AVS Voltage vdd_dspeve Note 7 vddshv1, vddshv2, vddshv3, vddshv4, vddshv5(3), vddshv6 xi_osc0 Note 8 resetn, porz Note 10 Note 9 Valid Config sysboot[15:0] Note 11 rstoutn SPRS916_ELCH_01 Figure 5-1. Power-Up Sequencing (1) Grey shaded areas are windows where it is valid to ramp-up a voltage rail. (2) Blue dashed lines are not valid windows but show alternate ramp-up possibilities based on whether I/O voltage levels are 1.8V or 3.3V (see associated note for more details). (3) vdds18v_* and vdda_* rails should not be combined for best performance to avoid transient switching noise impacts on analog domains. vdda_* should not ramp-up before vdds18v_* but could ramp concurrently if design ensures final operational voltage will not be reached until after vdds18v. The preferred sequence is to follow all vdds18v_* to ensure circuit components and PCB design do not cause an inadvertent violation. (4) vdds_ddr* should not ramp-up before vdds18v_*. The preferred sequence is to follow all vdds18v_* to ensure circuit components and PCB design do not cause an inadvertent violation. vdds_ddr* can ramp-up before, concurrently or after vdda_*, there are no dependencies between vdds_ddr* and vdda_* domains. – vdds_ddr* supplies can be combined with vdds18v_* and vdds18v_ddr supplies for DDR2 mode of operation (1.8V) and ramped up together for simplified power sequencing. – If vdds18v_ddr and vdds_ddr* are kept separate from vdds18v_* on board, then this combined DDR supply can come up together or after the vdds18v_* supply. The DDR supply in this case should never ramp up before the vdds18v_*. (5) vdd should not ramp-up before vdds18v_* or vdds_ddr* domains. (6) vdd_dspeve must not exceed vdd core supply and maintain at least 150mV lower voltage on vdd_dspeve vs vdd. vdd_dspeve could ramp concurrently with vdd if design ensures final operational voltage will not be reached until after vdd and maintains minimum of 150mV less than vdd during entire ramp time. The preferred sequence is to follow vdd to ensure circuit components and PCB design do not cause an inadvertent violation. (7) If any of the vddshv[1-6] power rails are used for 1.8V I/O signaling, then these rails can be combined with vdds18v_*. If 3.3V I/O signaling is required, then these rails must be the last to ramp following vdd_dspeve. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 99 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (8) resetn and porz must remain asserted low for a minimum of 12P(12) after xi_osc0 is stable at a valid frequency. (9) Setup time: SYSBOOT[15:0] pins must be valid 2P(12) before is de-asserted high. (10) Hold time: SYSBOOT[15:0] pins must be valid 15P(12) after is de-asserted high. (11) resetn to rstoutn delay is 2ms. (12) * P = 1/(SYS_CLK1/610) frequency in ns. (13) Ramped Up is defined as reaching the minimum operational voltage level for the corresponding power domain. For information about voltage levels, refer to , Recommended Operating Conditions. porz Note 3 vddshv1, vddshv2, vddshv3, vddshv4, vddshv5, vddshv6 vdd_dspeve Note 4 DSPEVE voltage CORE voltage vdd Note 5 EMIF voltage vdds_ddr1, vdds_ddr2, vdds_ddr3 Note 6 vdda_osc, vdda_per, vdda_ddr_dsp, vdda_gmac_core, vdda_csi, vdda_dac, vdda_adc vdds18v_ddr1, vdds18v_ddr2, vdds18v_ddr3, vdds18v, Note 7 xi_osc0 SPRS916_ELCH_02 Figure 5-2. Power-Down Sequencing (1) Grey shaded areas show valid times to ramp down each supply. (2) Dashed lines are not valid ramp times but show alternate ramp possibilities based on the associated note. (3) If any of the vddshv* are used as 1.8V only, then these rails can ramp down at the same time as vdds18v_* or be combined with vdds18v_*. If vddshv* are used as 3.3V, they can start ramping down no sooner than 100µs after PORz low assertion and must ramped down before vdd_dspeve. If all vddshv_* are 1.8V, then neither vdd_dspeve or vdd should start ramping down no sooner than 100µs after PORz low assertion. (4) vdd_dspeve can ramp down before or at the same time as vdd/vpp. (5) vdds_ddr* can start ramping down no sooner than 500µs after vdd and must be ramped down before vdds18v. vdds_ddr* can start ramping down before, concurrently or after vdda_*, there are no dependencies between vdds_ddr* and vdda_* domains. – vdds_ddr* supplies can be combined with vdds18v_* and vdds18v_ddr supplies for DDR2 mode of operation (1.8V) and ramped down together for simplified power sequencing. – If vdds18v_ddr and vdds_ddr* are kept separate from vdds18v_* on board, then this combined DDR supply can come down together or before the vdds18v_* supply. The DDR supply in this case should never ramp down after the vdds18v_*. (6) vdda_* can ramp down before or at the same time as vdds18v_*. (7) xi_osc0 can be turned off anytime after porz assertion and must be turned off before vdda_osc voltage rail is shutdown. (8) Ramped Down is defined as reaching a voltage level of no more than 0.6V. Figure 5-3 describes vddshv[1-6] supplies falling after vdds18v supplies delta. 100 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 vddshv1, vddshv2, vddshv3, vddshv4, vddshv5, vddshv6 vdds18v Vdelta (Note1) SPRS916_ELCH_03 Figure 5-3. vddshv* Supplies Falling After vdds18v Supplies Delta (1) Vdelta MAX = 2V 5.9.4 Clock Specifications NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Subsystem Environment / External Clock Signals and Clock Management Functional Description section of the Device TRM. NOTE Audio Back End (ABE) module is not supported for this family of devices, but “ABE” name is still present in some clock or DPLL names. The device operation requires the following clocks: • The system clocks, SYS_CLK1(Mandatory) and SYS_CLK2(Optional) are the main clock sources of the device. They supply the reference clock to the DPLLs as well as functional clock to several modules. Figure 5-4 shows the external input clock sources and the output clocks to peripherals. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 101 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com DEVICE rstoutn Warm reset output. resetn Device reset input. porz xi_osc0 Power ON Reset. From quartz (19.2, 20 or 27 MHz) or from CMOS square clock source (19.2, 20 or 27MHz). xo_osc0 To quartz (from oscillator output). xi_osc1 From quartz (range from 19.2 to 32 MHz) or from CMOS square clock source(range from 12 to 38.4 MHz). xo_osc1 To quartz (from oscillator output). clkout0 clkout1 Output clkout[0:2] clocks come from: • Either the input system clock and alternate clock (xi_osc0 or xi_osc1) • Or a CORE clock (from CORE output) • Or a 192-MHz clock (from PER DPLL output). clkout2 xref_clk0 xref_clk1 External Reference Clock [0:2]. For Audio and other Peripherals xref_clk2 sysboot[15:0] Boot Mode Configuration SPRS91v_CLK_01_SR2.0 Figure 5-4. Clock Interface 5.9.4.1 • • Input Clocks / Oscillators The source of the internal system clock (SYS_CLK1) could be either: – A CMOS clock that enters on the xi_osc0 ball (with xo_osc0 left unconnected on the CMOS clock case). – A crystal oscillator clock managed by xi_osc0 and xo_osc0. The source of the internal system clock (SYS_CLK2) could be either: – A CMOS clock that enters on the xi_osc1 ball (with xo_osc1 left unconnected on the CMOS clock case). – A crystal oscillator clock managed by xi_osc1 and xo_osc1. SYS_CLK1 is received directly from oscillator OSC0. For more information about SYS_CLK1 see Device TRM, Chapter: Power, Reset, and Clock Management. 5.9.4.1.1 OSC0 External Crystal An external crystal is connected to the device pins. Figure 5-5 describes the crystal implementation. 102 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Device xo_osc0 xi_osc0 vssa_osc0 Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf2 Cf1 SPRS91v_CLK_02 Figure 5-5. Crystal Implementation NOTE The load capacitors, Cf1 and Cf2 in Figure 5-5, should be chosen such that the below equation is satisfied. CL in the equation is the load specified by the crystal manufacturer. All discrete components used to implement the oscillator circuit should be placed as close as possible to the associated oscillator xi_osc0, xo_osc0, and vssa_osc0 pins. CL= Cf1Cf2 (Cf1+Cf2) Figure 5-6. Load Capacitance Equation The crystal must be in the fundamental mode of operation and parallel resonant. Table 5-16 summarizes the required electrical constraints. Table 5-16. OSC0 Crystal Electrical Characteristics NAME fp DESCRIPTION MIN Parallel resonance crystal frequency TYP MAX 19.2, 20, 27 UNIT MHz Cf1 Cf1 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF Cf2 Cf2 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF 100 Ω 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz, 27 MHz 7 pF 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 7 pF 27 MHz 5 pF 7 pF 5 pF 3 pF ESR(Cf1,Cf2) Crystal ESR ESR = 30 Ω ESR = 40 Ω ESR = 50 Ω CO Crystal shunt capacitance ESR = 60 Ω ESR = 80 Ω ESR = 100 Ω LM Crystal motional inductance for fp = 20 MHz CM Crystal motional capacitance tj(xiosc0) Frequency accuracy(1), xi_osc0 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 27 MHz Not Supported 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 27 MHz Not Supported 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 27 MHz - Not Supported - 10.16 mH 3.42 fF Ethernet not used ±200 ppm Ethernet RGMII using derived clock ±50 ppm Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 103 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. When selecting a crystal, the system design must consider the temperature and aging characteristics of a based on the worst case environment and expected life expectancy of the system. Table 5-17 details the switching characteristics of the oscillator and the requirements of the input clock. Table 5-17. Oscillator Switching Characteristics—Crystal Mode NAME DESCRIPTION fp Oscillation frequency tsX Start-up time MIN TYP MAX UNIT 19.2, 20, 27 MHz MHz 4 ms 5.9.4.1.2 OSC0 Input Clock A 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input can be used instead of the internal oscillator to provide the SYS_CLK1 clock input to the system. The external connections to support this are shown in Figure 5-7. The xi_osc0 pin is connected to the 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible clock source. The xi_osc0 pin is left unconnected. The vssa_osc0 pin is connected to board ground (vss). Device xi_osc0 xo_osc0 vssa_osc0 NC SPRS91v_CLK_03 Figure 5-7. 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input Table 5-18 summarizes the OSC0 input clock electrical characteristics. Table 5-18. OSC0 Input Clock Electrical Characteristics—Bypass Mode NAME f DESCRIPTION MIN TYP Frequency MAX UNIT 19.2, 20, 27 CIN Input capacitance IIN Input current (3.3V mode) MHz 2.184 2.384 2.584 pF 4 6 10 µA Table 5-19 details the OSC0 input clock timing requirements. Table 5-19. OSC0 Input Clock Timing Requirements NAME DESCRIPTION MIN CK0 1 / tc(xiosc0) CK1 tw(xiosc0) Pulse duration, xi_osc0 low or high tj(xiosc0) Period jitter(1), xi_osc0 tR(xiosc0) tF(xiosc0) 104 Frequency, xi_osc0 TYP MAX 19.2, 20, 27 0.45 × tc(xiosc0) UNIT MHz 0.55 × tc(xiosc0) ns 0.01 × tc(xiosc0) ns Rise time, xi_osc0 5 ns Fall time, xi_osc0 5 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-19. OSC0 Input Clock Timing Requirements (continued) NAME DESCRIPTION tj(xiosc0) MIN Frequency accuracy(2), xi_osc0 MAX UNIT Ethernet not used TYP ±200 ppm Ethernet RGMII using derived clock ±50 ppm (1) Period jitter is meant here as follows: – The maximum value is the difference between the longest measured clock period and the expected clock period – The minimum value is the difference between the shortest measured clock period and the expected clock period (2) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. CK0 CK1 CK1 xi_osc0 SPRS91v_CLK_04 Figure 5-8. xi_osc0 Input Clock 5.9.4.1.3 Auxiliary Oscillator OSC1 Input Clock SYS_CLK2 is received directly from oscillator OSC1. For more information about SYS_CLK2 see Device TRM, Chapter: Power, Reset, and Clock Management. 5.9.4.1.3.1 OSC1 External Crystal An external crystal is connected to the device pins. Figure 5-9 describes the crystal implementation. Device xo_osc1 xi_osc1 vssa_osc1 Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf2 Cf1 SPRS91v_CLK_05 Figure 5-9. Crystal Implementation NOTE The load capacitors, Cf1 and Cf2 in Figure 5-9, should be chosen such that the below equation is satisfied. CL in the equation is the load specified by the crystal manufacturer. All discrete components used to implement the oscillator circuit should be placed as close as possible to the associated oscillator xi_osc1, xo_osc1, and vssa_osc1 pins. CL= Cf1Cf2 (Cf1+Cf2) Figure 5-10. Load Capacitance Equation Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 105 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com The crystal must be in the fundamental mode of operation and parallel resonant. Table 5-20 summarizes the required electrical constraints. Table 5-20. OSC1 Crystal Electrical Characteristics NAME fp DESCRIPTION MIN Parallel resonance crystal frequency TYP MAX Range from 19.2 to 32 UNIT MHz Cf1 Cf1 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF Cf2 Cf2 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF ESR(Cf1,Cf2) Crystal ESR 100 Ω ESR = 30 Ω 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 32 MHz 7 pF ESR = 40 Ω 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 32 MHz 5 pF 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 25 MHz 7 pF 25 MHz < fp ≤ 27 MHz 5 pF ESR = 50 Ω 27 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz CO Crystal shunt capacitance ESR = 60 Ω Not Supported 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 23 MHz 7 pF 23 MHz < fp ≤ 25 MHz 5 pF 5 pF 3 pF 3 pF 25 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz Not Supported 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 23 MHz ESR = 80 Ω 23 MHz < fp ≤ 25 MHz 25 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz ESR = 100 Ω - - Not Supported 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 20 MHz 20 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz - Not Supported - LM Crystal motional inductance for fp = 20 MHz 10.16 mH CM Crystal motional capacitance 3.42 fF tj(xiosc0) Frequency accuracy(1), xi_osc1 Ethernet not used ±200 ppm Ethernet RGMII using derived clock ±50 ppm (1) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. When selecting a crystal, the system design must take into account the temperature and aging characteristics of a crystal versus the user environment and expected lifetime of the system. Table 5-21 details the switching characteristics of the oscillator and the requirements of the input clock. Table 5-21. Oscillator Switching Characteristics—Crystal Mode NAME DESCRIPTION fp Oscillation frequency tsX Start-up time MIN TYP MAX Range from 19.2 to 32 UNIT MHz 4 ms 5.9.4.1.3.2 OSC1 Input Clock A 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input can be used instead of the internal oscillator to provide the SYS_CLK2 clock input to the system. The external connections to support this are shown in, Figure 5-11. The xi_osc1 pin is connected to the 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible clock sources. The xo_osc1 pin is left unconnected. The vssa_osc1 pin is connected to board ground (VSS). 106 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Device xi_osc1 xo_osc1 vssa_osc1 NC SPRS91v_CLK_06 Figure 5-11. 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input Table 5-22 summarizes the OSC1 input clock electrical characteristics. Table 5-22. OSC1 Input Clock Electrical Characteristics—Bypass Mode NAME f DESCRIPTION MIN Frequency TYP MAX UNIT Range from 12 to 38.4 CIN Input capacitance IIN Input current (3.3V mode) tsX Start-up time(1) MHz 2.819 3.019 3.219 pF 4 6 10 µA See(2) ms (1) To switch from bypass mode to crystal or from crystal mode to bypass mode, there is a waiting time about 100 μs; however, if the chip comes from bypass mode to crystal mode the crystal will start-up after time mentioned in Table 5-21, tsX parameter. (2) Before the processor boots up and the oscillator is set to bypass mode, there is a waiting time when the internal oscillator is in application mode and receives a wave. The switching time in this case is about 100 μs. Table 5-23 details the OSC1 input clock timing requirements. Table 5-23. OSC1 Input Clock Timing Requirements NAME DESCRIPTION CK0 1 / tc(xiosc1) CK1 tw(xiosc1) MIN Frequency, xi_osc1 TYP MAX UNIT Range from 12 to 38.4 Pulse duration, xi_osc1 low or high 0.45 × tc(xiosc1) (1) MHz 0.55 × tc(xiosc1) (3) 0.01 × tc(xiosc1) ns tj(xiosc1) Period jitter , xi_osc1 tR(xiosc1) Rise time, xi_osc1 5 ns ns tF(xiosc1) Fall time, xi_osc1 5 ns Ethernet not used ±200 ppm tj(xiosc1) Frequency accuracy(2), xi_osc1 Ethernet RGMII using derived clock ±50 ppm (1) Period jitter is meant here as follows: – The maximum value is the difference between the longest measured clock period and the expected clock period – The minimum value is the difference between the shortest measured clock period and the expected clock period (2) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. (3) The Period jitter requirement for osc1 can be relaxed to 0.02*tc(xiosc1) under the following constraints: a. The osc1/SYS_CLK2 clock bypasses all device PLLs b. The osc1/SYS_CLK2 clock is only used to source the DSS pixel clock outputs Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 107 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com CK0 CK1 CK1 xi_osc1 SPRS91v_CLK_07 Figure 5-12. xi_osc1 Input Clock 5.9.4.1.4 RC On-die Oscillator Clock RCOSC_32K_CLK is received directly through a network of resistor and capacitor (an RC network) inside of the SoC. This RC oscillator do not have good frequency stability. The Frequency range is described in Table 5-24, which depends on the temperature. For more information about RCOSC_32K_CLK see the Device TRM, Chapter: Power, Reset, and Clock Management. Table 5-24. RC On-die Oscillator Clock Frequency Range NAME RCOSC_32K_CLK 5.9.4.2 DESCRIPTION MIN Internal RC Oscillator TYP MAX Range from 28 to 42 UNIT kHz Output Clocks NOTE NOTE TO USERS: The content of this section is UNDER DEVELOPMENT! 5.9.4.3 DPLLs, DLLs NOTE For more information, see: • Power, Reset, and Clock Management / Clock Management Functional Description / Internal Clock Sources / Generators / Generic DPLL Overview Section and • Display Subsystem / Display Subsystem Overview section of the Device TRM. To generate high-frequency clocks, the device supports multiple on-chip DPLLs controlled directly by the PRCM module. • They have their own independent power domain (each one embeds its own switch and can be controlled as an independent functional power domain) • They are fed with ALWAYS ON system clock, with independent control per DPLL. The different DPLLs managed by the PRCM are listed below: • DPLL_CORE: It supplies all interface clocks and also few module functional clocks. • DPLL_PER: It supplies several clock sources: a 192-MHz clock for the display functional clock , a 96-MHz functional clock to subsystems and peripherals. • DPLL_GMAC_DSP: It supplies RGMII, EVE1 and DSP0 module functional clocks. • DPLL_EVE_VID_DSP: It provides a few module functional clocks (EVE_GFCLK, VID_PIX_CLK and DSP1_CLK). • DPLL_DDR: It generates clocks for the one External Memory Interface (EMIF) controller and its associated EMIF PHYs. 108 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 NOTE The following DPLLs are controlled by the clock manager located in the always-on Core power domain (CM_CORE_AON): • DPLL_CORE, DPLL_DDR, DPLL_GMAC_DSP, DPLL_PER, DPLL_EVE_VID_DSP. For more information on CM_CORE_AON and CM_CORE or PRCM DPLLs, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) chapter of the Device TRM. 5.9.4.3.1 DPLL Characteristics The DPLL has three relevant input clocks. One of them is the reference clock (CLKINP) used to generated the synthesized clock but can also be used as the bypass clock whenever the DPLL enters a bypass mode. It is therefore mandatory. The second one is a fast bypass clock (CLKINPULOW) used when selected as the bypass clock and is optional. The third clock (CLKINPHIF) is explained in the next paragraph. The DPLL has three output clocks (namely CLKOUT, CLKOUTX2, and CLKOUTHIF). CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 run at the bypass frequency whenever the DPLL enters a bypass mode. Both of them are generated from the lock frequency divided by a post-divider (namely M2 post-divider). The third clock, CLKOUTHIF, has no automatic bypass capability. It is an output of a post-divider (M3 post-divider) with the input clock selectable between the internal lock clock (Fdpll) and CLKINPHIF input of the PLL through an asynchronous multplexing. For more information, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter of the Device TRM. Table 5-25 summarizes DPLL type described in Section 5.9.4.3, DPLLs, DLLs Specifications. Table 5-25. DPLL Control DPLL NAME CONTROLLED BY PRCM DPLL_CORE Yes(1) DPLL_EVE_VID_DSP Yes(1) DPLL_GMAC_DSP Yes(1) DPLL_PER Yes(1) DPLL_DDR Yes(1) (1) DPLL is in the always-on domain. Table 5-26 and summarize the DPLL characteristics and assume testing over recommended operating conditions. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 109 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-26. DPLL Characteristics NAME MAX UNIT 52 MHz FINP 0.15 52 MHz REFCLK 10 1400 MHz FINPHIF 0.001 600 MHz Bypass mode: fCLKOUT = fCLKINPULOW / (M1 + 1) if ulowclken = 1(6) CLKOUT output frequency 20(1) 1400(2) MHz [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M2] (in locked condition) fCLKOUTx2 CLKOUTx2 output frequency 40(1) 2200(2) MHz 2 × [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M2] (in locked condition) 20(3) 1400(4) MHz FINPHIF / M3 if clkinphifsel = 1 fCLKOUTHIF CLKOUTHIF output frequency 40 2200 MHz 2 × [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M3] if clkinphifsel = 0 fCLKDCOLDO DCOCLKLDO output frequency 2800 MHz 2 × [M / (N + 1)] × FINP (in locked condition) tlock Frequency lock time 6 + 350 × REFCLK µs plock Phase lock time 6 + 500 × REFCLK µs trelock-L Relock time—Frequency lock(5) (LP relock time from bypass) 6 + 70 × REFCLK µs DPLL in LP relock time: lowcurrstdby = 1 prelock-L Relock time—Phase lock(5) (LP relock time from bypass) 6 + 120 × REFCLK µs DPLL in LP relock time: lowcurrstdby = 1 trelock-F Relock time—Frequency lock(5) (fast relock time from bypass) 3.55 + 70 × REFCLK µs DPLL in fast relock time: lowcurrstdby = 0 prelock-F Relock time—Phase lock(5) (fast relock time from bypass) 3.55 + 120 × REFCLK µs DPLL in fast relock time: lowcurrstdby = 0 finput DESCRIPTION MIN CLKINP input frequency 0.032 finternal Internal reference frequency fCLKINPHIF CLKINPHIF input frequency fCLKINPULOW fCLKOUT CLKINPULOW input frequency TYP (3) (4) 40 COMMENTS (1) The minimum frequencies on CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 are assuming M2 = 1. For M2 > 1, the minimum frequency on these clocks will further scale down by factor of M2. (2) The maximum frequencies on CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 are assuming M2 = 1. (3) The minimum frequency on CLKOUTHIF is assuming M3 = 1. For M3 > 1, the minimum frequency on this clock will further scale down by factor of M3. (4) The maximum frequency on CLKOUTHIF is assuming M3 = 1. (5) Relock time assumes typical operating conditions, 10°C maximum temperature drift. (6) Bypass mode: fCLKOUT = FINP if ulowclken = 0. For more information, see the Device TRM. 110 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.9.4.3.2 DLL Characteristics Table 5-27 summarizes the DLL characteristics and assumes testing over recommended operating conditions. Table 5-27. DLL Characteristics NAME DESCRIPTION MIN TYP MAX UNIT finput Input clock frequency (EMIF_DLL_FCLK) 266 MHz tlock Lock time 50k cycles Relock time (a change of the DLL frequency implies that DLL must relock) 50k cycles trelock 5.9.4.3.2.1 DPLL and DLL Noise Isolation NOTE For more information on DPLL and DLL decoupling capacitor requirements, see the External Capacitors / Voltage Decoupling Capacitors / I/O and Analog Voltage Decoupling / VDDA Power Domain section. 5.9.5 Recommended Clock and Control Signal Transition Behavior All clocks and control signals must transition between VIH and VIL (or between VIL and VIH) in a monotonic manner. Monotonic transitions are more easily guaranteed with faster switching signals. Slower input transitions are more susceptible to glitches due to noise and special care should be taken for slow input clocks. 5.9.6 Peripherals 5.9.6.1 Timing Test Conditions All timing requirements and switching characteristics are valid over the recommended operating conditions unless otherwise specified. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 111 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.9.6.2 www.ti.com VIP The device includes 1 Video Input Ports (VIP). Table 5-28, Figure 5-13 and Figure 5-14 present timings and switching characteristics of the VIPs. Table 5-28. Timing Requirements for VIP (1)(2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN V1 tc(CLK) Cycle time, vinx_clki(3)(5) V2 tw(CLKH) Pulse duration, vinx_clki high V3 tw(CLKL) Pulse duration, vinx_clki low(3)(5) V4 tsu(CTL/DATA-CLK) Input setup time, Control (vinx_dei, vinx_vsynci, vinx_fldi, vinx_hsynci) and Data (vinx_dn) valid to vinx_clki transition V5 th(CLK-CTL/DATA) 5.99 (3)(5) MAX UNIT ns (1) 0.45*P (2) ns 0.45*P (2) ns 2.52 ns -0.05 ns (3)(4)(5) Input hold time, Control (vinx_dei, vinx_vsynci, vinx_fldi, vinx_hsynci) and Data (vinx_dn) valid from vinx_clki transition(3)(4)(5) (1) For maximum frequency of 165 MHz. (2) P = vinx_clki period. (3) x in vinx = 1a, 1b, 2a and 2b. (4) n in dn = 0 to 7 when x = 1b, 2b; n = 0 to 23 when x = 1a and 2a; (5) i in clki, dei, vsynci, hsynci and fldi = 0 or 1. V3 V2 V1 vinx_clki SPRS91v_VIP_01 Figure 5-13. Video Input Ports Clock Signal vinx_clki (positive-edge clocking) vinx_clki (negative-edge clocking) V5 V4 vinx_d[23:0]/sig SPRS8xx_VIP_02 Figure 5-14. Video Input Ports Timings CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid for VIN1 and VIN2 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-29 and Table 5-30. In Table 5-29 and Table 5-30 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with vin1a, vin1b, vin2a and vin2b. 112 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-29. VIN1 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL IOSET3 MUX IOSET4 BALL MUX BALL MUX vin1a vin1a_clk0 F22 0 F22 0 F22 0 F22 0 vin1a_de0 F21 0 F21 0 F19 2 F21 0 vin1a_fld0 F20 0 vin1a_hsync0 F19 0 vin1a_vsync0 G19 0 G19 0 G19 0 G19 0 vin1a_d0 G18 0 G18 0 G18 0 G18 0 vin1a_d1 G21 0 G21 0 G21 0 G21 0 vin1a_d2 G22 0 G22 0 G22 0 G22 0 vin1a_d3 H18 0 H18 0 H18 0 H18 0 vin1a_d4 H20 0 H20 0 H20 0 H20 0 vin1a_d5 H19 0 H19 0 H19 0 H19 0 vin1a_d6 H22 0 H22 0 H22 0 H22 0 vin1a_d7 H21 0 H21 0 H21 0 H21 0 vin1a_d8 J17 0 J17 0 vin1b_clk1 F21 2 vin1b_hsync1 W7 7 vin1b_vsync1 W6 7 vin1b_d0 J17 2 vin1b_d1 K22 2 vin1b_d2 K21 2 vin1b_d3 K18 2 vin1b_d4 K17 2 vin1b_d5 K19 2 vin1b_d6 K20 2 vin1b_d7 L21 2 vin1a_d9 K22 0 K22 0 vin1a_d10 K21 0 K21 0 vin1a_d11 K18 0 K18 0 vin1a_d12 K17 0 AB17 2 vin1a_d13 K19 0 U17 2 vin1a_d14 K20 0 W17 2 vin1a_d15 L21 0 AA17 2 vin1b Table 5-30. VIN2 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX vin2a_clk0 L22 0 vin2a_de0 M17 0 vin2a_fld0 M18 0 vin2a_vsync0 W6 2 vin2a_d0 AA14 vin2a_d1 AB14 BALL IOSET3 MUX BALL MUX AB17 9 L22 0 AA17 9 U16 9 W7 2 F14 9 W6 2 C14 9 2 AA14 2 AA14 2 2 AB14 2 AB14 2 vin2a vin2a_hsync0 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 113 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-30. VIN2 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX vin2a_d2 U13 2 U13 2 U13 2 vin2a_d3 V13 2 V13 2 V13 2 vin2a_d4 Y13 2 Y13 2 Y13 2 vin2a_d5 W13 2 W13 2 W13 2 vin2a_d6 U11 2 U11 2 U11 2 vin2a_d7 V11 2 V11 2 V11 2 vin2a_d8 U9 2 vin2a_d9 W11 2 vin2a_d10 V9 2 vin2a_d11 W9 2 vin2a_d12 U8 2 vin2a_d13 W8 2 vin2a_d14 U7 2 V7 2 vin2b_clk1 F20 2 vin2b_hsync1 M17 2 vin2b_vsync1 M18 2 vin2b_d0 U9 5 vin2b_d1 W11 5 vin2b_d2 V9 5 vin2b_d3 W9 5 vin2b_d4 U8 5 vin2b_d5 W8 5 vin2b_d6 U7 5 vin2b_d7 V7 5 vin2a_d15 vin2b 5.9.6.3 DSS Display Parallel Interfaces (DPI) channels are available in DSS named DPI Video Output 1. Every VOUT interface consists of: • 24-bit data bus (data[23:0]) • Horizontal synchronization signal (HSYNC) • Vertical synchronization signal (VSYNC) • Data enable (DE) • Field ID (FID) • Pixel clock (CLK) NOTE For more information, see the Display Subsystem section of the Device TRM. 114 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 CAUTION All pads/balls configured as vouti_* signals must be programmed to use slow slew rate by setting the corresponding CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[SLEWCONTROL] register field to SLOW (0b1). Table 5-31 and Figure 5-15 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions. Table 5-31. DPI Video Output 1 Switching Characteristics(1)(2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN MAX UNIT D1 tc(clk) Cycle time, output pixel clock vouti_clk 6.73 ns D2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, output pixel clock vouti_clk low P*0.5-1 ns D3 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, output pixel clock vouti_clk high P*0.5-1 D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI1 -1.33 1.01 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI1 -1.33 1.01 ns ns (1) P = output vout1_clk period in ns. (2) All pads/balls configured as vouti_* signals must be programmed to use slow slew rate by setting the corresponding CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[SLEWCONTROL] register field to SLOW (0b1). (3) SERDES transceivers may be sensitive to the jitter profile of vouti_clk. See Application Note SPRAC62 for additional guidance. D2 D3 D1 D4 Falling-edge Clock Reference vouti_clk D6 Rising-edge Clock Reference vouti_clk vouti_vsync D6 vouti_hsync D5 vouti_d[23:0] data_1 data_2 data_n D6 vouti_de D6 vouti_fld even odd SWPS049-018 (1)(2)(3) Figure 5-15. DPI Video Output (1) The configuration of assertion of the data can be programmed on the falling or rising edge of the pixel clock. (2) The polarity and the pulse width of vout1_hsync and vout1_vsync are programmable, refer to the DSS section of the device TRM. (3) The vout1_clk frequency can be configured, refer to the DSS section of the device TRM. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 115 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.9.6.4 www.ti.com ISS NOTE For more information, see the Imaging Subsystem chapter of the device TRM. The imaging subsystem (ISS) deals with the processing of the pixel data coming from an external image sensor or data from memory (image format encoding and decoding can be done to and from memory). With its subparts, such as interfaces and interconnects, image signal processor (ISP), and still image coprocessor (SIMCOP), the ISS is a key component for the following use cases: • Rear View Camera • Front View Stereo Camera • Surround View Camera The ISS is mainly composed of CAL_A, CAL_B, LVDS-RX camera interfaces, a parallel interface (CPI), an ISP, and a block-based imaging accelerator (SIMCOP). • • • The Camera Adapter Layer (CAL_A) supports MIPI® CSI2 protocol with four data lanes. The CAL_A is targeted as sensor capture interface and write DMA, while CAL_B is targeted as read DMA engine and does not support sensor capture. The LVDS receiver (LVDS-RX) support Sony / Aptina / Omnivision / Panasonic / AltaSens serial interfaces. The parallel interface (CPI) supports up to 16 data lanes. All interfaces can use the image signal processor (ISP), but not concurrently. When one interface uses the ISP, the other must send data to memory. However, the ISP can still be used to process this data in memory-to-memory. Time multiplex processing is also possible. The camera adaptation layer (CAL) deals with the processing of the pixel data coming from an external image sensor, data from memory. The CAL is a key component for the following multimedia applications: camera viewfinder, video record, and still image capture. The CAL has two serial camera interfaces (primary and secondary): • The primary serial interface (CSI2 Port A) is compliant with MIPI CSI-2 protocol with four data lanes. 5.9.6.4.1 CSI-2 MIPI D-PHY—1.5 V and 1.8 V The CSI-2 port A is compliant with the MIPI D-PHY RX specification v1.00.00 and the MIPI CSI-2 specification v1.00, with 4 data differential lanes plus 1 clock differential lane in synchronous mode, double data rate: • 1.5 Gbps (750 MHz) @OPP_NOM for each lane. CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-32. In Table 5-32 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with ISS. Table 5-32. Camera Parallel Interface (CPI) IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET2 MUX BALL MUX F22 1 F22 1 cpi_data0 F19 1 F19 1 cpi_data1 G19 1 G19 1 cpi_pclk 116 IOSET1 BALL Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-32. Camera Parallel Interface (CPI) IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX BALL MUX cpi_data2 G18 1 G18 1 cpi_data3 G21 1 G21 1 cpi_data4 G22 1 G22 1 cpi_data5 H18 1 H18 1 cpi_data6 H20 1 H20 1 cpi_data7 H19 1 H19 1 cpi_data8 H22 1 H22 1 cpi_data9 H21 1 H21 1 cpi_data10 J17 1 J17 1 cpi_data11 K22 1 K22 1 cpi_data12 K21 1 K21 1 cpi_data13 K18 1 K18 1 cpi_data14 K17 1 K17 1 L21 1 cpi_wen K19 1 K19 1 cpi_fid K20 1 K20 1 cpi_hsync F21 1 F21 1 cpi_vsync F20 1 F20 1 W6 1 cpi_data15 cam_nreset cam_strobe B18 3 M17 1 cam_shutter C18 3 M18 1 For more information, please contact your local TI representative. 5.9.6.5 EMIF The device has a dedicated interface to DDR3 and DDR3L SDRAM. It supports JEDEC standard compliant DDR3 and DDR3L SDRAM devices with the following features: • 16-bit or 32-bit data path to external SDRAM memory • Memory device capacity: 128Mb, 256Mb, 512Mb, 1Gb, 2Gb, 4Gb and 8Gb devices (Single die only) • One interface with associated DDR3/DDR3L PHYs NOTE For more information, see the EMIF Controller section of the Device TRM. 5.9.6.6 GPMC The GPMC is the unified memory controller that interfaces external memory devices such as: • Asynchronous SRAM-like memories and ASIC devices • Asynchronous page mode and synchronous burst NOR flash • NAND flash NOTE For more information, see the General-Purpose Memory Controller section of the Device TRM. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 117 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 5.9.6.6.1 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Synchronous Timing Table 5-33 and Table 5-34, Table 5-35 and Table 5-36 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 5-16, Figure 5-17, Figure 5-18, Figure 5-19, Figure 5-20 and Figure 5-21). Table 5-33. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN F12 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_clk high 1.9 MAX UNIT ns F13 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_clk high 1 ns F21 tsu(waitV-clkH) Setup time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid before gpmc_clk high 1.9 ns F22 th(clkH-waitV) Hold Time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid after gpmc_clk high 1 ns NOTE Wait monitoring support is limited to a WaitMonitoringTime value > 0. For a full description of wait monitoring feature, see the Device TRM. Table 5-34. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN F0 tc(clk) Cycle time, output clock gpmc_clk period (12) 11.3 F2 td(clkH-nCSV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] transition (14) (14) MAX UNIT ns F-0.8 F+3.1 ns E-0.8 E+3.1 ns B-0.8 B+3.1 ns F3 td(clkH-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid F4 td(ADDV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_a[27:0] address bus valid to gpmc_clk first edge F5 td(clkH-ADDIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_a[27:0] gpmc address bus invalid F6 td(nBEV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid to gpmc_clk rising edge B-3.8 B+1.1 ns F7 td(clkH-nBEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] invalid D-0.4 D+1.1 ns F8 td(clkH-nADV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale transition G-0.8 G+3.1 ns D-0.8 D+3.1 ns H-0.8 H+2.1 ns E-0.8 E+2.1 ns (14) (14) -0.8 ns F9 td(clkH-nADVIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale invalid F10 td(clkH-nOE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren transition F11 td(clkH-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren invalid (14) F14 td(clkH-nWE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_wen transition (14) I-0.8 I+3.1 ns F15 td(clkH-Data) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ad[15:0] data bus transition J-1.1 J+3.92 ns F17 td(clkH-nBE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] transition J-1.1 J+3.8 ns F18 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, gpmc_cs[7:0] low A ns F19 tw(nBEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_ben[1:0] low C ns F20 tw(nADVV) Pulse duration, gpmc_advn_ale low K ns F23 td(CLK-GPIO) Delay time, gpmc_clk transition to gpio6_16.clkout0 transition (14) (13) 1.2 6.1 ns Table 5-35. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN F12 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_clk high 2.5 ns F13 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_clk high 1.9 ns F21 tsu(waitV-clkH) Setup time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid before gpmc_clk high 2.5 ns F22 th(clkH-waitV) Hold Time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid after gpmc_clk high 1.9 ns 118 Specifications MAX UNIT Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-36. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION F0 tc(clk) Cycle time, output clock gpmc_clk period (12) MIN F2 td(clkH-nCSV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] transition F3 td(clkH-nCSIV) F4 F5 MAX 15.04 (14) UNIT ns F+0.7 (6) F+6.1 (6) ns Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid (14) E+0.7 (5) E+6.1 (5) ns td(ADDV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_a[27:0] address bus valid to gpmc_clk first edge B+0.7 (2) B+6.1 (2) ns td(clkH-ADDIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_a[27:0] gpmc address bus invalid F6 td(nBEV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid to gpmc_clk rising edge B-4.9 B+0.4 ns F7 td(clkH-nBEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] invalid D-0.4 D+4.9 ns F8 td(clkH-nADV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale transition F9 td(clkH-nADVIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale invalid (14) (14) (14) 0.7 ns G+0.7 (7) G+6.1 (7) ns D+0.7 (4) D+6.1 (4) ns H+0.7 (8) H+5.1 (8) ns E+0.7 (5) E+5.1 (5) ns I+0.7 (9) I+6.1 (9) ns F10 td(clkH-nOE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren transition F11 td(clkH-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren invalid (14) F14 td(clkH-nWE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_wen transition F15 td(clkH-Data) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ad[15:0] data bus transition J-0.4 (10) J+4.9 (10) ns F17 td(clkH-nBE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] transition J-0.4 (10) J+4.9 (10) ns F18 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, gpmc_cs[7:0] low A (1) ns F19 tw(nBEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_ben[1:0] low C (3) ns F20 tw(nADVV) Pulse duration, gpmc_advn_ale low K (11) ns F23 td(CLK-GPIO) (14) Delay time, gpmc_clk transition to gpio6_16.clkout0 transition (13) 1.2 6.1 ns (1) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period with n the page burst access number. (2) B = ClkActivationTime * GPMC_FCLK (3) For single read: C = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: C = (RdCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For Burst write: C = (WrCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK with n the page burst access number. (4) For single read: D = (RdCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: D = (RdCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: D = (WrCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (5) For single read: E = (CSRdOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: E = (CSRdOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: E = (CSWrOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (6) For nCS falling edge (CS activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0 : F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are even) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) F = (2 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) F = (2 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) F = (3 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) (7) For ADV falling edge (ADV activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0 : G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 119 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For ADV rising edge (ADV deactivated) in Reading mode: Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 4) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 4) G = (3 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 3) is a multiple of 4) For ADV rising edge (ADV deactivated) in Writing mode: Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 4) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 4) G = (3 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 3) is a multiple of 4) (8) For OE falling edge (OE activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are even) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) - H = (3 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) For OE rising edge (OE desactivated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are even) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 4) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 4) - H = (3 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 3) is a multiple of 4) (9) For WE falling edge (WE activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are even) 120 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) - I = (3 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) For WE rising edge (WE desactivated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are even) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) - I = (3 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) (10) J = GPMC_FCLK period, where GPMC_FCLK is the General Purpose Memory Controller internal functional clock (11) For read: K = (ADVRdOffTime – ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For write: K = (ADVWrOffTime – ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (12) The gpmc_clk output clock maximum and minimum frequency is programmable in the I/F module by setting the GPMC_CONFIG1_CSx configuration register bit fields GpmcFCLKDivider (13) gpio6_16 programmed to MUXMODE=9 (clkout1), CM_CLKSEL_CLKOUTMUX1 programmed to 7 (CORE_DPLL_OUT_DCLK), CM_CLKSEL_CORE_DPLL_OUT_CLK_CLKOUTMUX programmed to 1. (14) CSEXTRADELAY = 0, ADVEXTRADELAY = 0, WEEXTRADELAY = 0, OEEXTRADELAY = 0. Extra half-GPMC_FCLK cycle delay mode is not timed. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 121 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com F1 F0 F1 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 Address (MSB) gpmc_a[10:1] gpmc_a[27] F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben1 F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F13 F4 gpmc_ad[15:0] F5 F12 Address (LSB) D0 F22 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout0 GPMC_01 Figure 5-16. GPMC / Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Single Read (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. 122 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 F1 F0 F1 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[27:1] Address F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben1 F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F9 F20 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F13 F12 D0 gpmc_ad[15:0] F22 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout0 GPMC_02 Figure 5-17. GPMC / Non-Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Single Read (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 123 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[10:1] gpmc_a[27] Address (MSB) F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben1 F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F9 F20 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F12 F4 gpmc_ad[15:0] F5 F13 D0 Address (LSB) F22 D1 F12 D2 D3 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout0 GPMC_03 Figure 5-18. GPMC / Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Read 4x16 bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i= 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. 124 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[27:1] Address F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben1 F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F12 F13 gpmc_ad[15:0] D0 D1 F12 D2 D3 F21 F22 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout0 GPMC_04 Figure 5-19. GPMC / Non-Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Read 4x16 bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 125 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[10:1] gpmc_a[27] Address (MSB) F17 F6 F17 F6 F17 F17 gpmc_ben1 F17 F17 gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F14 F14 gpmc_wen F15 gpmc_ad[15:0] Address (LSB) D0 F22 D1 F15 D2 F15 D3 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout0 GPMC_05 Figure 5-20. GPMC / Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Write 4x16bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. (2) In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. 126 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 Address gpmc_a[27:1] F17 F6 F17 F17 gpmc_ben1 F17 F6 F17 F17 gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F14 F14 gpmc_wen F15 gpmc_ad[15:0] D0 F15 D1 F15 D2 D3 F21 F22 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout0 GPMC_06 Figure 5-21. GPMC / Non-Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Write 4x16bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 1 to 7. (2) In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. 5.9.6.6.2 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Asynchronous Timing Table 5-37 and Table 5-38 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 5-22, Figure 5-23, Figure 5-24, Figure 5-25, Figure 5-26 and Figure 5-27). Table 5-37. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Asynchronous Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION FA5 tacc(DAT) Data Maximum Access Time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) MIN MAX UNIT H (1) cycles FA20 tacc1-pgmode(DAT) Page Mode Successive Data Maximum Access Time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) P (2) cycles FA21 tacc2-pgmode(DAT) Page Mode First Data Maximum Access Time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) H (1) cycles - tsu(DV-OEH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_oen_ren high - th(OEH-DV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_oen_ren high 1.9 ns 1 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 127 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) H = Access Time * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) (2) P = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) Table 5-38. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Asynchronous Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT - tr(DO) - tf(DO) Rising time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data 0.447 4.067 ns Fallling time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data 0.43 4.463 FA0 tw(nBEV) ns Pulse duration, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid time N FA1 ns tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, gpmc_cs[7:0] low A ns FA3 td(nCSV-nADVIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_advn_ale invalid B - 0.2 B + 2.0 ns FA4 td(nCSV-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren invalid (Single read) C - 0.2 C + 2.0 ns FA9 td(AV-nCSV) Delay time, address bus valid to gpmc_cs[7:0] valid J - 0.2 J + 2.0 ns FA10 td(nBEV-nCSV) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid to gpmc_cs[7:0] valid J - 0.2 J + 2.0 ns FA12 td(nCSV-nADVV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_advn_ale valid K - 0.2 K + 2.0 ns FA13 td(nCSV-nOEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren valid L - 0.2 L + 2.0 ns FA16 tw(AIV) Pulse duration, address invalid between 2 successive R/W accesses G FA18 td(nCSV-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren invalid (Burst read) I - 0.2 FA20 tw(AV) Pulse duration, address valid : 2nd, 3rd and 4th accesses FA25 td(nCSV-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_wen valid FA27 td(nCSV-nWEIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_wen invalid FA28 td(nWEV-DV) Delay time, gpmc_ wen valid to data bus valid FA29 td(DV-nCSV) Delay time, data bus valid to gpmc_cs[7:0] valid FA37 td(nOEV-AIV) Delay time, gpmc_oen_ren valid to gpmc_ad[15:0] multiplexed address bus phase end ns I + 2.0 D ns ns E-2 E + 2.0 ns F - 0.2 F + 2.0 ns 2 ns J + 2.0 ns 2 ns J - 0.2 (1) For single read: N = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For single write: N = WrCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: N = (RdCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: N = (WrCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (2) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For single write: A = (CSWrOffTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period with n the page burst access number. (3) For reading: B = ((ADVRdOffTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK For writing: B = ((ADVWrOffTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (4) C = ((OEOffTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLKFor single read: C = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (5) J = (CSOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK (6) K = ((ADVOnTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (7) L = ((OEOnTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (8) G = Cycle2CycleDelay * GPMC_FCLK * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) (9) I = ((OEOffTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (10) D = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (11) E = ((WEOnTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (12) F = ((WEOffTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK 128 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA5 FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 Valid Address gpmc_a[27:1] FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 Valid gpmc_ben1 Valid FA0 FA10 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA4 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] Data IN 0 Data IN 0 gpmc_waitj FA15 FA14 DIR OUT IN OUT GPMC_07 Figure 5-22. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Single Word Timing(1)(2)(3) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. (2) FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (3) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally. (4) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 129 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA5 FA5 FA1 FA1 gpmc_csi FA16 FA9 FA9 gpmc_a[27:1] Address 0 Address 1 FA0 FA0 FA10 FA10 gpmc_ben0 Valid FA0 FA0 gpmc_ben1 Valid Valid Valid FA10 FA10 FA3 FA3 FA12 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA4 FA4 FA13 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] Data Upper gpmc_waitj FA15 FA15 FA14 DIR FA14 OUT IN OUT IN GPMC_08 (1)(2)(3) Figure 5-23. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - 32-bit Timing (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. (2) FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value should be stored inside AccessTime register bits field (3) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally (4) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. 130 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA21 FA20 FA20 FA20 FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 Add0 gpmc_a[27:1] Add1 Add2 Add3 D0 D1 D2 Add4 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben1 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA18 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] D3 D3 gpmc_waitj FA15 FA14 DIR OUT IN OUT SPRS91v_GPMC_09 Figure 5-24. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Page Mode 4x16-bit Timing(1)(2)(3)(4) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1 (2) FA21 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample first input Page Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA21 functional clock cycles, First input Page Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA21 calculation is detailled in a separated application note (ref …) and should be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (3) FA20 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample successive input Page Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. After each access to input Page Data, next input Page Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge after FA20 functional clock cycles. FA20 is also the duration of address phases for successive input Page Data (excluding first input Page Data). FA20 value should be stored in PageBurstAccessTime register bits field. (4) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally (5) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 131 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com gpmc_fclk gpmc_clk FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 Valid Address gpmc_a[27:1] FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA27 FA25 gpmc_wen FA29 Data OUT gpmc_ad[15:0] gpmc_waitj DIR OUT GPMC_10 Figure 5-25. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Write - Single Word Timing(1) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. (2) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. 132 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA1 FA5 gpmc_csi FA9 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a[10:1] Address (MSB) FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 Valid FA0 FA10 Valid gpmc_ben1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA4 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren FA29 gpmc_ad[15:0] FA37 Address (LSB) Data IN Data IN FA15 FA14 DIR OUT IN OUT gpmc_waitj GPMC_11 Figure 5-26. GPMC / Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Single Word Timing(1)(2)(3) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1 (2) FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value should be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (3) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally (4) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 133 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com gpmc_fclk gpmc_clk FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a[10:1] Address (MSB) FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA27 FA25 gpmc_wen FA29 FA28 Valid Address (LSB) gpmc_ad[15:0] Data OUT gpmc_waitj OUT DIR GPMC_12 Figure 5-27. GPMC / Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Write - Single Word Timing(1) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. (2) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. 5.9.6.6.3 GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Asynchronous Timing Table 5-39 and Table 5-40 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 5-28, Figure 5-29, Figure 5-30 and Figure 5-31). Table 5-39. GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Timing Requirements(1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tacc(DAT) Data maximum access time (GPMC_FCLK Cycles) - tsu(DV-OEH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_oen_ren high - th(OEH-DV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_oen_ren high GNF12 MIN MAX UNIT J cycles 1.9 ns 1 ns (1) J = AccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) Table 5-40. GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Switching Characteristics NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT - tr(DO) Rising time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data 0.447 4.067 ns - 0.43 4.463 ns tf(DO) Fallling time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data GNF0 tw(nWEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_wen valid time GNF1 td(nCSV-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_wen valid 134 Specifications A B - 0.2 (2) (1) B + 2.0 (2) ns ns Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-40. GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Switching Characteristics (continued) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT GNF2 NO. td(CLEH-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] high to gpmc_wen valid C - 0.2 (3) C + 2.0 ns GNF3 td(nWEV-DV) Delay time, gpmc_ad[15:0] valid to gpmc_wen valid D - 0.2 (4) D + 2.0 ns GNF4 td(nWEIV-DIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_ad[15:0] invalid E - 0.2 (5) E + 2.0 ns GNF5 td(nWEIV-CLEIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_ben[1:0] invalid F - 0.2 (6) F + 2.0 ns GNF6 td(nWEIV-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid G - 0.2 (7) G + 2.0 ns GNF7 td(ALEH-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_advn_ale high to gpmc_wen valid C - 0.2 (3) C + 2.0 ns GNF8 td(nWEIV-ALEIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_advn_ale invalid F - 0.2 (6) F + 2.0 ns GNF9 tc(nWE) Cycle time, write cycle time GNF10 td(nCSV-nOEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren valid GNF13 tw(nOEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_oen_ren valid time GNF14 tc(nOE) Cycle time, read cycle time GNF15 td(nOEIV-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_oen_ren invalid to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (3) (6) (8) H I - 0.2 (9) I + 2.0 L M - 0.2 (11) ns (9) ns K ns (10) ns M + 2.0 (11) ns (1) A = (WEOffTime – WEOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (2) B = ((WEOnTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (3) C = ((WEOnTime – ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay – ADVExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (4) D = (WEOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (5) E = (WrCycleTime – WEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) – 0.5 * WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (6) F = (ADVWrOffTime – WEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay – WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (7) G = (CSWrOffTime – WEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay – WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (8) H = WrCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (9) I = ((OEOffTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (10) K = (OEOffTime – OEOnTime) * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (11) L = RdCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (12) M = (CSRdOffTime – OEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay – OEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 135 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK GNF1 GNF6 GNF2 GNF5 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren GNF0 gpmc_wen GNF3 GNF4 Command gpmc_ad[15:0] GPMC_13 (1) Figure 5-28. GPMC / NAND Flash - Command Latch Cycle Timing (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. GPMC_FCLK GNF1 GNF6 GNF7 GNF8 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren GNF9 GNF0 gpmc_wen GNF3 gpmc_ad[15:0] GNF4 Address GPMC_14 Figure 5-29. GPMC / NAND Flash - Address Latch Cycle Timing(1) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. 136 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 GPMC_FCLK GNF12 GNF10 GNF15 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale GNF14 GNF13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] DATA gpmc_waitj GPMC_15 Figure 5-30. GPMC / NAND Flash - Data Read Cycle Timing(1)(2)(3) (1) GNF12 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after GNF12 functional clock cycles, input data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. GNF12 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (2) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally. (3) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. GPMC_FCLK GNF1 GNF6 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren GNF9 GNF0 gpmc_wen GNF3 GNF4 gpmc_ad[15:0] DATA GPMC_16 (1) Figure 5-31. GPMC / NAND Flash - Data Write Cycle Timing (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented Table 4-28 and described in Device TRM, Control Module section. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 137 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.9.6.7 www.ti.com GP Timers The device has eight GP timers: TIMER1 through TIMER8. • TIMER1 (1-ms tick) includes a specific function to generate accurate tick interrupts to the operating system and it belongs to the PD_WKUPAON domain. • TIMER2 through TIMER8 belong to the PD_COREAON module. Each timer can be clocked from the system clock (19.2, 20, or 27 MHz) or the 32-kHz clock. Select the clock source at the power, reset, and clock management (PRCM) module level. Each timer provides an interrupt through the device IRQ_CROSSBAR. Each timer is connected to an external pin by their PWM output or their event capture input pin (for external timer triggering). 5.9.6.7.1 GP Timer Features The following are the main features of the GP timer controllers: • Level 4 (L4) slave interface support: – 32-bit data bus width – 32- or 16-bit access supported – 8-bit access not supported – 10-bit address bus width – Burst mode not supported – Write nonposted transaction mode supported • Interrupts generated on overflow, compare, and capture • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • Compare and capture modes • Autoreload mode • Start and stop mode • Programmable divider clock source (2n, where n = [0:8]) • Dedicated input trigger for capture mode and dedicated output trigger/PWM signal • Dedicated GP output signal for using the TIMERi_GPO_CFG signal • On-the-fly read/write register (while counting) • 1-ms tick with 32.768-Hz functional clock generated (only TIMER1) 5.9.6.8 I2C The device includes 2 inter-integrated circuit (I2C) modules which provide an interface to other devices compliant with Philips Semiconductors Inter-IC bus (I2C-bus™) specification version 2.1. External components attached to this 2-wire serial bus can transmit/receive 8-bit data to/from the device through the I2C module. NOTE Note that, I2C1 and I2C2, due to characteristics of the open drain IO cells, HS mode is not supported. NOTE Inter-integrated circuit i (i=1 to 2) module is also referred to as I2Ci. 138 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 NOTE For more information, see the Multimaster I2C Controller section of the Device TRM. Table 5-41 and Figure 5-32 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 5-41. Timing Requirements for I2C Input Timings(1) NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION STANDARD MODE MIN FAST MODE MAX MIN MAX UNIT tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 10 2.5 µs 2 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Setup time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 4.7 0.6 µs 3 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a START and a repeated START condition) 4 0.6 µs 4 tw(SCLL) Pulse duration, SCL low 4.7 1.3 µs 5 tw(SCLH) Pulse duration, SCL high 4 0.6 µs 6 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid before SCL high 250 100(2) 7 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low 0(3) 8 tw(SDAH) Pulse duration, SDA high between STOP and START conditions 4.7 9 tr(SDA) Rise time, SDA 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 10 tr(SCL) Rise time, SCL 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 11 tf(SDA) Fall time, SDA 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 12 tf(SCL) Fall time, SCL 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 13 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for STOP condition) 14 tw(SP) Pulse duration, spike (must be suppressed) 15 Cb (5) Capacitive load for each bus line 3.45(4) ns 0(3) 0.9(4) 1.3 µs (5) (5) (5) 4 µs (5) 0.6 µs 0 400 50 ns 400 pF (1) The I2C pins SDA and SCL do not feature fail-safe I/O buffers. These pins could potentially draw current when the device is powered down. (2) A Fast-mode I2C-bus™ device can be used in a Standard-mode I2C-bus system, but the requirement tsu(SDA-SCLH)≥ 250 ns must then be met. This will automatically be the case if the device does not stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal. If such a device does stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal, it must output the next data bit to the SDA line tr max + tsu(SDA-SCLH)= 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (according to the Standard-mode I2C-Bus Specification) before the SCL line is released. (3) A device must internally provide a hold time of at least 300 ns for the SDA signal (referred to the VIHmin of the SCL signal) to bridge the undefined region of the falling edge of SCL. (4) The maximum th(SDA-SCLL) has only to be met if the device does not stretch the low period [tw(SCLL)] of the SCL signal. (5) Cb = total capacitance of one bus line in pF. If mixed with HS-mode devices, faster fall-times are allowed. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 139 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 9 11 I2Ci_SDA 6 8 14 4 13 5 10 I2Ci_SCL 1 12 3 7 2 3 Stop Start Repeated Start Stop SPRS91v_I2C_01 Figure 5-32. I2C Receive Timing Table 5-42 and Figure 5-33 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 5-42. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for I2C Output Timings(2) NO. 16 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION STANDARD MODE MIN MAX FAST MODE MIN MAX UNIT tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 10 2.5 µs 17 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Setup time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 4.7 0.6 µs 18 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a START and a repeated START condition) 4 0.6 µs 19 tw(SCLL) Pulse duration, SCL low 4.7 1.3 µs 20 tw(SCLH) Pulse duration, SCL high 4 0.6 µs 21 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid before SCL high 250 100 ns 22 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low (for I2C bus devices) 23 tw(SDAH) Pulse duration, SDA high between STOP and START conditions 24 tr(SDA) Rise time, SDA 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 25 tr(SCL) Rise time, SCL 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 26 tf(SDA) Fall time, SDA 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 27 tf(SCL) Fall time, SCL 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 28 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for STOP condition) 29 Cp Capacitance for each I2C pin 140 0 3.45 4.7 0.9 1.3 4 Specifications 0 (1) (1) (1) (1) µs 0.6 10 µs µs 10 pF Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 (1) Cb = total capacitance of one bus line in pF. If mixed with HS-mode devices, faster fall-times are allowed. (2) Software must properly configure the I2C module registers to achieve the timings shown in this table. See the Device TRM for details. 24 26 I2Ci_SDA 21 23 19 28 20 25 I2Ci_SCL 27 16 18 22 17 18 Stop Start Repeated Start Stop SPRS91v_I2C_02 Figure 5-33. I2C Transmit Timing 5.9.6.9 UART The UART performs serial-to-parallel conversions on data received from a peripheral device and parallelto-serial conversion on data received from the CPU. There are 3 UART modules in the device. Each UART can be used for configuration and data exchange with a number of external peripheral devices or interprocessor communication between devices. The UARTi (where i = 1 to 3) include the following features: • 16C750 compatibility • 64-byte FIFO buffer for receiver and 64-byte FIFO for transmitter • Baud generation based on programmable divisors N (where N = 1…16 384) operating from a fixed functional clock of 48 MHz or 192 MHz • Break character detection and generation • Configurable data format: – Data bit: 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits – Parity bit: Even, odd, none – Stop-bit: 1, 1.5, 2 bit(s) • Flow control: Hardware (RTS/CTS) or software (XON/XOFF) NOTE For more information, see the UART section of the Device TRM. Table 5-43, Table 5-44 and Figure 5-34 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 5-43. Timing Requirements for UART NO. MIN MAX UNIT 4 tw(RX) PARAMETER Pulse width, receive data bit, 15/30/100pF high or low DESCRIPTION 0.96U(1) 1.05U(1) ns 5 tw(CTS) Pulse width, receive start bit, 15/30/100pF high or low 0.96U(1) 1.05U(1) ns (2) ns ns td(RTS-TX) Delay time, transmit start bit to transmit data P td(CTS-TX) Delay time, receive start bit to transmit data P(2) Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 141 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate (2) P = Clock period of the reference clock (FCLK, usually 48 MHz or 192MHz). Table 5-44. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for UART NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX 15 pF 12 30 pF 0.23 UNIT f(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate 2 tw(TX) Pulse width, transmit data bit, 15/30/100 pF high or low U - 2(1) U + 2(1) ns 3 tw(RTS) Pulse width, transmit start bit, 15/30/100 pF high or low U - 2(1) U + 2(1) ns 100 pF MHz 0.115 (1) U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate 3 2 Start Bit UARTi_TXD Data Bits 5 4 Start Bit UARTi_RXD Data Bits SPRS91v_UART_01 Figure 5-34. UART Timing CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-45. In Table 5-45 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with UART. Table 5-45. UART1-3 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL IOSET3 BALL MUX MUX uart1_rxd F13 0 F13 0 uart1_txd E14 0 E14 0 uart1_rtsn C14 0 uart1_ctsn F14 0 BALL MUX UART1 UART2 uart2_rxd E7 2 D14 0 uart2_txd F7 2 D15 0 uart2_rtsn F16 0 uart2_ctsn F15 0 UART3 uart3_rxd W7 4 L1 1 M2 1 uart3_txd W6 4 L2 1 R6 1 R7 1 T5 1 uart3_rtsn 142 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-45. UART1-3 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX N4 1 U6 1 uart3_ctsn 5.9.6.10 McSPI The McSPI is a master/slave synchronous serial bus. There are four separate McSPI modules (SPI1, SPI2, SPI3, and SPI4) in the device. All these four modules support up to four external devices (four chip selects) and are able to work as both master and slave. The McSPI modules include the following main features: • Serial clock with programmable frequency, polarity, and phase for each channel • Wide selection of SPI word lengths, ranging from 4 to 32 bits • Up to four master channels, or single channel in slave mode • Master multichannel mode: – Full duplex/half duplex – Transmit-only/receive-only/transmit-and-receive modes – Flexible input/output (I/O) port controls per channel – Programmable clock granularity – SPI configuration per channel. This means, clock definition, polarity enabling and word width • Power management through wake-up capabilities • Programmable timing control between chip select and external clock generation • Built-in FIFO available for a single channel. • Each SPI module supports multiple chip select pins spim_cs[i], where i = 1 to 4. NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface section of the device TRM. NOTE The McSPIm module (m = 1 to 4) is also referred to as SPIm. Table 5-46, Figure 5-35 and Figure 5-36 present Timing Requirements for McSPI - Master Mode. Table 5-46. Timing Requirements for SPI - Master Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SM1 tc(SPICLK) Cycle time, spi_sclk (1) (2) SM2 tw(SPICLKL) Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk low SM3 tw(SPICLKH) Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk high SM4 tsu(MISO-SPICLK) SM5 th(SPICLK-MISO) SM6 SM7 td(SPICLK-SIMO) td(CS-SIMO) MODE MIN SPI1/2/3/ 4 20.8 ns 0.5*P-1 (3) ns 0.5*P-1 (3) ns Setup time, spi_d[x] valid before spi_sclk active edge (1) 2.29 ns Hold time, spi_d[x] valid after spi_sclk active edge (1) 2.67 ns (1) (1) Delay time, spi_sclk active edge to spi_d[x] transition (1) Delay time, spi_cs[x] active edge to spi_d[x] transition MAX SPI1/2/4 -3.57 3.57 ns SPI3 -3.57 3.57 ns 3.57 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 143 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-46. Timing Requirements for SPI - Master Mode (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SM8 td(CS-SPICLK) Delay time, spi_cs[x] active to spi_sclk first edge (1) MODE MIN MAX UNIT MASTER B-4.2 (5) _PHA0 ns MASTER A-4.2 (6) _PHA1 ns MASTER A-4.2 (6) _PHA0 ns MASTER B-4.2 (5) _PHA1 ns (4) (4) SM9 td(SPICLK-CS) Delay time, spi_sclk last edge to spi_cs[x] inactive (1) (4) (4) (1) This timing applies to all configurations regardless of SPI_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. (2) Related to the SPI_CLK maximum frequency. (3) P = SPICLK period. (4) SPI_CLK phase is programmable with the PHA bit of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. (5) B = (TCS + 0.5) * TSPICLKREF * Fratio, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register and Fratio = Even ≥2. (6) When P = 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 1) * TSPICLKREF, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. When P > 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 0.5) * Fratio * TSPICLKREF, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. (7) The IO timings provided in this section are applicable for all combinations of signals for spi1 and spi2. However, the timings are only valid for spi3 and spi4 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the following tables. 144 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM1 SM3 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM2 SM9 POL=0 SM3 SM1 SM2 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM7 SM6 Bit n-1 spim_d(OUT) SM6 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM2 SM1 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM3 SM9 POL=0 SM1 SM2 SM3 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM6 SM6 Bit n-1 spim_d(OUT) Bit n-2 SM6 Bit n-3 SM6 Bit 1 Bit0 SPRS91v_McSPI_01 Figure 5-35. McSPI - Master Mode Transmit Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 145 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM1 SM3 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM2 SM9 POL=0 SM3 SM1 SM2 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM5 SM5 spim_d(IN) SM4 SM4 Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM2 SM1 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM3 SM9 POL=0 SM1 SM2 SM3 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM5 SM4 SM4 Bit n-1 spim_d(IN) SM5 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 1 Bit 0 SPRS91v_McSPI_02 Figure 5-36. McSPI - Master Mode Receive Table 5-47, Figure 5-37 and Figure 5-38 present Timing Requirements for McSPI - Slave Mode. Table 5-47. Timing Requirements for SPI - Slave Mode(5) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SS1 (1) NO. tc(SPICLK) Cycle time, spi_sclk SS2 (1) tw(SPICLKL) (3) Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk low SS3 (1) tw(SPICLKH) (3) Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk high 0.45*P ns ns (2) MODE MIN SPI1 25 ns 33.3 ns 0.45*P ns SPI2/3/4 SS4 (1) tsu(SIMO-SPICLK) Setup time, spi_d[x] valid before spi_sclk active edge 2.82 SS5 (1) th(SPICLK-SIMO) Hold time, spi_d[x] valid after spi_sclk active edge 2.82 SS6 (1) td(SPICLK-SOMI) Delay time, spi_sclk active edge to mcspi_somi transition SS7 (4) td(CS-SOMI) Delay time, spi_cs[x] active edge to mcspi_somi transition 146 Specifications MAX UNIT ns SPI1 2 9.8 ns SPI2/3/4 2 21 ns 16 ns Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-47. Timing Requirements for SPI - Slave Mode(5) (continued) NO. SS8 (1) SS9 (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tsu(CS-SPICLK) Setup time, spi_cs[x] valid before spi_sclk first edge MODE 2.82 MIN MAX UNIT ns th(SPICLK-CS) Hold time, spi_cs[x] valid after spi_sclk last edge 2.82 ns (1) This timing applies to all configurations regardless of SPI_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. (2) When operating the SPI interface in RX-only mode, the minimum Cycle time is 26ns (38.4MHz) (3) P = SPICLK period. (4) PHA = 0; SPI_CLK phase is programmable with the PHA bit of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. (5) The IO timings provided in this section are applicable for all combinations of signals for spi1 and spi2. However, the timings are only valid for spi3 and spi4 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the following tables. PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS2 SS1 SS3 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS7 SS6 Bit n-1 spim_d(OUT) SS6 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS3 SS1 SS2 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS6 spim_d(OUT) SS6 Bit n-1 Bit n-2 SS6 Bit n-3 SS6 Bit 1 Bit 0 SPRS91v_McSPI_03 Figure 5-37. McSPI - Slave Mode Transmit Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 147 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS2 SS1 SS3 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS5 SS4 SS4 SS5 Bit n-1 spim_d(IN) Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS3 SS1 SS2 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS4 SS5 SS4 Bit n-1 spim_d(IN) SS5 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 1 Bit0 SPRS91v_McSPI_04 Figure 5-38. McSPI - Slave Mode Receive CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are applicable for all combinations of signals for SPI2 and SPI4. However, the timings are only valid for SPI1 and SPI3 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-48. In Table 5-48 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with McSPI. Table 5-48. McSPI1/3 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL IOSET3 MUX BALL MUX 0 M2 0 SPI1 spi1_sclk 148 M2 0 M2 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-48. McSPI1/3 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX spi1_d1 U6 0 U6 0 U6 0 spi1_d0 T5 0 T5 0 T5 0 spi1_cs0 R6 0 R6 0 R6 0 R5 0 spi1_cs2 F14 5 spi1_cs3 C14 5 spi1_cs1 SPI3 spi3_sclk F15 4 C6 4 spi3_d1 D14 4 F7 4 spi3_d0 D15 4 E7 4 spi3_cs0 F16 4 B6 4 5.9.6.11 QSPI The Quad SPI (QSPI) module is a type of SPI module that allows single, dual or quad read access to external SPI devices. This module has a memory mapped register interface, which provides a direct interface for accessing data from external SPI devices and thus simplifying software requirements. It works as a master only. There is one QSPI module in the device and it is primary intended for fast booting from quad-SPI flash memories. General SPI features: • Programmable clock divider • Six pin interface (DCLK, CS_N, DOUT, DIN, QDIN1, QDIN2) • 4 external chip select signals • Support for 3-, 4- or 6-pin SPI interface • Programmable CS_N to DOUT delay from 0 to 3 DCLKs • Programmable signal polarities • Programmable active clock edge • Software controllable interface allowing for any type of SPI transfer NOTE For more information, see the Quad Serial Peripheral Interface section of the Device TRM. CAUTION The IO Timings provided in this section are only valid when all QSPI Chip Selects used in a system are configured to use the same Clock Mode (either Clock Mode 0 or Clock Mode 3). Table 5-49 and Table 5-50 present Timing and Switching Characteristics for Quad SPI Interface. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 149 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-49. Switching Characteristics for QSPI No 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION Mode MIN tc(SCLK) Cycle time, sclk Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 0 10.4 MAX UNIT ns Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 15.625 ns Y*P-1 (1) ns 2 tw(SCLKL) Pulse duration, sclk low 3 tw(SCLKH) Pulse duration, sclk high 4 td(CS-SCLK) Delay time, sclk falling edge to cs active edge, CS3:0 Default Timing Mode -M*P-1 (2) (3) -M*P+1 (2) (3) ns 5 td(SCLK-CS) Delay time, sclk falling edge to cs inactive edge, CS3:0 Default Timing Mode N*P-1 (2) (3) N*P+1 (2) (3) ns 6 td(SCLK-D1) Delay time, sclk falling edge to d[0] transition Default Timing Mode -1 1 ns 7 tena(CS-D1LZ) Enable time, cs active edge to d[0] driven (lo-z) -P-3.5 -P+2.5 ns 8 tdis(CS-D1Z) Disable time, cs active edge to d[0] tri-stated (hi-z) -P-2.5 -P+2.0 ns 9 td(SCLK-D1) Delay time, sclk first falling edge to first d[0] transition -1-P -1-P ns Y*P-1 (1) PHA=0 Only, Default Timing Mode ns (1) The Y parameter is defined as follows: If DCLK_DIV is 0 or ODD then, Y equals 0.5. If DCLK_DIV is EVEN then, Y equals (DCLK_DIV/2) / (DCLK_DIV+1). For best performance, it is recommended to use a DCLK_DIV of 0 or ODD to minimize the duty cycle distortion. The HSDIVIDER on CLKOUTX2_H13 output of DPLL_PER can be used to achieve the desired clock divider ratio. All required details about clock division factor DCLK_DIV can be found in the device TRM. (2) P = SCLK period. (3) M=QSPI_SPI_DC_REG.DDx + 1 when Clock Mode 0. M=QSPI_SPI_DC_REG.DDx when Clock Mode 3. N = 2 when Clock Mode 0. N = 3 when Clock Mode 3. 150 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 PHA=1 cs Q5 Q1 POL=1 Q4 Q3 Q2 sclk Q15 Q14 Q6 Q7 Q6 Command Bit n-1 d[0] Command Bit n-2 d[3:1] Q12 Q13 Read Data Read Data Bit 1 Bit 0 Q14 Q15 Q12 Q13 Read Data Read Data Bit 1 Bit 0 SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_01 Figure 5-39. QSPI Read (Clock Mode 3) PHA=0 cs Q5 Q4 Q1 Q2 POL=0 Q3 sclk POL=0 rtclk Q7 d[0] Q6 Q9 Command Command Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Q12 Q13 Read Data Bit 1 Q12 Q13 Read Data Bit 1 d[3:1] Q12 Q13 Read Data Bit 0 Q12 Q13 Read Data Bit 0 SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_02 Figure 5-40. QSPI Read (Clock Mode 0) Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 151 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-50. Timing Requirements for QSPI No PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN 12 tsu(D-RTCLK) Setup time, d[3:0] valid before falling rtclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 0 2.9 ns tsu(D-SCLK) Setup time, d[3:0] valid before falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 5.7 ns th(RTCLK-D) Hold time, d[3:0] valid after falling rtclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 0 -0.1 ns th(SCLK-D) Hold time, d[3:0] valid after falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 0.1 ns 14 tsu(D-SCLK) Setup time, final d[3:0] bit valid before final falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 5.7-P (1) ns 15 th(SCLK-D) Hold time, final d[3:0] bit valid after final falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 0.1+P (1) ns 13 MAX UNIT (1) P = SCLK period. (2) Clock Modes 1 and 2 are not supported. (3) The Device captures data on the falling clock edge in Clock Mode 0 and 3, as opposed to the traditional rising clock edge. Although non-standard, the falling-edge-based setup and hold time timings have been designed to be compatible with standard SPI devices that launch data on the falling edge in Clock Modes 0 and 3. PHA=1 cs Q5 POL=1 Q1 Q4 Q3 Q2 sclk Q7 d[0] Command Bit n-1 Command Bit n-2 Q8 Q6 Q6 Q6 Q6 Write Data Bit 1 Write Data Bit 0 d[3:1] SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_03 Figure 5-41. QSPI Write (Clock Mode 3) 152 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 PHA=0 cs Q5 Q4 Q1 Q2 POL=0 Q3 sclk Q9 Q6 Command Command Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Q7 d[0] Q6 Q8 Q6 Write Data Bit 1 Write Data Bit 0 d[3:1] SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_04 Figure 5-42. QSPI Write (Clock Mode 0) NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented in Table 4-28 and described in Device TRM, Control Module section. CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-51. In Table 5-51 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with QSPI. Table 5-51. QSPI IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 IOSET3 IOSET4 BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX qspi1_sclk C8 1 C8 1 C8 1 C8 1 qspi1_rtclk C14 8 B7 1 F13 5 D8 2 qspi1_d0 B9 1 B9 1 B9 1 B9 1 qspi1_d1 F10 1 F10 1 F10 1 F10 1 qspi1_d2 A9 1 A9 1 A9 1 A9 1 qspi1_d3 D10 1 D10 1 D10 1 D10 1 qspi1_cs0 E10 1 E10 1 E10 1 E10 1 F15 5 qspi1_cs1 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 153 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 5.9.6.12 McASP The multichannel audio serial port (McASP) functions as a general-purpose audio serial port optimized for the needs of multichannel audio applications. The McASP is useful for time-division multiplexed (TDM) stream, Inter-Integrated Sound (I2S) protocols, and inter-component digital audio interface transmission (DIT). NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface section of the Device TRM. Table 5-52, Table 5-53, Table 5-54 and Figure 5-43 present Timing Requirements for McASP1 to McASP3. Table 5-52. Timing Requirements for McASP1 (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tc(AHCLKX) Cycle time, AHCLKX 2 tw(AHCLKX) Pulse duration, AHCLKX high or low 3 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 4 5 6 7 8 tw(ACLKRX) tsu(AFSRX-ACLK) th(ACLK-AFSRX) tsu(AXR-ACLK) th(ACLK-AXR) MODE Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low MIN MAX UNIT 20 ns 0.35P ns (2) Any Other Conditions 20 ns ACLKX/AFSX (In Sync Mode), ACLKR/AFSR (In Async Mode), and AXR are all inputs 15.258 ns Any Other Conditions 0.5R - 3 ns ACLKX/AFSX (In Sync Mode), ACLKR/AFSR (In Async Mode), and AXR are all inputs 0.38R ns Setup time, AFSR/X input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AFSR/X input valid after ACLKR/X Setup time, AXR input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AXR input valid after ACLKR/X (3) (3) ACLKR/X int 18.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 3 ns ACLKR/X int 0.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.4 ns ACLKR/X int 18.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 3 ns ACLKR/X int 0.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.4 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKX period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 5-53. Timing Requirements for McASP2 (1) NO. 154 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tc(AHCLKX) Cycle time, AHCLKX MODE 2 tw(AHCLKX) Pulse duration, AHCLKX high or low Specifications MIN MAX UNIT 20 ns 0.35P ns (2) Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-53. Timing Requirements for McASP2 (1) (continued) NO. 3 4 5 6 7 8 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X tw(ACLKRX) tsu(AFSRX-ACLK) th(ACLK-AFSRX) tsu(AXR-ACLK) th(ACLK-AXR) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low MODE MIN Any Other Conditions 20 ns IOSET1 only, ACLKX/AFSX (In Sync Mode), ACLKR/AFSR (In Async Mode), and AXR are all inputs 15.258 ns Any Other Conditions 0.5R - 3 ns IOSET1 only, ACLKX/AFSX (In Sync Mode), ACLKR/AFSR (In Async Mode), and AXR are all inputs 0.38R ns Setup time, AFSR/X input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AFSR/X input valid after ACLKR/X Setup time, AXR input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AXR input valid after ACLKR/X MAX (3) (3) UNIT ACLKR/X int 18.5 ns IOSET1 (vout1_*): ACLKR/X ext in IOSET1 (vout1_*): ACLKR/X ext out 4 ns IOSET2 (gpmc_*): ACLKR/X ext in IOSET2 (gpmc_*): ACLKR/X ext out 3 ns ACLKR/X int 0.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.4 ns ACLKR/X int 18.5 ns IOSET1 (vout1_*): ACLKR/X ext in IOSET1 (vout1_*): ACLKR/X ext out 12 ns IOSET2 (gpmc_*): ACLKR/X ext in IOSET2 (gpmc_*): ACLKR/X ext out 3 ns ACLKR/X int 0.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.4 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKX period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 5-54. Timing Requirements for McASP3 (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tc(AHCLKX) Cycle time, AHCLKX MODE 2 tw(AHCLKX) Pulse duration, AHCLKX high or low 3 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 4 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 5 tsu(AFSRX-ACLK) Setup time, AFSR/X input valid before ACLKR/X MIN MAX ns 0.35P ns 20 ns 0.5R - 3 ns ACLKR/X int 18.2 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 4 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 20 155 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-54. Timing Requirements for McASP3 (1) (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 6 th(ACLK-AFSRX) Hold time, AFSR/X input valid after ACLKR/X tsu(AXR-ACLK) 8 th(ACLK-AXR) Setup time, AXR input valid before ACLKX Hold time, AXR input valid after ACLKX MODE MIN ACLKR/X int 0.5 MAX UNIT ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.4 ns ACLKX int (ASYNC=0) 18.2 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 12 ns ACLKX int (ASYNC=0) 0.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.5 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 (NOT SUPPORTED) ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKX period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. 156 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 2 1 2 AHCLKX (Falling Edge Polarity) AHCLKX (Rising Edge Polarity) 4 3 4 ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 0)(A) ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 1)(B) 6 5 AFSR/X (Bit Width, 0 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Bit Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Bit Width, 2 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 0 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 2 Bit Delay) 8 7 AXR[n] (Data In/Receive) A0 A1 A30 A31 B0 B1 B30 B31 C0 C1 C2 C3 C31 SPRS91v_McASP_01 A. B. For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for 0, the McASP transmitter is configured for rising edge (to shift data out) and the McASP falling edge (to shift data in). 1, the McASP transmitter is configured for falling edge (to shift data out) and the McASP rising edge (to shift data in). Figure 5-43. McASP Input Timing Table 5-55, Table 5-56, Table 5-57 and Figure 5-44 present Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP1 to McASP3. Table 5-55. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP1 NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE 9 tc(AHCLKX) Cycle time, AHCLKX 10 tw(AHCLKX) Pulse duration, AHCLKX high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 12 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 13 td(ACLK-AFSXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AFSX/R output valid MIN (1) MAX 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (2) ns 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (3) ns ACLKR/X int 0 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 22.2 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 157 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-55. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP1 (1) (continued) NO. 14 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION td(ACLK-AXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AXR output valid MODE MIN MAX UNIT ACLKR/X int 0 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 22.2 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKX period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 5-56. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP2 NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 9 tc(AHCLKX) Cycle time, AHCLKX 10 tw(AHCLKX) Pulse duration, AHCLKX high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 12 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 13 td(ACLK-AFSXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AFSX/R output valid 14 td(ACLK-AXR) MODE Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AXR output valid MIN MAX (1) UNIT 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (2) ns 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (3) ns ACLKR/X int 0 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 22.2 ns ACLKR/X int 0 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 22.2 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKX period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 5-57. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP3 NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 9 tc(AHCLKX) Cycle time, AHCLKX 10 tw(AHCLKX) Pulse duration, AHCLKX high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 12 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 13 td(ACLK-AFSXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AFSX/R output valid 14 158 td(ACLK-AXR) MODE Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AXR output valid Specifications MIN MAX (1) UNIT 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 ns 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 ns ACLKR/X int 0 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 23.1 ns ACLKR/X int 0 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 23.1 ns Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKX period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. 10 10 9 AHCLKX (Falling Edge Polarity) AHCLKX (Rising Edge Polarity) 12 11 12 ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 1)(A) ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 0)(B) 13 13 13 13 AFSR/X (Bit Width, 0 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Bit Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Bit Width, 2 Bit Delay) 13 13 13 AFSR/X (Slot Width, 0 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 2 Bit Delay) 14 15 AXR[n] (Data Out/Transmit) A0 A1 A30 A31 B0 B1 B30 B31 C0 C1 C2 C3 C31 SPRS91v_McASP_02 A. B. For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for 1, the McASP transmitter is configured for falling edge (to shift data out) and the McASP rising edge (to shift data in). 0, the McASP transmitter is configured for rising edge (to shift data out) and the McASP falling edge (to shift data in). Figure 5-44. McASP Output Timing Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 159 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented Table 4-28 and described in Device TRM, Control Module section. CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-58. In Table 5-58 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with McASP1. Table 5-58. McASP1 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX mcasp1_aclkx U17 mcasp1_fsx W17 mcasp1_aclkr AA17 1 IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX 1 U17 1 W17 1 U17 1 1 W17 1 mcasp1_fsr U16 1 mcasp1_axr0 W16 1 W16 1 W16 1 mcasp1_axr1 V16 1 V16 1 V16 1 mcasp1_axr2 U15 1 mcasp1_axr3 V15 1 mcasp1_axr4 Y15 1 mcasp1_axr5 W15 1 mcasp1_axr6 AA15 1 mcasp1_axr7 AB15 1 mcasp1_axr8 AA14 1 AA14 1 U15 4 mcasp1_axr9 AB14 1 AB14 1 V15 4 mcasp1_axr10 U13 1 Y15 4 mcasp1_axr11 V13 1 W15 4 mcasp1_axr12 Y13 1 AA15 4 mcasp1_axr13 W13 1 AB15 4 mcasp1_axr14 U11 1 U7 4 mcasp1_axr15 V11 1 V7 4 5.9.6.13 DCAN and MCAN 5.9.6.13.1 DCAN The device provides one DCAN interface for supporting distributed realtime control with a high level of security. The DCAN interface implements the following features: • Supports CAN protocol version 2.0 part A, B • Bit rates up to 1 MBit/s • 64 message objects • Individual identifier mask for each message object • Programmable FIFO mode for message objects 160 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Programmable loop-back modes for self-test operation Suspend mode for debug support Automatic bus on after Bus-Off state by a programmable 32-bit timer Message RAM single error correction and double error detection (SECDED) mechanism Direct access to Message RAM during test mode Support for two interrupt lines: Level 0 and Level 1, plus separate ECC interrupt line Local power down and wakeup support Automatic message RAM initialization Support for DMA access 5.9.6.13.2 MCAN The device supports one MCAN module connecting to the CAN network through external (for the device) transceiver for connection to the physical layer. The MCAN module supports up to 5 Mbit/s data rate and is compliant to ISO 11898-1:2015. The MCAN module implements the following features: • Conforms with ISO 11898-1:2015 • Full CAN FD support (up to 64 data bytes) • AUTOSAR and SAE J1939 support • Up to 32 dedicated Transmit Buffers • Configurable Transmit FIFO, up to 32 elements • Configurable Transmit Queue, up to 32 elements • Configurable Transmit Event FIFO, up to 32 elements • Up to 64 dedicated Receive Buffers • Two configurable Receive FIFOs, up to 64 elements each • Up to 128 filter elements • Internal Loopback mode for self-test • Maskable interrupts, two interrupt lines • Two clock domains (CAN clock/Host clock) • Parity/ECC support - Message RAM single error correction and double error detection (SECDED) mechanism • Local power-down and wakeup support • Timestamp Counter NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interfaces / DCAN and MCAN sections of the Device TRM. Table 5-59, Table 5-60 and Figure 5-45 present Timing and Switching characteristics for DCAN and MCAN Interface. Table 5-59. Timing Requirements for DCAN Receive(1) NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION f(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate tw(DCANRX) Pulse duration, receive data bit (DCANx_RX) MIN H - 15 NOM MAX UNIT 1 Mbps H + 15 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 161 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) H = period of baud rate, 1/programmed baud rate. (1) Table 5-60. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DCAN Transmit NO. 2 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION f(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate tw(DCANTX) Pulse duration, transmit data bit (DCANx_TX) MIN MAX UNIT 1 Mbps H - 15 H + 15 ns (1) H = period of baud rate, 1/programmed baud rate. 1 DCANx_RX 2 DCANx_TX SPRS91v_DCAN_01 Figure 5-45. DCAN and MCAN Timings CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-61. In Table 5-61 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with DCAN and MCAN. Table 5-61. DCAN and MCAN IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL IOSET3 MUX IOSET4 BALL MUX BALL MUX DCAN1 dcan1_tx N5 0 D14 12 F14 12 dcan1_rx N6 0 D15 12 C14 12 MCAN mcan_tx W7 0 F13 12 F15 12 mcan_rx W6 0 E14 12 F16 12 5.9.6.14 GMAC_SW The two-port gigabit ethernet switch subsystem (GMAC_SW) provides ethernet packet communication and can be configured as an ethernet switch. It provides Reduced Gigabit Media Independent Interface (RGMII), and the Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) for physical layer device (PHY) management. NOTE For more information, see the Gigabit Ethernet Switch (GMAC_SW) section of the Device TRM. NOTE The Gigabit, Reduced and Media Independent Interface n (n = 0 to 1) are also referred to as RGMIIn 162 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 5.9.6.14.1 GMAC MDIO Interface Timings Table 5-62, Table 5-63 and Figure 5-46 present Timing Requirements for MDIO. Table 5-62. Timing Requirements for MDIO Input No PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 1 tc(MDC) Cycle time, MDC 400 ns 2 tw(MDCH) Pulse Duration, MDC High 160 ns 3 tw(MDCL) Pulse Duration, MDC Low 160 ns 4 tsu(MDIO-MDC) Setup time, MDIO valid before MDC High 90 ns 5 th(MDIO_MDC) Hold time, MDIO valid from MDC High 0 ns Table 5-63. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for MDIO Output No PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 6 tt(MDC) Transition time, MDC MIN 7 td(MDC-MDIO) Delay time, MDC High to MDIO valid 10 MAX UNIT 5 ns 390 ns 1 MDIO2 MDIO3 MDCLK MDIO6 MDIO6 MDIO4 MDIO5 MDIO (input) MDIO7 MDIO (output) SPRS91v_GMAC_07 Figure 5-46. GMAC MDIO diagrams Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 163 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 5.9.6.14.2 GMAC RGMII Timings Table 5-64, Table 5-65 and Figure 5-47 present Timing Requirements for receive RGMIIn operation. Table 5-64. Timing Requirements for rgmiin_rxc - RGMIIn Operation NO. 1 2 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX UNIT tc(RXC) Cycle time, rgmiin_rxc 10 Mbps 360 440 ns tw(RXCH) 3 Pulse duration, rgmiin_rxc high tw(RXCL) 4 Pulse duration, rgmiin_rxc low tt(RXC) Transition time, rgmiin_rxc 100 Mbps 36 44 ns 1000 Mbps 7.2 8.8 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 0.75 ns 100 Mbps 0.75 ns 1000 Mbps 0.75 ns Table 5-65. Timing Requirements for GMAC RGMIIn Input Receive for 10/100/1000 Mbps NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN 5 tsu(RXD-RXCH) Setup time, receive selected signals valid before rgmiin_rxc high/low 1.15 MAX UNIT ns 6 th(RXCH-RXD) Hold time, receive selected signals valid after rgmiin_rxc high/low 1.15 ns (1) For RGMII, receive selected signals include: rgmiin_rxd[3:0] and rgmiin_rxctl. (2) RGMII0 requires that the 4 data pins rgmii0_rxd[3:0] and rgmii0_rxctl have their board propagation delays matched within 50pS of rgmii0_rxc. (3) RGMII1 requires that the 4 data pins rgmii1_rxd[3:0] and rgmii1_rxctl have their board propagation delays matched within 50pS of rgmii1_rxc. 1 4 2 rgmiin_rxc 4 3 (A) 5 1st Half-byte 2nd Half-byte rgmiin_rxd[3:0] rgmiin_rxctl (B) (B) RGRXD[3:0] RGRXD[7:4] RXDV RXERR 6 SPRS91v_GMAC_08 A. B. rgmiin_rxc must be externally delayed relative to the data and control pins. Data and control information is received using both edges of the clocks. rgmiin_rxd[3:0] carries data bits 3-0 on the rising edge of rgmiin_rxc and data bits 7-4 on the falling edge ofrgmiin_rxc. Similarly, rgmiin_rxctl carries RXDV on rising edge of rgmiin_rxc and RXERR on falling edge of rgmiin_rxc. Figure 5-47. GMAC Receive Interface Timing, RGMIIn operation Table 5-66, Table 5-67 and Figure 5-48 present switching characteristics for rgmiin_txctl - RGMIIn Operation for 10/100/1000 Mbit/s 164 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-66. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for rgmiin_txctl - RGMIIn Operation for 10/100/1000 Mbit/s NO. 1 2 3 4 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tc(TXC) Cycle time, rgmiin_txc tw(TXCH) tw(TXCL) tt(TXC) Pulse duration, rgmiin_txc high Pulse duration, rgmiin_txc low Transition time, rgmiin_txc SPEED MIN MAX UNIT 10 Mbps 360 440 ns 100 Mbps 36 44 ns 1000 Mbps 7.2 8.8 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 0.75 ns 100 Mbps 0.75 ns 1000 Mbps 0.75 ns Table 5-67. Switching Characteristics for GMAC RGMIIn Output Transmit for 10/100/1000 Mbps NO. 5 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE tosu(TXD-TXC) Output Setup time, transmit selected signals valid to rgmiin_txc high/low MIN MAX RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps 6 toh(TXC-TXD) Output Hold time, transmit selected signals valid after rgmiin_txc high/low 1.2 ns ns 1.2 ns RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps ns 1.2 ns RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps ns 1.2 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT ns RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps (1) 165 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) For RGMII, transmit selected signals include: rgmiin_txd[3:0] and rgmiin_txctl. (2) RGMII0 1000Mbps operation is not supported. (3) RGMII1 1000Mbps operation is not supported. 1 4 2 4 3 (A) rgmiin_txc [internal delay enabled] 5 (B) 1st Half-byte rgmiin_txd[3:0] 2nd Half-byte 6 (B) rgmiin_txctl TXEN TXERR SPRS91v_GMAC_09 A. B. TXC is delayed internally before being driven to the rgmiin_txc pin. This internal delay is always enabled. Data and control information is transmitted using both edges of the clocks. rgmiin_txd[3:0] carries data bits 3-0 on the rising edge of rgmiin_txc and data bits 7-4 on the falling edge of rgmiin_txc. Similarly, rgmiin_txctl carries TXEN on rising edge of rgmiin_txc and TXERR of falling edge of rgmiin_txc. Figure 5-48. GMAC Transmit Interface Timing RGMIIn operation 5.9.6.15 SDIO Controller MMC interface is compliant with the SDIO3.0 standard v1.0, SD Part E1 and for generic SDIO devices, it supports the following applications: • MMC 4-bit data, SD Default speed, SDR • MMC 4-bit data, SD High speed, SDR • MMC 4-bit data, UHS-I SDR12 (SD Standard v3.01), 4-bit data, SDR, half cycle • MMC 4-bit data, UHS-I SDR25 (SD Standard v3.01), 4-bit data, SDR, half cycle NOTE For more information, see the SDIO Controller chapter of the Device TRM. 5.9.6.15.1 MMC, SD Default Speed Figure 5-49, Figure 5-50, Table 5-68, and Table 5-69 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC - SD and SDIO Default speed in receiver and transmiter mode. Table 5-68. Timing Requirements for MMC - Default Speed Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN DS5 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_cmd valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge 5.11 MAX UNIT ns DS6 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc_cmd valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 20.46 ns DS7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge 5.11 ns DS8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 20.46 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 3 Table 5-69. Switching Characteristics for MMC - SD/SDIO Default Speed Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DS0 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc_clk DS1 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc_clk high 166 MIN Specifications 0.5*P0.270 MAX UNIT 24 MHz ns Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-69. Switching Characteristics for MMC - SD/SDIO Default Speed Mode (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DS2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc_clk low 0.5*P0.270 MIN MAX UNIT DS3 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_cmd transition -14.93 14.93 ns DS4 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_dat[i:0] transition -14.93 14.93 ns ns (1) P = output mmc_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 DS2 DS1 DS0 mmc_clk DS6 DS5 mmc_cmd DS8 DS7 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_01 Figure 5-49. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - Default Speed - Receiver Mode DS2 DS1 DS0 mmc_clk DS3 mmc_cmd DS4 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_02 Figure 5-50. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - Default Speed - Transmiter Mode 5.9.6.15.2 MMC, SD High Speed Figure 5-51, Figure 5-52, Table 5-70, and Table 5-71 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC - SD and SDIO High speed in receiver and transmiter mode. Table 5-70. Timing Requirements for MMC - SD/SDIO High Speed Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX HS3 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_cmd valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge 5.3 ns HS4 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc_cmd valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns HS7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge 5.3 ns HS8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 167 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) i in [i:0] = 3 Table 5-71. Switching Characteristics for MMC - SD/SDIO High Speed Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION HS1 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc_clk MIN MAX UNIT 48 MHz HS2H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc_clk high 0.5*P0.270 ns HS2L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc_clk low 0.5*P0.270 ns HS5 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_cmd transition -7.6 3.6 ns HS6 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_dat[i:0] transition -7.6 3.6 ns (1) P = output mmc_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 HS1 HS2H HS2L mmc_clk HS4 HS3 mmc_cmd HS7 HS8 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_03 Figure 5-51. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - High Speed - Receiver Mode HS1 HS2H HS2L mmc_clk HS5 HS5 mmc_cmd HS6 HS6 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_04 Figure 5-52. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - High Speed - Transmiter Mode 5.9.6.15.3 MMC, SD and SDIO SDR12 Mode Figure 5-53, Figure 5-54, Table 5-72, and Table 5-73 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC - SD and SDIO SDR12 in receiver and transmiter mode. Table 5-72. Timing Requirements for MMC - SDR12 Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR125 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_cmd valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge SDR126 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc_cmd valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge SDR127 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge SDR128 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 168 MIN Specifications MAX UNIT 25.99 ns 1.6 ns 25.99 ns 1.6 ns Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 (1) i in [i:0] = 3 Table 5-73. Switching Characteristics for MMC - SDR12 Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR120 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc_clk MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz SDR121 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc_clk high 0.5*P0.270 ns SDR122 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc_clk low 0.5*P0.270 ns SDR123 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_cmd transition -19.13 16.93 ns SDR124 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_dat[i:0] transition -19.13 16.93 ns (1) P = output mmc_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 SDR122 SDR121 SDR120 mmc_clk SDR126 SDR125 mmc_cmd SDR128 SDR127 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_05 Figure 5-53. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR12 - Receiver Mode SDR122 SDR121 SDR120 mmc_clk SDR123 mmc_cmd SDR124 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_06 Figure 5-54. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR12 - Transmiter Mode 5.9.6.15.4 MMC, SD SDR25 Mode Figure 5-55, Figure 5-56, Table 5-74, and Table 5-75 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC - SD and SDIO SDR25 in receiver and transmiter mode. Table 5-74. Timing Requirements for MMC - SDR25 Mode (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN SDR253 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_cmd valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge 5.3 MAX ns SDR254 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc_cmd valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns SDR257 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid before mmc_clk rising clock edge 5.3 ns SDR258 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc_dat[i:0] valid after mmc_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 169 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (1) i in [i:0] = 3 Table 5-75. Switching Characteristics for MMC - SDR25 Mode (2) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR251 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc_clk MIN MAX UNIT 48 MHz 0.5*P0.270 (1) SDR252 H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc_clk high ns SDR252L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR255 td(clkL-cmdV) SDR256 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_cmd transition -8.8 6.6 ns Delay time, mmc_clk falling clock edge to mmc_dat[i:0] transition -8.8 6.6 ns (1) P = output mmc_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 SDR251 SDR252L SDR252H mmc_clk SDR253 SDR254 mmc_cmd SDR257 SDR258 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_07 Figure 5-55. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR25 - Receiver Mode SDR251 SDR252H SDR252L mmc_clk SDR255 SDR255 mmc_cmd SDR256 SDR256 mmc_dat[3:0] SPRS91v_MMC_08 Figure 5-56. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR25 - Transmiter Mode CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-76. In Table 5-76 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with MMC. Table 5-76. MMC IOSETs SIGNALS 170 IOSET1 IOSET2 IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX mmc_clk C16 5 W16 5 B18 5 mmc_cmd C17 5 V16 5 C18 5 mmc_dat0 E16 5 U15 5 A19 5 mmc_dat1 D16 5 V15 5 B20 5 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 5-76. MMC IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX mmc_dat2 E17 mmc_dat3 F17 IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX 5 Y15 5 C20 5 5 W15 5 A20 5 5.9.6.16 GPIO The general-purpose interface combines four general-purpose input/output (GPIO) banks. Each GPIO module provides up to 32 dedicated general-purpose pins with input and output capabilities; thus, the general-purpose interface supports up to 126 pins. These pins can be configured for the following applications: • Data input (capture)/output (drive) • Keyboard interface with a debounce cell • Interrupt generation in active mode upon the detection of external events. Detected events are processed by two parallel independent interrupt-generation submodules to support biprocessor operations • Wake-up request generation in idle mode upon the detection of external events NOTE For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface chapter of the Device TRM. NOTE The general-purpose input/output i (i = 1 to 4) bank is also referred to as GPIOi. CAUTION The IO timings provided in this section are only valid if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 5-77. In Table 5-77 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with GPIO. Table 5-77. GPIO2/3/4 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL MUX gpio2_11 J17 14 gpio2_12 K22 14 gpio2_13 K21 14 gpio2_14 K18 14 gpio2_20 AB17 14 GPIO2 gpio2_23 AA17 14 AA17 14 gpio2_24 U16 14 U16 14 gpio2_27 U15 14 gpio2_28 V15 14 gpio2_29 Y15 14 gpio2_30 W15 14 gpio2_31 AA15 14 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 171 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-77. GPIO2/3/4 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL MUX GPIO3 gpio3_0 AB15 14 gpio3_9 U9 14 U9 14 gpio3_10 W11 14 W11 14 gpio3_11 V9 14 V9 14 gpio3_12 W9 14 W9 14 gpio3_13 U8 14 U8 14 gpio3_14 W8 14 W8 14 gpio3_15 U7 14 gpio3_16 V7 14 gpio4_4 R5 14 gpio4_6 N4 14 gpio4_7 R7 14 gpio4_8 L2 14 gpio4_9 N5 14 gpio4_10 N6 14 GPIO4 5.9.7 Emulation and Debug Subsystem The device includes the following Test interfaces: • IEEE 1149.1 Standard-Test-Access Port (JTAG) • Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) 5.9.7.1 JTAG Electrical Data/Timing Table 5-78, Table 5-79 and Figure 5-57 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 5-78. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 62.29 ns 1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low(40% of tc) 24.92 ns 3 tsu(TDI-TCK) Input setup time, TDI valid to TCK high 6.23 ns tsu(TMS-TCK) Input setup time, TMS valid to TCK high 6.23 ns th(TCK-TDI) Input hold time, TDI valid from TCK high 31.15 ns th(TCK-TMS) Input hold time, TMS valid from TCK high 31.15 ns 4 Table 5-79. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG NO. 2 172 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION td(TCKL-TDOV) Delay time, TCK low to TDO valid Specifications MIN MAX UNIT 0 30.5 ns Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 1 1a 1b TCK 2 TDO 3 4 TDI/TMS SPRS91v_JTAG_01 Figure 5-57. JTAG Timing Table 5-80, Table 5-81 and Figure 5-58 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 5-80. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG With RTCK NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 62.29 ns 1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low(40% of tc) 24.92 ns 3 tsu(TDI-TCK) Input setup time, TDI valid to TCK high 6.23 ns tsu(TMS-TCK) Input setup time, TMS valid to TCK high 6.23 ns th(TCK-TDI) Input hold time, TDI valid from TCK high 31.15 ns th(TCK-TMS) Input hold time, TMS valid from TCK high 31.15 ns 4 Table 5-81. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG With RTCK NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 5 td(TCK-RTCK) Delay time, TCK to RTCK with no selected subpaths (i.e. ICEPick is the only tap selected - when the ARM is in the scan chain, the delay time is a function of the ARM functional clock). 0 27 ns 6 tc(RTCK) Cycle time, RTCK 62.29 ns 7 tw(RTCKH) Pulse duration, RTCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 8 tw(RTCKL) Pulse duration, RTCK low (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 5 TCK 6 7 8 RTCK SPRS91v_JTAG_02 Figure 5-58. JTAG With RTCK Timing 5.9.7.2 Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) 5.9.7.2.1 TPIU PLL DDR Mode Table 5-82 and Figure 5-59 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 173 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 5-82. Switching Characteristics for TPIU PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN TPIU1 NO. tc(clk) Cycle time, TRACECLK period 5.56 MAX UNIT TPIU4 td(clk-ctlV) Skew time, TRACECLK transition to TRACECTL transition -1.61 1.98 ns TPIU5 td(clk-dataV) Skew time, TRACECLK transition to TRACEDATA[17:0] transition -1.61 1.98 ns ns (1) P = TRACECLK period in ns (2) The listed pulse duration is a typical value TPIU1 TPIU2 TPIU3 TRACECLK TPIU4 TPIU4 TRACECTL TPIU5 TPIU5 TRACEDATA[X:0] SPRS91v_TPIU_01 (1) Figure 5-59. TPIU—PLL DDR Transmit Mode (1) In d[X:0], X is equal to 15 or 17. 174 Specifications Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 6 Detailed Description 6.1 Description The DM505 is a highly optimized device for Vision Analytics and Machine Vision processing in Industrial products such as drones, robots, forklifts, railroad and agriculture equipment. The Processor enables sophisticated embedded vision processing integrating an optimal mix of real time performance, low power, small form factor and camera processing for systems to interact in more intelligent, useful ways with the physical world and the people in it. The DM505 incorporates a heterogeneous, scalable architecture that includes a mix of TI’s fixed and floating-point TMS320C66x digital signal processor (DSP) generation cores, Vision AccelerationPac (EVE), and dual-Cortex-M4 processors. The device allows low power designs to meet demanding embedded system budgets without sacrificing real-time processing performance to enable small form factor designs. The DM505 also integrates a host of peripherals including interfaces for multi-camera input (both parallel and serial), display outputs, audio and serial I/O, CAN and GigB Ethernet AVB. TI provides application specific hardware and software through our Design Network Partners and a complete set of development tools for the ARM, and DSP, including C compilers with TI RTOS to accelerate time to market. 6.2 Functional Block Diagram Figure 6-1 is functional block diagram for the device. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 175 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com IPU with ECC DSP Subsystem x2 Dual Cortex M4 32KB ROM L1P 32KB L2 256KB Cache C66x L1D 32KB EDMA 2TC Display Subsystem Vision Accelerator DVOUT EVE 16MAC SD-DAC EDMA 2TC Video Front End up to 512KB RAM with ECC Video Input Port CAL LVDSRX CSI2 ISP OSD Resizing CSC Interconnect DM505 System Connectivity GMAC Serial Interfaces I2C x2 McASP x3 SPI x4 UART x3 QSPI x1 DCAN with ECC SDIO x1 MCAN(CAN-FD) with ECC EDMA Timer x8 GPIO x4 Mailbox/Spinlock PWMSSx1 10-bit ADC MMUx1 Control Module JTAG PLLs PRCM OSC Memory Controllers GPMC 8b/16b with up to 16b ECC LPDDR2 / DDR2/ DDR3 / DDR3L 32b with 8b ECC SPRS916_Intro_001 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Figure 6-1. DM505 Block Diagram 6.3 DSP Subsystem The device includes two identical instances (DSP1 and DSP2) of a digital signal processor (DSP) subsystem, based on the TI's standard TMS320C66x™ DSP CorePac core. The TMS320C66x DSP core enhances the TMS320C674x™ core, which merges the C674x™ floating point and the C64x+™ fixed-point instruction set architectures. The C66x DSP is object-code compatible with the C64x+/C674x DSPs. For more information on the TMS320C66x core CPU, see the TMS320C66x DSP CPU and Instruction Set Reference Guide, (SPRUGH7). Each of the two DSP subsystems integrated in the device includes the following components: 176 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 A TMS320C66x™ CorePac DSP core that encompasses: – L1 program-dedicated (L1P) cacheable memory – L1 data-dedicated (L1D) cacheable memory – L2 (program and data) cacheable memory – Extended Memory Controller (XMC) – External Memory Controller (EMC) – DSP CorePac located interrupt controller (INTC) – DSP CorePac located power-down controller (PDC) Dedicated enhanced data memory access engine - EDMA, to transfer data from/to memories and peripherals external to the DSP subsystem and to local DSP memory (most commonly L2 SRAM). The external DMA requests are passed through DSP system level (SYS) wakeup logic, and collected from the DSP1/DSP2 dedicated outputs of the device DMA Events Crossbar for each of the two subsystems. A level 2 (L2) interconnect network (DSP NoC) to allow connectivity between different modules of the subsystem or the remainder of the device via the device L3_MAIN interconnect. Two memory management units (on EDMA L2 interconnect and DSP MDMA paths) for accessing the device L3_MAIN interconnect address space. Dedicated system control logic (DSP_SYSTEM) responsible for power management, clock generation, and connection to the device power, reset, and clock management (PRCM) module The TMS320C66x Instruction Set Architecture (ISA) is the latest for the C6000 family. As with its predecessors (C64x, C64x+ and C674x), the C66x is an advanced VLIW architecture with 8 functional units (two multiplier units and six arithmetic logic units) that operate in parallel. The C66x CPU has a total of 64 general-purpose 32-bit registers. Some features of the DSP C6000 family devices are: • Advanced VLIW CPU with eight functional units (two multipliers and six ALUs) which: – Executes up to eight instructions per cycle for up to ten times the performance of typical DSPs – Allows designers to develop highly effective RISC-like code for fast development time • Instruction packing: – Gives code size equivalence for eight instructions executed serially or in parallel – Reduces code size, program fetches, and power consumption • Conditional execution of most instructions: – Reduces costly branching – Increases parallelism for higher sustained performance • Efficient code execution on independent functional units: – Industry's most efficient C compiler on DSP benchmark suite – Industry's first assembly optimizer for fast development and improved parallelization • 8-/16-/32-bit/64-bit data support, providing efficient memory support for a variety of applications. • 40-bit arithmetic options which add extra precision for vocoders and other computationally intensive applications. • Saturation and normalization to provide support for key arithmetic operations. • Field manipulation and instruction extract, set, clear, and bit counting support common operation found in control and data manipulation applications. The C66x CPU has the following additional features: • Each multiplier can perform two 16 × 16-bit or four 8 × 8 bit multiplies every clock cycle. • Quad 8-bit and dual 16-bit instruction set extensions with data flow support. • Support for non-aligned 32-bit (word) and 64-bit (double word) memory accesses. • Special communication-specific instructions have been added to address common operations in errorcorrecting codes. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 177 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • • • • • www.ti.com Bit count and rotate hardware extends support for bit-level algorithms. Compact instructions: Common instructions (AND, ADD, LD, MPY) have 16-bit versions to reduce code size. Protected mode operation: A two-level system of privileged program execution to support highercapability operating systems and system features such as memory protection. Exceptions support for error detection and program redirection to provide robust code execution Hardware support for modulo loop operation to reduce code size and allow interrupts during fullypipelined code Each multiplier can perform 32 × 32 bit multiplies Additional instructions to support complex multiplies allowing up to eight 16-bit multiply/add/subtracts per clock cycle The TMS320C66x has the following key improvements to the ISA: • 4x Multiply Accumulate improvement for both fixed and floating point • Improvement of the floating point arithmetic • Enhancement of the vector processing capability for fixed and floating point • Addition of domain-specific instructions for complex arithmetic and matrix operations On the C66x ISA, the vector processing capability is improved by extending the width of the SIMD instructions. The C674x DSP supports 2-way SIMD operations for 16-bit data and 4-way SIMD operations for 8-bit data. C66x enhances this capabilities with the addition of SIMD instructions for 32-bit data allowing operation on 128-bit vectors. For example the QMPY32 instruction is able to perform the element to element multiplication between two vectors of four 32-bit data each. C66x ISA includes a set of specific instructions to handle complex arithmetic and matrix operations. 178 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 TMS320C66x DSP CorePac memory components: – A 32-KiB L1 program memory (L1P) configurable as cache and/or SRAM: • When configured as a cache, the L1P is a 1-way set-associative cache with a 32-byte cache line • The DSP CorePac L1P memory controller provides bandwidth management, memory protection, and power-down functions • The L1P is capable of cache block and global coherence operations • The L1P controller has an Error Detection (ED) mechanism, including necessary SRAM • The L1P memory can be fully configured as a cache or SRAM • Page size for L1P memory is 2KB – A 32-KiB L1 data memory (L1D) configurable as cache and / or SRAM: • When configured as a cache, the L1D is a 2-way set-associative cache with a 64-byte cache line • The DSP CorePac L1D memory controller provides bandwidth management, memory protection, and power-down functions • The L1D memory can be fully configured as a cache or SRAM • No support for error correction or detection • Page size for L1D memory is 2KB – A 288-KiB (program and data) L2 memory, only part of which is cacheable: • When configured as a cache, the L2 memory is a 4-way set associative cache with a 128-byte cache line • Only 256 KiB of L2 memory can be configured as cache or SRAM • 32 KiB of the L2 memory is always mapped as SRAM • The L2 memory controller has an Error Correction Code (ECC) and ED mechanism, including necessary SRAM • The L2 memory controller supports hardware prefetching and also provides bandwidth management, memory protection, and power-down functions. • Page size for L2 memory is 16KB The External Memory Controller (EMC) is a bridge from the C66x CorePac to the rest of the DSP subsystem and device. It has : – a 32-bit configuration port (CFG) providing access to local subsystem resources (like DSP_EDMA, DSP_SYSTEM, and so forth) or to L3_MAIN resources accessible via the CFG address range. – a 128-bit slave-DMA port (SDMA) which provides accesses of system masters outside the DSP subsystem to resources inside the DSP subsystem or C66x DSP CorePac memories, i.e. when the DSP subsystem is the slave in a transaction. The Extended Memory Controller (XMC) processes requests from the L2 Cache Controller (which are a result of CPU instruction fetches, load/store commands, cache operations) to device resources via the C66x DSP CorePac 128-bit master DMA (MDMA) port: – Memory protection for addresses outside C66x DSP CorePac generated over device L3_MAIN on the MDMA port – Prefetch, multi-in-flight requests A DSP local Interrupt Controller (INTC) in the DSP C66x CorePac, interfaces the system events to the DSP C66x core CPU interrupt and exceptions inputs. The DSP subsystem C66x CorePac interrupt controller supports up to 128 system events of which 64 interrupts are external to DSP subsystems, collected from the DSP1/DSP2 dedicated outputs of the device Interrupt Crossbar. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 179 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • • • • • www.ti.com Local Enhanced Direct Memory Access (EDMA) controller features: – Channel controller (CC) : 64-channel, 128 PaRAM, 2 Queues – 2 x Third-party Transfer Controllers (TPTC0 and TPTC1): • Each TC has a 128-bit read port and a 128-bit write port • 2KiB FIFOs on each TPTC – 1-dimensional/2-dimensional (1D/2D) addressing – Chaining capability DSP subsystem integrated MMUs: – Two MMUs are integrated: • The MMU0 is located between DSP MDMA master port and the device L3_MAIN interconnect and can be optionally bypassed • The MMU1 is located between the EDMA master port and the device L3_MAIN interconnect A DSP local Power-Down Controller (PDC) is responsible to power-down various parts of the DSP C66x CorePac, or the entire DSP C66x CorePac. The DSP subsystem System Control logic provides: – Slave idle and master standby protocols with device PRCM for powerdown – OCP Disconnect handshake for init and target busses – Asynchronous reset – Power-down modes: • "Clockstop" mode featuring wake-up on interrupt event. The DMA event wake-up is managed in software. The device DSP subsystem is supplied by a PRCM DPLL, but each DSP1/2 has integrated its own PLL module outside the C66x CorePac for clock gating and division. Each of the two device DSP subsystem has following port instances to connect to remaining part of the device. See also : – A 128-bit initiator (DSP MDMA master) port for MDMA/Cache requests – A 128-bit initiator (DSP EDMA master) port for EDMA requests – A 32-bit initiator (DSP CFG master) port for configuration requests – A 128-bit target (DSP slave) port for requests to DSP memories and various peripherals C66x DSP subsystems (DSPSS) safety aspects: – Above mentioned memory ECC/ED mechanisms – MMUs enable mapping of only the necessary application space to the processor – Memory Protection Units internal to the DSPSS (in L1P, L1D and L2 memory controllers) and external to DSPSS (firewalls) to help define legal accesses and raise exceptions on illegal accesses – Exceptions: Memory errors, various DSP errors, MMU errors and some system errors are detected and cause exceptions. The exceptions could be handled by the DSP or by a designated safety processor at the chip level. Note that it may not be possible for the safety processor to completely handle some exceptions Unsupported features on the C66x DSP core for the device are: • The Extended Memory Controller MPAX (memory protection and address extension) 36-bit addressing is NOT supported Known DSP subsystem power mode restrictions for the device are: • "Full logic / RAM retention" mode featuring wake-up on both interrupt or DMA event (logic in “always on” domain). Only OFF mode is supported by DSP subsystem, requiring full boot. 180 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 For more information about C66x debug/trace support, see chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the device TRM. 6.4 IPU The Imaging Processor Unit (IPU) subsystem contains two ARM® Cortex-M4 cores (IPU_C0 and IPU_C1) that share a common level 1 (L1) cache (called unicache). The two Cortex-M4 cores are completely homogeneous to one another. Any task possible using one Cortex-M4 core is also possible using the other Cortex-M4 core. Both Cortex-M4 cores could be used for tasks such as running RTOS, controlling ISP, SIMCOP, DSS, and other functions. It is software responsibility to distribute the various tasks between the Cortex-M4 cores for optimal performance. The integrated interrupt handling of the IPU subsystem allows it to function as an efficient control unit. IPU is the boot master of this device with its own boot ROM. The key features of the IPU subsystem are: • Two ARM Cortex-M4 microprocessors (IPU_C0 and IPU_C1): – ARMv7-M and Thumb®-2 instruction set architecture (ISA) – ARMv6 SIMD and digital signal processor (DSP) extensions – Single-cycle MAC – Integrated nested vector interrupt controller (NVIC) (also called IPU_Cx_INTC, where x = 0, 1) – Integrated bus matrix: • Bus arbiter • Bit-banding – atomic bit manipulation • Write buffer • Memory interface (I and D) plus system interface (S) and private peripheral bus (PPB) – Registers: • Thirteen general-purpose 32-bit registers • Link register (LR) • Program counter (PC) • Program status register, xPSR • Two banked SP registers – Integrated power management – Extensive debug capabilities • Unicache interface: – AHBLite to unicache interface – Instruction and data interface – Supports interleaved Cortex-M4 requests • L1 cache (IPU_UNICACHE): – 32KiB divided into 16 banks – 4-way – Runs at twice the Cortex-M4 CPU frequency – Cache configuration lock/freeze/preload – Internal MMU: • 16-entry region-based address translation • Read/write control and access type control • Runs at twice the Cortex-M4 CPU frequency • Execute Never (XN) MMU protection policy • Little-endian format – OCP port for configuration and cache maintenance • Subsystem counter timer module (SCTM) connected to unicache Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 181 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • • • • • • www.ti.com L2 master interface (MIF): – Splitter for access to memory or OCP ports – Interleaved bank request for fast memory access L2 internal memories: – 16KiB ROM – IPU_ROM; used for device boot/initialization – 64KiB banked RAM – IPU_RAM L2 MMU (IPU_MMU): 32 entries with Table Walking Logic (TWL) Wake-up generator (IPU_WUGEN): Generates wake-up request from external interrupts Two OCP ports at IPU boundary (connected to the L3_MAIN interconnect): – Master port – allows the IPU to access system resources (memories and peripherals) – Slave port – allows other requestors to access a part of the IPU internal memory space Power management: – Local power-management control: Configurable through the IPU_WUGEN registers. – Two sleep modes supported by Cortex-M4, controlled by its integrated interrupt controller (NVIC). – Cortex-M4 system is clock-gated in both sleep modes. – NVIC interrupt interface stays awake. – Supports L1 cache and L2 memories retention. Error-Correcting Code (ECC) supported for both L1 unicache and L2 RAM Debug/emulation features supported For more information, see chapter Dual Cortex-M4 IPU Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.5 EVE The embedded vision engine (EVE) module is a programmable imaging and vision processing engine, intended for use in devices that serve customer electronics imaging and vision applications. Its programmability meets late-in-development or post-silicon processing requirements, and lets third parties or customers add differentiating features in imaging and vision products. The device includes one instantiation of the EVE engine. A single EVE module consists of an ARP32 scalar core, a vector coprocessor (VCOP) vector core, and an Enhanced DMA (EDMA3) controller. The EVE engine includes the following main features: • Two 128-bit interconnect initiator ports used for: – Paging between system-level memory (L3 SRAM/DDR) and EVE memory (primarily IBUF, WBUF) – ARP32 program fetches to system memory (through program cache) – ARP32 load or store requests to system memory – ARP32 program cache-related read requests, including prefetch/preload requests • 128-bit interconnect target port used for system-level host or DMA access to EVE memory or MMR space • Scalar core (ARP32) with the following features: – 32KB program cache (direct mapped and prefetch) – 32KB data memory (DMEM) • Vector core (VCOP): – 32KB working buffer (WBUF) – 16KB image buffer low copy A (IBUFLA) – 16KB image buffer low copy B (IBUFLB) – 16KB image buffer high copy A (IBUFHA) – 16KB image buffer high copy B (IBUFHB) • EDMA channel controller (EDMACC): 128 PaRAM entries, 2 Queues • EDMA transfer controllers: two instances, 2k FIFO each 182 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Memory Management Units (MMUs): – 32-entry TLB per MMU – Page walking with hardware – EDMA accesses and ARP32 program or data accesses to system memory space – Can limit EVE accesses to desired subset of system addresses Configuration interconnect for MMR and debug accesses High-performance interconnect for high throughput and high concurrency data transfers between connected endpoints Multiple interrupts for interrupt mapping, DMA event mapping, and interprocessor handshaking Support for slave idle and master standby protocols for clock gating No support for retention and memory array off modes Error detection on all memories: – Single bit error detect on DMEM, WBUF, IBUFLA, IBUFLB, IBUFHA, and IBUFHB – Double bit error detect on program cache Invalid instruction detection in the two processor units (ARP32 and VCOP) Debug support: – Subsystem Counter Timer Module (SCTM) for counting and measuring of VCOP, EVE program cache, and EDMA performance-related state – Software Messaging System Event Trace (SMSET) for trace of software messages and hardware events – ARP32 debug support: State visibility, breakpoint, run control, cross-triggering – VCOP debug support: State visibility and run control Interprocessor communication: Internal Mailbox for DSP/EVE communication For more information, see chapter Embedded Vision Engine of the device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 183 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 6.6 6.6.1 www.ti.com Memory Subsystem EMIF The EMIF module provides connectivity between DDR memory types and manages data bus read/write accesses between external memory and device subsystems which have master access to the L3_MAIN interconnect and DMA capability. The EMIF module has the following capabilities: • Supports JEDEC standard-compliant LPDDR2/DDR2-SDRAM and DDR3/DDR3L-SDRAM memory types • 2-GiB SDRAM address range over one chip-select • Supports SDRAM devices with one, two, four or eight internal banks • Supports SDRAM devices with single die (one chip select supported) • Supports SDRAM devices with single or dual die packages • Data bus widths: – 128-bit L3_MAIN (system) interconnect data bus width – 32-bit SDRAM data bus width – 16-bit SDRAM data bus width used in narrow mode • Supported CAS latencies: – DDR3: 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 – DDR2: 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 and 7 – LPDDR2: 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and 8 • Supports 256-, 512-, 1024-, and 2048-word page sizes • Supported burst length: 8 • Supports sequential burst type • SDRAM auto initialization from reset or configuration change • Supports self refresh and power-down modes for low power • Partial array self-refresh mode for low power when DDR3 is used • Output impedance (ZQ) calibration for DDR3 • Supports on-die termination (ODT) for DDR2 and DDR3 • Supports prioritized refresh • Programmable SDRAM refresh rate and backlog counter • Programmable SDRAM timing parameters • Write and read leveling/calibration and data eye training for DDR3 • ECC on the SDRAM data bus: – 7-bit ECC over 32-bit data – 6-bit ECC over 16-bit data when narrow mode is used – 1-bit error correction and 2-bit error detection – Programmable address ranges to define ECC protected region – ECC calculated and stored on all writes to ECC protected address region – ECC verified on all reads from ECC protected address region – Statistics for 1-bit ECC and 2-bit ECC errors – The total width of the ECC DDR data bus is 8 bits The EMIF module does not support: • Burst chop for DDR3 • Interleave burst type • Auto precharge because of better Bank Interleaving performance 184 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 OCD calibration for DDR2 CAS Read Latency of 2 and CAS Write Latency of 1 for DDR2 DLL disabling from EMIF side For more information, see section DDR External Memory Interface (EMIF) in chapter Memory Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.6.2 GPMC The General Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) is an external memory controller of the device. Its data access engine provides a flexible programming model for communication with all standard memories. The GPMC supports the following various access types: • Asynchronous read/write access • Asynchronous read page access (4, 8, and 16 Word16) • Synchronous read/write access • Synchronous read/write burst access without wrap capability (4, 8 and 16 Word16) • Synchronous read/write burst access with wrap capability (4, 8 and 16 Word16) • Address-data-multiplexed (AD) access • Address-address-data (AAD) multiplexed access • Little- and big-endian access The GPMC can communicate with a wide range of external devices: • External asynchronous or synchronous 8-bit wide memory or device (non burst device) • External asynchronous or synchronous 16-bit wide memory or device • External 16-bit non-multiplexed NOR flash device • External 16-bit address and data multiplexed NOR Flash device • External 8-bit and 16-bit NAND flash device • External 16-bit pseudo-SRAM (pSRAM) device The main features of the GPMC are: • 8- or 16-bit-wide data path to external memory device • Supports up to eight CS regions of programmable size and programmable base addresses in a total address space of 1 GiB • Supports transactions controlled by a firewall • On-the-fly error code detection using the Bose-ChaudhurI-Hocquenghem (BCH) (t = 4, 8, or 16) or Hamming code to improve the reliability of NAND with a minimum effect on software (NAND flash with 512-byte page size or greater) • Fully pipelined operation for optimal memory bandwidth use • The clock to the external memory is provided from GPMC functional clock divided by 1, 2, 3, or 4 • Supports programmable autoclock gating when no access is detected • Independent and programmable control signal timing parameters for setup and hold time on a per-chip basis. Parameters are set according to the memory device timing parameters, with a timing granularity of one GPMC functional clock cycle. • Flexible internal access time control (WAIT state) and flexible handshake mode using external WAIT pin monitoring • Support bus keeping • Support bus turnaround • Prefetch and write posting engine associated with a device DMA to achieve full performance from the NAND device with minimum effect on NOR/SRAM concurrent access Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 185 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com For more information, see section General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) in chapter Memory Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.6.3 ELM When reading from NAND flash memories, some level of error-correction is required. In the case of NAND modules with no internal correction capability, sometimes referred to as bare NANDs, the correction process is delegated to the memory controller. The ELM supports the following features: • 4, 8, and 16 bits per 512-byte block error location based on BCH algorithm • Eight simultaneous processing contexts • Page-based and continuous modes • Interrupt generation when error location process completes: – When the full page has been processed in page mode – For each syndrome polynomial (checksum-like information) in continuous mode For more information, see section Error Location Module in chapter Memory Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.6.4 OCMC There is one on-chip memory controller (OCMC) in the device. The OCM Controller supports the following features: • L3_MAIN data interface: – Used for maximum throughput performance – 128-bit data bus width – Burst supported • L4 interface: – Used for access to configuration registers – 32-bit data bus width – Only single accesses supported – The L4 associated OCMC clock is two times lower than the L3 associated OCMC clock • Error correction and detection: – Single error correction and dual error detection – 9-bit Hamming error correction code (ECC) calculated on 128-bit data word which is concatenated with memory address bits – Hamming distance of 4 – Enable/Disable mode control through a dedicated register – Single bit error correction on a read transaction – Exclusion of repeated addresses from correctable error address trace history – ECC valid for all write transactions to an enabled region – Sub-128-bit writes supported via read modify write • ECC Error Status Reporting: – Trace history buffer (FIFO) with depth of 4 for corrected error address – Trace history buffer with depth of 4 for non correctable error address and also including double error detection – Interrupt generation for correctable and uncorrectable detected errors 186 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 ECC Diagnostics Configuration: – Counters for single error correction (SEC), double error detection (DED) and address error events (AEE) – Programmable threshold registers for exeptions associated with SEC, DED and AEE counters – Register control for enabling and disabling of diagnostics – Configuration registers and ECC status accessible through L4 interconnect Circular buffer for sliced based VIP frame transfers: – Up to 12 programmable circular buffers mapped with unique virtual frame addresses – On the fly (with no additional latency) address translation from virtual to OCMC circular buffer memory space – Virtual frame size up to 8 MiB and circular buffer size up to 1 MiB – Error handling and reporting of illegal CBUF addressing – Underflow and Overflow status reporting and error handling – Last access read/write address history Two Interrupt outputs configured independently to service either ECC or CBUF interrupt events The OCM controller does not have a memory protection logic and does not support endianism conversion. For more information, see section On-Chip Memory (OCM) Subsystem in chapter Memory Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.7 6.7.1 Interprocessor Communication Mailbox Communication between the on-chip processors of the device uses a queued mailbox-interrupt mechanism. The queued mailbox-interrupt mechanism allows the software to establish a communication channel between two processors through a set of registers and associated interrupt signals by sending and receiving messages (mailboxes). The device implements the following mailbox types: • System mailbox: – Number of instances: 2 – Used for communication between: DSP1, DSP2, IPU subsystems – Reference name: MAILBOX1, MAILBOX2 Each mailbox module supports the following features: • Parameters configurable at design time – Number of users – Number of mailbox message queues – Number of messages (FIFO depth) for each message queue • 32-bit message width • Message reception and queue-not-full notification using interrupts • Support of 16-/32-bit addressing scheme • Power management support For more information, see chapter Mailbox of the device TRM. 6.7.2 Spinlock The Spinlock module provides hardware assistance for synchronizing the processes running on multiple processors in the device: • Digital signal processor (DSP) subsystems – DSP1 and DSP2 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 187 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • www.ti.com Dual Cortex-M4 image processing unit (IPU) subsystems – IPU1 and IPU2 The Spinlock module implements 256 spinlocks (or hardware semaphores), which provide an efficient way to perform a lock operation of a device resource using a single read-access, avoiding the need of a readmodify- write bus transfer that the programmable cores are not capable of. For more information, see chapter Spinlock of the device TRM. 6.8 Interrupt Controller The device has a large number of interrupts to service the needs of its many peripherals and subsystems. The DSP (x2), and IPU, and EVE subsystems are capable of servicing these interrupts via their integrated interrupt controllers. In addition, each processor's interrupt controller is preceded by an Interrupt Controller Crossbar (IRQ_CROSSBAR) that provides flexibility in mapping the device interrupts to processor interrupt inputs. For more information about IRQ crossbar, see chapter Control Module of the Device TRM. C66x DSP Subsystem Interrupt Controller (DSPx_INTC, where x = 1, 2) There are two Digital Signal Processing (DSP) subsystems in the device - DSP1, and DSP2. Each DSP subsystem integrates an interrupt controller - DSPx_INTC, which interfaces the system events to the C66x core interrupt and exceptions inputs. It combines up to 128 interrupts into 12 prioritized interrupts presented to the C66x CPU. For detailed information about this module, see chapter DSP Subsystems of the Device TRM. Dual Cortex-M4 IPU Subsystem Interrupt Controller (IPU_Cx_INTC, where x = 1, 2) There is one Image Processing Unit (IPU) subsystem in the device. The IPU subsystem integrates two ARM® Cortex-M4 cores. A Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) is integrated within each Cortex-M4. The interrupt mapping is the same for the two cores to facilitate parallel processing. The NVIC supports: • 96 external interrupts (in addition to 16 Cortex-M4 internal interrupts), which are dynamically prioritized with 16 levels of priority defined for each core • Low-latency exception and interrupt handling • Prioritization and handling of exceptions • Control of the local power management • Debug accesses to the processor core For detailed information about this module, refer to ARM Cortex-M4 Technical Reference Manual (available at infocenter.arm.com/help/index.jsp). EVE Subsystem Interrupt Controller (EVE_INTC) There is one Embedded Video Engine (EVE) subsystems in the device. The EVE subsystem integrates an interrupt controller - EVE_INTC, which handles incoming interrupts, merging them with internal interrupt sources to drive ARP32's interrupt inputs. It also allows ARP32 to generate outgoing interrupts or events to synchronize with other system processors and EDMA. The EVE_INTC supports up to 32 active-high level interrupt inputs. Its architecture allows both hardware and software prioritization. For detailed information about this module, see chapter Embedded Vision Engine of the Device TRM. 6.9 EDMA The enhanced direct memory access module, also called EDMA, performs high-performance data transfers between two slave points, memories and peripheral devices without microprocessor unit (MPU) or digital signal processor (DSP) support during transfer. EDMA transfer is programmed through a logical EDMA channel, which allows the transfer to be optimally tailored to the requirements of the application. 188 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 The EDMA can also perform transfers between external memories and between device subsystems internal memories, with some performance loss caused by resource sharing between the read and write ports. EDMA controller is based on two major principal blocks: • EDMA third-party channel controller (EDMA_TPCC) • EDMA third-party transfer controller (EDMA_TPTC) The EDMA_TPCC channel controller has following features: • Fully orthogonal transfer description: – Three transfer dimensions. – A-synchronized transfers: one-dimension serviced per event. – AB-synchronized transfers: two-dimensions serviced per event. – Independent indexes on source and destination. – Chaining feature allows a 3-D transfer based on a single event. • Flexible transfer definition: – Increment or FIFO transfer addressing modes. – Linking mechanism allows automatic PaRAM set update. – Chaining allows multiple transfers to execute with one event. • Interrupt generation for the following: – Transfer completion. – Error conditions. • Debug visibility: – Queue water marking/threshold. – Error and status recording to facilitate debug. • 64 DMA request channels: – Event synchronization. – Chain synchronization (completion of one transfer triggers another transfer). • Eight QDMA channels: – QDMA channels trigger automatically upon writing to a parameter RAM (PaRAM) set entry. – Support for programmable QDMA channel to PaRAM mapping. • 512 PaRAM sets: – Each PaRAM set can be used for a DMA channel, QDMA channel, or link set. • Two transfer controllers/event queues. • 16 event entries per event queue. • Memory protection support: – Proxy memory protection for TR submission. – Active memory protection for accesses to PaRAM and registers. The EDMA_TPTC transfer controller has the following features: • Two transfer controllers (TC). • 128-bit wide read and write ports per TC. • Up to four in-flight transfer requests (TRs). • Programmable priority level. • Supports two-dimensional transfers with independent indexes on source and destination (EDMA_TPCC manages the 3rd dimension). • Support for increment or constant addressing mode transfers. • Interrupt and error support. • Memory-Mapped Register (MMR) bit fields are fixed position in 32-bit MMR regardless of endianness. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 189 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com EDMA controller uses the shared MMU1 module for transfering to and from DSP module. This provides several benefits including: • Protection of Host CPU memory regions from accidental corruption by EDMA TPTCs. • Direct allocation of buffers in user space without the need for translation between CPU and DSP applications using EDMA TPTCs. Accesses by the EDMA TPTCs (both TPTC0 and TPTC1) may optionally be routed through the MMU1. The TPTC0 and TPTC1 routing allows EDMA transfer controller to be used to perform transfers using only the virtual addresses of the associated buffers. For more information chapter Enhanced DMA of the device TRM. 6.10 Peripherals 6.10.1 VIP The VIP module provides video capture functions for the device. VIP incorporates a multichannel raw video parser, various video processing blocks, and a flexible Video Port Direct Memory Access (VPDMA) engine to store incoming video in various formats. The device uses a single instantiation of the VIP module giving the ability of capturing up to two video streams. A VIP module includes the following main features: • Two independently configurable external video input capture slices (Slice 0 and Slice 1) each of which has two video input ports, Port A and Port B, where Port A can be configured as a 16/8-bit port, and Port B is a fixed 8-bit port. • Each video Port A can be operated as a port with clock independent input channels (with interleaved or separated Y/C data input). Embedded sync and external sync modes are supported for all input configurations. • Support for a single external asynchronous pixel clock, up to 165MHz per port. • Pixel Clock Input Domain Port A supports up to one 16-bit input data bus, including BT.1120 style embedded sync for 16-bit data. • Embedded Sync data interface mode supports single or multiplexed sources • Discrete Sync data interface mode supports only single source input • 16-bit data input plus discrete syncs can be configured to include: – 8-bit YUV422 (Y and U/V time interleaved) – 16-bit YUV422 (CbY and CrY time interleaved) – 16-bit RGB565 – 16-bit RAW Capture • Discrete sync modes include: – VSYNC + HSYNC (FID determined by FID signal pin or HSYNC/VSYNC skew) – VSYNC + ACTVID + FID – VBLANK + ACTVID (ACTVID toggles in VBLANK) + FID – VBLANK + ACTVID (no ACTVID toggles in VBLANK) + FID • Multichannel parser (embedded syncs only) – Embedded syncs only – Pixel (2x or 4x) or Line multiplexed modes supported – Performs demultiplexing and basic error checking – Supports maximum of 9 channels in Line Mux (8 normal + 1 split line) 190 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Ancillary data capture support – For 16-bit input, ancillary data may be extracted from any single channel – For 8-bit time interleaved input, ancillary data can be chosen from the Luma channel, the Chroma channel, or both channels – Horizontal blanking interval data capture only supported when using discrete syncs (VSYNC + HSYNC or VSYNC + HBLANK) – Ancillary data extraction supported on multichannel capture as well as single source streams Format conversion and scaling – Programmable color space conversion – YUV422 to YUV444 conversion – YUV444 to YUV422 conversion – YUV422 to YUV420 conversion – YUV422 Source: YUV422 to YUV422, YUV422 to YUV420, YUV422 to YUV444, YUV422 to RGB888 – Supports RAW to RAW (no processing) – Scaling and format conversions do not work for multiplexed input Supports up to 2047 pixels wide input - when scaling is engaged Supports up to 3840 pixels wide input - when only chroma up/down sampling is engaged, without scaling Supports up to 4095 pixels wide input - without scaling and chroma up/down sampling The maximum supported input resolution is further limited by pixel clock and feature-dependent constraints For more information, see chapter Video Input Port of the device TRM. 6.10.2 DSS The Display Subsystem (DSS) provides the logic to interface display peripherals. DSS integrates a DMA engine as part of DISPC module, which allows direct access to the memory frame buffer. Various pixel processing capabilities are supported, such as: color space conversion, filtering, scaling, blending, color keying, etc. The supported display interfaces are: • One parallel CMOS output, which can be used for MIPI® DPI 2.0, or BT-656 or BT-1120. • One TV output, which is connected to the internal Video Encoder module (VENC). The VENC drives a single video digital-to-analog converter (SD_DAC) supporting composite video mode. The modules integrated in the display subsystem are: • Display controller (DISPC), with the following main features – One direct memory access (DMA) engine – One graphics pipeline (GFX), two video pipelines (VID1 and VID2), and one write-back pipeline (WB) – Two overlay managers – Active Matrix color support for 12/16/18/24-bit (truncated or dithered encoded pixel values) – One Video Port (VP) with programmable timing generator to support: • DPI: up to 165 MHz pixel clock video formats defined in CEA-861-E and VESA DMT standards • VENC: NTSC/PAL standards with 60Hz/50Hz refresh rates – Supported maximum FrameBuffer width of 4096 for all pixel formats – Configurable output mode: progressive or interlaced – Selection between RGB and YUV422 output pixel formats (YUV4:2:2 only available when BT-656 or BT-1120 output mode is enabled) For more information, see section Display Controller in chapter Display Subsystem of the device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 191 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • www.ti.com Video Encoder (VENC) with 10-bit standard definition video DAC (SD_DAC). For more information, see section Video Encoder in chapter Display Subsystem of the device TRM. DSS provides two interfaces to L3_MAIN interconnect • One 128-bit master port (with MFLAG support). The DMA engine in DISPC uses this single master to read/write data from/to device system memory. • One 32-bit slave port. Used for registers configuration. It is further connected internally to DISPC and VENC modules. For more information, see chapter Display Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.10.3 ADC The analog-to-digital converter (ADC) module is a successive-approximation-register (SAR) generalpurpose analog-to-digital converter. The main features of the ADC include: • 10-bit data. • 8 general-purpose ADC channels. • 750 KSPS at 13.5-MHz ADC_CLK. • Programmable FSM sequencer. • Support interrupts and status, with masking. For more information, see chapter ADC of the device TRM. 6.10.4 ISS The imaging subsystem (ISS) deals with the processing of the pixel data coming from an external image sensor or data from memory (image format encoding and decoding can be done to and from memory). With its subparts, such as interfaces and interconnects, image signal processor (ISP), and still image coprocessor (SIMCOP), the ISS is a key component for the following applications: • Rear View Camera • Front View Stereo Camera • Surround View Camera The ISS offers the following features: • ISS interfaces: – Camera Adapter Layer (CAL_A) module, which serves as sensor capture interface supporting MIPI® CSI-2 protocol via external MIPI D-PHY module (CSI2_PHY1), and in addition provides write DMA capability – CAL_B module, serving as internal read DMA engine, without direct sensor capture interface capability – Parallel interface (CPI) (16 bits wide, with up to 212.8 MPix/s throughput, and supporting BT656, SYNC modes) – LVDS receiver – 128-bit-wide data interface to L3_MAIN interconnect For more information, see chapter Imaging Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.10.5 Timers The device includes several types of timers used by the system software, including eight general-purpose (GP) timers, and a 32-kHz synchronized timer (COUNTER_32K). 6.10.5.1 General-Purpose Timers The device has eight GP timers: TIMER1 through TIMER8. 192 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 TIMER1 (1-ms tick) includes a specific function to generate accurate tick interrupts to the operating system and it belongs to the PD_WKUPAON domain. TIMER2 through TIMER8 belong to the PD_COREAON module. Each timer can be clocked from the system clock (19.2, 20, or 27 MHz) or the 32-kHz clock. Select the clock source at the power, reset, and clock management (PRCM) module level. Each timer provides an interrupt through the device IRQ_CROSSBAR. The following are the main features of the GP timer controllers: • Level 4 (L4) slave interface support: – 32-bit data bus width – 32-/16-bit access supported – 8-bit access not supported – 10-bit address bus width – Burst mode not supported – Write nonposted transaction mode supported • Interrupts generated on overflow, compare, and capture • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • Compare and capture modes • Autoreload mode • Start and stop mode • Programmable divider clock source (2n, where n = [0:8]) • Dedicated input trigger for capture mode and dedicated output trigger/PWM signal • Dedicated GP output signal for using the TIMERi_GPO_CFG signal • On-the-fly read/write register (while counting) • 1-ms tick with 32.768-Hz functional clock generated (only TIMER1) For more information, see section General-Purpose Timers in chapter Timers of the device TRM. 6.10.5.2 32-kHz Synchronized Timer (COUNTER_32K) The 32-kHz synchronized timer (COUNTER_32K) is a 32-bit counter clocked by the falling edge of the 32kHz system clock. The main features of the 32-kHz synchronized timer controller are: • L4 slave interface (OCP) support: – 32-bit data bus width – 32-/16-bit access supported – 8-bit access not supported – 16-bit address bus width – Burst mode not supported – Write nonposted transaction mode not supported • Only read operations are supported on the module registers; no write operation is supported (no error/no action on write). • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • Start and keep counting after power-on reset • Automatic roll over to 0; highest value reached: 0xFFFF FFFF • On-the-fly read (while counting) For more information, see section 32-kHz Synchronized Timer (COUNTER_32K) in chapter Timers of the device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 193 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 6.10.6 I2C The device contains five multimaster inter-integrated circuit (I2C) controllers (I2Ci modules, where i = 1, 2) each of which provides an interface between a local host (LH), such as a digital signal processor (DSP), and any I2C-bus-compatible device that connects through the I2C serial bus. External components attached to the I2C bus can serially transmit and receive up to 8 bits of data to and from the LH device through the 2-wire I2C interface. Each multimaster I2C controller can be configured to act like a slave or master I2C-compatible device. For more information, see section Multimaster I2C Controller in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.7 UART The UART is a simple L4 slave peripheral that use the EDMA for data transfer or IRQ polling via CPU. There are 3 UART modules in the device. Each UART can be used for configuration and data exchange with a number of external peripheral devices or interprocessor communication between devices. 6.10.7.1 UART Features The UARTi (where i = 1 to 3) include the following features: • 16C750 compatibility • 64-byte FIFO buffer for receiver and 64-byte FIFO for transmitter • Programmable interrupt trigger levels for FIFOs • Baud generation based on programmable divisors N (where N = 1…16,384) operating from a fixed functional clock of 48 MHz or 192 MHz Oversampling is programmed by software as 16 or 13. Thus, the baud rate computation is one of two options: • Baud rate = (functional clock / 16) / N • Baud rate = (functional clock / 13) / N • This software programming mode enables higher baud rates with the same error amount without changing the clock source • Break character detection and generation • Configurable data format: – Data bit: 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits – Parity bit: Even, odd, none – Stop-bit: 1, 1.5, 2 bit(s) • Flow control: Hardware (RTS/CTS) or software (XON/XOFF) • The 48 MHz functional clock option allows baud rates up to 3.6Mbps • The 192 MHz functional clock option allows baud rates up to 12Mbps For more information, see section UART in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.8 McSPI The McSPI is a master/slave synchronous serial bus. There are four separate McSPI modules (SPI1, SPI2, SPI3, and SPI4) in the device. All these four modules are able to work as both master and slave and support the following chip selects: • McSPI1: spi1_cs[0], spi1_cs[1], spi1_cs[2], spi1_cs[3] • McSPI2: spi2_cs[0], spi2_cs[1] • McSPI3: spi3_cs[0], spi3_cs[1] • McSPI4: spi4_cs[0] The McSPI modules include the following main features: 194 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • • • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Serial clock with programmable frequency, polarity, and phase for each channel Wide selection of SPI word lengths, ranging from 4 to 32 bits Up to four master channels, or single channel in slave mode Master multichannel mode: – Full duplex/half duplex – Transmit-only/receive-only/transmit-and-receive modes – Flexible input/output (I/O) port controls per channel – Programmable clock granularity – SPI configuration per channel. This means, clock definition, polarity enabling and word width Single interrupt line for multiple interrupt source events Power management through wake-up capabilities Enable the addition of a programmable start-bit for SPI transfer per channel (start-bit mode) Supports start-bit write command Supports start-bit pause and break sequence Programmable timing control between chip select and external clock generation Built-in FIFO available for a single channel For more information, see section Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 195 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 6.10.9 QSPI The quad serial peripheral interface (QSPI™) module is a kind of SPI module that allows single, dual, or quad read access to external SPI devices. This module has a memory mapped register interface, which provides a direct interface for accessing data from external SPI devices and thus simplifying software requirements. The QSPI works as a master only. The QSPI supports the following features: • General SPI features: – Programmable clock divider – Six pin interface – Programmable length (from 1 to 128 bits) of the words transferred – Programmable number (from 1 to 4096) of the words transferred – 4 external chip-select signals – Support for 3-, 4-, or 6-pin SPI interface – Optional interrupt generation on word or frame (number of words) completion – Programmable delay between chip select activation and output data from 0 to 3 QSPI clock cycles – Programmable signal polarities – Programmable active clock edge – Software-controllable interface allowing for any type of SPI transfer – Control through L3_MAIN configuration port • Serial flash interface (SFI) features: – Serial flash read/write interface – Additional registers for defining read and write commands to the external serial flash device – 1 to 4 address bytes – Fast read support, where fast read requires dummy bytes after address bytes; 0 to 3 dummy bytes can be configured. – Dual read support – Quad read support – Little-endian support only – Linear increment addressing mode only The QSPI supports only dual and quad reads. Dual or quad writes are not supported. In addition, there is no "pass through" mode supported where the data present on the QSPI input is sent to its output. For more information, see section Quad Serial Peripheral Interface in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.10 McASP The McASP functions as a general-purpose audio serial port optimized to the requirements of various audio applications. The McASP module can operate in both transmit and receive modes. The McASP is useful for time-division multiplexed (TDM) stream, Inter-IC Sound (I2S) protocols reception and transmission as well as for an intercomponent digital audio interface transmission (DIT). The McASP has the flexibility to gluelessly connect to a Sony/Philips digital interface (S/PDIF) transmit physical layer component. Although intercomponent digital audio interface reception (DIR) mode (i.e. S/PDIF stream receiving) is not natively supported by the McASP module, a specific TDM mode implementation for the McASP receivers allows an easy connection to external DIR components (for example, S/PDIF to I2S format converters). The device has integrated 3 McASP modules with: • McASP1 supports 16 channels with independent TX/RX clock/sync domain • McASP2 and McASP3 support 6 channels with independent TX/RX clock/sync domain 196 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 For more information, see section Multichannel Audio Serial Port in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.11 DCAN The Controller Area Network (CAN) is a serial communications protocol which efficiently supports distributed real-time applications. CAN has high immunity to electrical interference and the ability to selfdiagnose and repair data errors. In a CAN network, many short messages are broadcast to the entire network, which provides for data consistency in every node of the system. The device supports: • One DCAN module, referred to as DCAN1 The DCAN interface implements the following features: • Supports CAN protocol version 2.0 part A, B • Bit rates up to 1 MBit/s • 64 message objects in a dedicated message RAM • Individual identifier mask for each message object • Programmable FIFO mode for message objects • Programmable loop-back modes for self-test operation • Suspend mode for debug support • Automatic bus on after Bus-Off state by a programmable 32-bit timer • Message RAM single error correction and double error detection (SECDED) mechanism • Direct access to message RAM during test mode • Support for two interrupt lines: Level 0 and Level 1, plus separate ECC interrupt line • Local power down and wakeup support • Automatic message RAM initialization • Support for DMA access For more information, see section DCAN in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.12 MCAN The Controller Area Network (CAN) is a serial communications protocol which efficiently supports distributed real-time control with a high level of security. CAN has high immunity to electrical interference and the ability to self-diagnose and repair data errors. In a CAN network, many short messages are broadcast to the entire network, which provides for data consistency in every node of the system. The MCAN module supports both classic CAN and CAN FD (CAN with Flexible Data-Rate) specifications. CAN FD feature allows high throughput and increased payload per data frame. The classic CAN and CAN FD devices can coexist on the same network without any conflict. The MCAN module implements the following features: • Conforms with ISO 11898-1:2015 • Full CAN FD support (up to 64 data bytes) • AUTOSAR and SAE J1939 support • Up to 32 dedicated Transmit Buffers • Configurable Transmit FIFO, up to 32 elements • Configurable Transmit Queue, up to 32 elements • Configurable Transmit Event FIFO, up to 32 elements • Up to 64 dedicated Receive Buffers • Two configurable Receive FIFOs, up to 64 elements each • Up to 128 filter elements Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 197 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • • • • www.ti.com Internal Loopback mode for self-test Maskable interrupts, two interrupt lines Two clock domains (CAN clock/Host clock) Parity/ECC support - Message RAM single error correction and double error detection (SECDED) mechanism Local power-down and wakeup support Timestamp Counter For more information, see section MCAN in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.13 GMAC_SW The three-port gigabit ethernet switch subsystem (GMAC_SW) provides ethernet packet communication and can be configured as an ethernet switch. It provides the reduced gigabit media independent interface (RGMII), and the management data input output (MDIO) for physical layer device (PHY) management. The GMAC_SW subsystem provides the following features: • Two Ethernet ports (port 1 and port 2) with RGMII interfaces plus internal Communications Port Programming Interface (CPPI 3.1) on port 0 • Synchronous 10/100/1000 Mbit operation • Wire rate switching (802.1d) • Non-blocking switch fabric • Flexible logical FIFO-based packet buffer structure • Four priority level Quality Of Service (QOS) support (802.1p) • CPPI 3.1 compliant DMA controllers • Support for Audio/Video Bridging (P802.1Qav/D6.0) • Support for IEEE 1588 Clock Synchronization (2008 Annex D and Annex F) – Timing FIFO and time stamping logic embedded in the subsystem • Device Level Ring (DLR) Support • Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) support (802.3az) • Flow Control Support (802.3x) • Address Lookup Engine (ALE) – 1024 total address entries plus VLANs – Wire rate lookup – Host controlled time-based aging – Multiple spanning tree support (spanning tree per VLAN) – L2 address lock and L2 filtering support – MAC authentication (802.1x) – Receive-based or destination-based multicast and broadcast rate limits – MAC address blocking – Source port locking – OUI (Vendor ID) host accept/deny feature – Remapping of priority level of VLAN or ports • VLAN support – 802.1Q compliant • Auto add port VLAN for untagged frames on ingress • Auto VLAN removal on egress and auto pad to minimum frame size • Ethernet Statistics: – EtherStats and 802.3Stats Remote network Monitoring (RMON) statistics gathering (shared) – Programmable statistics interrupt mask when a statistic is above one half its 32-bit value 198 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • • • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Flow Control Support (802.3x) Digital loopback and FIFO loopback modes supported Maximum frame size 2016 bytes (2020 with VLAN) 8k (2048 × 32) internal CPPI buffer descriptor memory Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) module for PHY Management Programmable interrupt control with selected interrupt pacing Emulation support Programmable Transmit Inter Packet Gap (IPG) Reset isolation (switch function remains active even in case of all device resets except for POR pin reset and ICEPICK cold reset) Full duplex mode supported in 10/100/1000 Mbps. Half-duplex mode supported only in 10/100 Mbps. IEEE 802.3 gigabit Ethernet conformant For more information, see section Gigabit Ethernet Switch (GMAC_SW) in chapter Serial Communication Interfaces of the device TRM. 6.10.14 SDIO The SDIO host controller provides an interface between a local host (LH) such as a microprocessor unit or digital signal processor and SDIO cards. It handles SDIO transactions with minimal LH intervention. The SDIO host controller deals with SDIO protocol at transmission level, data packing, adding cyclic redundancy checks (CRCs), start/end bit, and checking for syntactical correctness. The application interface can send every SDIO command and poll for the status of the adapter or wait for an interrupt request, which is sent back in case of exceptions or to warn of end of operation. The application interface can read card responses or flag registers. It can also mask individual interrupt sources. All these operations can be performed by reading and writing control registers. The SDIO host controller also supports two slave DMA channels. Compliance with standards: • SDIO command/response sets and interrupt/read-wait suspend-resume operations as defined in the SD part E1 specification v3.00 • SD command/response sets as defined in the SD Physical Layer specification v3.01 • SD Host Controller Standard Specification sets as defined in the SD card specification Part A2 v3.00 Main features of the SD/SDIO host controllers: • Flexible architecture allowing support for new command structure • 32-bit wide access bus to maximize bus throughput • Designed for low power • Programmable clock generation • L4 slave interface supports: – 32-bit data bus width – 8/16/32 bit access supported – 9-bit address bus width – Streaming burst supported only with burst length up to 7 – WNP supported • Built-in 1024-byte buffer for read or write • Two DMA channels, one interrupt line • Supported data transfer rates up to SDR25 mode • The SDIO controller is connected to 1,8V/3.3V compatible I/Os to support 1,8V/3.3V signaling Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 199 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com The differences between the SDIO host controller and a standard SD host controller defined by the SD Card Specification, Part A2, SD Host Controller Standard Specification, v3.00 are: • The clock divider in the SDIO host controller supports a wider range of frequency than specified in the SD Memory Card Specifications, v3.0. The SDIO host controller supports odd and even clock ratioes. • The SDIO host controller supports configurable busy time-out. • There is no external LED control For more information, see chapter SDIO Controller of the device TRM. 200 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 6.10.15 GPIO The general-purpose interface combines four general-purpose input/output (GPIO) banks. Each GPIO module provides 32 dedicated general-purpose pins with input and output capabilities; thus, the general-purpose interface supports up to 126 pins. These pins can be configured for the following applications: • Data input (capture)/output (drive) • Keyboard interface with a debounce cell • Interrupt generation in active mode upon the detection of external events. Detected events are processed by two parallel independent interrupt-generation submodules to support biprocessor operations. • Wake-up request generation in idle mode upon the detection of external events For more information, see chapter General-Purpose Interface of the device TRM. 6.10.16 ePWM An effective PWM peripheral must be able to generate complex pulse width waveforms with minimal CPU overhead or intervention. It needs to be highly programmable and very flexible while being easy to understand and use. The ePWM unit described here addresses these requirements by allocating all needed timing and control resources on a per PWM channel basis. Cross coupling or sharing of resources has been avoided; instead, the ePWM is built up from smaller single channel modules with separate resources and that can operate together as required to form a system. This modular approach results in an orthogonal architecture and provides a more transparent view of the peripheral structure, helping users to understand its operation quickly. Each ePWM module supports the following features: • Dedicated 16-bit time-base counter with period and frequency control • Two PWM outputs (EPWM1A and EPWM2B) that can be used in the following configurations: – Two independent PWM outputs with single-edge operation – Two independent PWM outputs with dual-edge symmetric operation – One independent PWM output with dual-edge asymmetric operation • Asynchronous override control of PWM signals through software. • Hardware-locked (synchronized) phase relationship on a cycle-by-cycle basis. • Dead-band generation with independent rising and falling edge delay control. • Programmable trip zone allocation of both cycle-by-cycle trip and one-shot trip on fault conditions. • A trip condition can force either high, low, or high-impedance state logic levels at PWM outputs. • Programmable event prescaling minimizes CPU overhead on interrupts. • PWM chopping by high-frequency carrier signal, useful for pulse transformer gate drives. For more information, see section Enhanced PWM (ePWM) Module in chapter Pulse-Width Modulation Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.10.17 eCAP Uses for eCAP include: • Sample rate measurements of audio inputs • Speed measurements of rotating machinery (for example, toothed sprockets sensed via Hall sensors) • Elapsed time measurements between position sensor pulses • Period and duty cycle measurements of pulse train signals • Decoding current or voltage amplitude derived from duty cycle encoded current/voltage sensors The eCAP module includes the following features: Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 201 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • • • • • • • • www.ti.com 32-bit time base counter 4-event time-stamp registers (each 32 bits) Edge polarity selection for up to four sequenced time-stamp capture events Interrupt on either of the four events Single shot capture of up to four event time-stamps Continuous mode capture of time-stamps in a four-deep circular buffer Absolute time-stamp capture Difference (Delta) mode time-stamp capture All above resources dedicated to a single input pin When not used in capture mode, the ECAP module can be configured as a single channel PWM output For more information, see section Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Module in chapter Pulse-Width Modulation Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.10.18 eQEP A single track of slots patterns the periphery of an incremental encoder disk. These slots create an alternating pattern of dark and light lines. The disk count is defined as the number of dark/light line pairs that occur per revolution (lines per revolution). As a rule, a second track is added to generate a signal that occurs once per revolution (index signal: QEPI), which can be used to indicate an absolute position. Encoder manufacturers identify the index pulse using different terms such as index, marker, home position, and zero reference. To derive direction information, the lines on the disk are read out by two different photo-elements that "look" at the disk pattern with a mechanical shift of 1/4 the pitch of a line pair between them. This shift is realized with a reticle or mask that restricts the view of the photo-element to the desired part of the disk lines. As the disk rotates, the two photo-elements generate signals that are shifted 90 degrees out of phase from each other. These are commonly called the quadrature QEPA and QEPB signals. The clockwise direction for most encoders is defined as the QEPA channel going positive before the QEPB channel. The encoder wheel typically makes one revolution for every revolution of the motor or the wheel may be at a geared rotation ratio with respect to the motor. Therefore, the frequency of the digital signal coming from the QEPA and QEPB outputs varies proportionally with the velocity of the motor. For example, a 2000-line encoder directly coupled to a motor running at 5000 revolutions per minute (rpm) results in a frequency of 166.6 KHz, so by measuring the frequency of either the QEPA or QEPB output, the processor can determine the velocity of the motor. For more information, see section Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) Module in chapter PulseWidth Modulation Subsystem of the device TRM. 6.11 On-Chip Debug Debugging a system that contains an embedded processor involves an environment that connects highlevel debugging software running on a host computer to a low-level debug interface supported by the target device. Between these levels, a debug and trace controller (DTC) facilitates communication between the host debugger and the debug support logic on the target chip. The DTC is a combination of hardware and software that connects the host debugger to the target system. The DTC uses one or more hardware interfaces and/or protocols to convert actions dictated by the debugger user to JTAG® commands and scans that execute the core hardware. The debug software and hardware components let the user control multiple central processing unit (CPU) cores embedded in the device in a global or local manner. This environment provides: • Synchronized global starting and stopping of multiple processors • Starting and stopping of an individual processor 202 Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Each processor can generate triggers that can be used to alter the execution flow of other processors System topics include but are not limited to: • System clocking and power-down issues • Interconnection of multiple devices • Trigger channels The device deploys Texas Instrument's CTools debug technology for on-chip debug and trace support. It provides the following features: • External debug interfaces: – Primary debug interface - IEEE1149.1 (JTAG) or IEEE1149.7 (complementary superset of JTAG) • Used for debugger connection • Default mode is IEEE1149.1 but debugger can switch to IEEE1149.7 via an IEEE1149.7 adapter module • Controls ICEPick™ (generic test access port [TAP] for dynamic TAP insertion) to allow the debugger to access several debug resources through its secondary (output) JTAG ports (for more information, see section ICEPick Secondary TAPs in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM). – Debug (trace) port • Can be used to export processor or system trace off-chip (to an external trace receiver) • Can be used for cross-triggering with an external device • Configured through debug resources manager (DRM) module instantiated in the debug subsystem • For more information about debug (trace) port, see sections Debug (Trace) Port and Concurrent Debug Modes in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. • JTAG based processor debug on: – C66x in DSP1 – Cortex-M4 (x2) in IPU – ARP32 in EVE • Dynamic TAP insertion – Controlled by ICEPick – For more information, see section Dynamic TAP Insertion in chapter On-Chip Debug Support • Power and clock management – Debugger can get the status of the power domain associated to each TAP. – Debugger may prevent the application software switching off the power domain. – Application power management behavior can be preserved during debug across power transitions. – For more information, see section Power and Clock Management in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. • Reset management – Debugger can configure ICEPick to assert, block, or extend the reset of a given subsystem. – For more information, see section Reset Management in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 203 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • 204 www.ti.com Cross-triggering – Provides a way to propagate debug (trigger) events from one processor, subsystem, or module to another: • Subsystem A can be programmed to generate a debug event, which can then be exported as a global trigger across the device. • Subsystem B can be programmed to be sensitive to the trigger line input and to generate an action on trigger detection. – Two global trigger lines are implemented – Device-level cross-triggering is handled by the XTRIG (TI cross-trigger) module implemented in the debug subsystem – For more information about cross-triggering, see section Cross-Triggering in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. Suspend – Provides a way to stop a closely coupled hardware process running on a peripheral module when the host processor enters debug state – For more information about suspend, see section Suspend in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. Processor trace – C66x (DSP) processor trace is supported – Two exclusive trace sinks: • CoreSight Trace Port Interface Unit (CS_TPIU) – trace export to an external trace receiver • CTools Trace Buffer Router (CT_TBR) in system bridge mode – trace export through USB – For more information, see section Processor Trace in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 System instrumentation (trace) – Supported by a CTools System Trace Module (CT_STM), implementing MIPI System Trace Protocol (STP) (rev 2.0) – Real-time software trace • System-on-chip (SoC) software instrumentation through CT_STM (STP2.0) – OCP watchpoint (OCP_WP_NOC) • OCP target traffic monitoring: OCP_WP_NOC can be configured to generate a trigger upon watchpoint match (that is, when target transaction attributes match the user-defined attributes). • SoC events trace • DMA transfer profiling – Statistics collector (performance probes) • Computes traffic statistics within a user-defined window and periodically reports to the user through the CT_STM interface • Embedded in the L3_MAIN interconnect • 10 instances: – 1 instance dedicated to target (SDRAM) load monitoring – 9 instances dedicated to master latency monitoring – EVE instrumentation • Supported through a software message and system trace event (SMSET) module embedded in the EVE subsystem – ISS instrumentation • Supported through system trace event (CTSET) module embedded in the ISS subsystem – Power-management events profiling (PM instrumentation [PMI]) • Monitoring major power-management events. The PM state changes are handled as generic events and encapsulated in STP messages. – Clock-management events profiling CM instrumentation [CMI]) for CM_CORE_AON clocks • Monitoring major clock management events. The CM state changes are handled as generic events and encapsulated in STP messages. • One instances – CM1 Instrumentation (CMI1) module mapped in the PD_CORE_AON power domain – For more information, see section System Instrumentation in chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the Device TRM. Performance monitoring – Supported by subsystem counter timer module (SCTM) for IPU For more information, see chapter On-Chip Debug Support of the device TRM. Detailed Description Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 205 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 7 Applications, Implementation, and Layout NOTE Information in the following applications sections is not part of the TI component specification, and TI does not warrant its accuracy or completeness. TI’s customers are responsible for determining suitability of components for their purposes. Customers should validate and test design implementation to confirm system functionality. 7.1 Introduction This chapter is intended to communicate, guide and illustrate a PCB design strategy resulting in a PCB that can support TI’s latest Application Processor. This Processor is a high-performance processor designed for automotive Infotainment based on enhanced OMAP™ architecture integrated on a 28-nm CMOS process technology. These guidelines first focus on designing a robust Power Delivery Network (PDN) which is essential to achieve the desirable high performance processing available on Device. The general principles and stepby-step approach for implementing good power integrity (PI) with specific requirements will be described for the key Device power domains. TI strongly believes that simulating a PCB’s proposed PDN is required for first pass PCB design success. Key Device processor high-current power domains need to be evaluated for Power Rail IR Drop, Decoupling Capacitor Loop-Inductance and Power Rail Target Impedance. Only then can a PCB’s PDN performance be truly accessed by comparing these model PI parameters vs. TI’s recommended values. Ultimately for any high-volume product, TI recommends conducting a "Processor PDN Validation" test on prototype PCBs across processor "split lots" to verify PDN robustness meets desired performance goals for each customer’s worst-case scenario. Please contact your TI representative to receive guidance on PDN PI modeling and validation testing. Likewise, the methodology and requirements needed to route Device high-speed, differential interfaces , single-ended interfaces (i.e. DDR3, QSPI) and general purpose interfaces using LVCMOS drivers that meet timing requirements while minimizing signal integrity (SI) distortions on the PCB’s signaling traces. Signal trace lengths and flight times are aligned with FR-4 standard specification for PCBs. Several different PCB layout stack-up examples have been presented to illustrate a typical number of layers, signal assignments and controlled impedance requirements. Different Device interface signals demand more or less complexity for routing and controlled impedance stack-ups. Optimizing the PCB’s PDN stack-up needs with all of these different types of signal interfaces will ultimately determine the final layer count and layer assignments in each customer’s PCB design. This guideline must be used as a supplement in complement to TI’s Application Processor, Power Management IC (PMIC) and Audio Companion components along with other TI component technical documentation (i.e. Technical Reference Manual, Data Manual, Data Sheets, Silicon Errata, Pin-Out Spreadsheet, Application Notes, etc.). NOTE Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary, TI makes no warranty expressed, implied, or statutory, including any implied warranty of merchantability of fitness for a specific purpose, for customer boards. The data described in this appendix are intended as guidelines only. NOTE These PCB guidelines are in a draft maturity and consequently, are subject to change depending on design verification testing conducted during IC development and validation. Note also that any references to Application Processor’s ballout or pin muxing are subject to change following the processor’s ballout maturity. 206 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.1.1 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Initial Requirements and Guidelines Unless otherwise specified, the characteristic impedance for single-ended interfaces is recommended to be between 35 Ω and 65 Ω to minimize the overshoot or undershoot on far-end loads. Characteristic impedance for differential interfaces must be routed as differential traces on the same layer. The trace width and spacing must be chosen to yield the recommended differential impedance. For more information see Section 7.5.1. The PDN must be optimized for low trace resistance and low trace inductance for all high-current power nets from PMIC to the device. An external interface using a connector must be protected following the IEC61000-4-2 level 4 system ESD. 7.2 Power Optimizations This section describes the necessary steps for designing a robust Power Distribution Network (PDN): • Section 7.2.1, Step 1: PCB Stack-up • Section 7.2.2, Step 2: Physical Placement • Section 7.2.3, Step 3: Static Analysis • Section 7.2.4, Step 4: Frequency Analysis 7.2.1 Step 1: PCB Stack-up The PCB stack-up (layer assignment) is an important factor in determining the optimal performance of the power distribution system. An optimized PCB stack-up for higher power integrity performance can be achieved by following these recommendations: • Power and ground plane pairs must be closely coupled together. The capacitance formed between the planes can decouple the power supply at high frequencies. Whenever possible, the power and ground planes must be solid to provide continuous return path for return current. • Use a thin dielectric between the power and ground plane pair. Capacitance is inversely proportional to the separation of the plane pair. Minimizing the separation distance (the dielectric thickness) maximizes the capacitance. • Optimize the power and ground plane pair carrying high current supplies to key component power domains as close as possible to the same surface where these components are placed (see Figure 71). This will help to minimize "loop inductance" encountered between supply decoupling capacitors and component supply inputs and between power and ground plane pairs. NOTE 1-2oz Cu weight for power / ground plane is preferred to enable better PCB heat spreading, helping to reduce Processor junction temperatures. In addition, it is preferable to have the power / ground planes be adjacent to the PCB surface on which the Processor is mounted. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 207 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Capacitor Trace DIE Package Via 3 1 Power/Ground 2 Ground/Power Note: 1. BGA via pair loop inductance 2. Power/Ground net spreading inductance 3. Capacitor trace inductance Loop inductance SPRS91v_PCB_STACKUP_01 Figure 7-1. Minimize Loop Inductance With Proper Layer Assignment The placement of power and ground planes in the PCB stackup (determined by layer assignment) has a significant impact on the parasitic inductances of power current path as shown in Figure 7-1. For this reason, it is recommended to consider layer order in the early stages of the PCB PDN design cycle, putting high-priority supplies in the top half of the stackup (assuming high load and priority components are mounted on the top-side of PCB) and low-priority supplies in the bottom half of the stackup as shown in the examples below (vias have parasitic inductances which impact the bottom layers more, so it is advised to put the sensitive and high-priority power supplies on the top/same layers). 7.2.2 Step 2: Physical Placement A critical step in designing an optimized PDN is that proper care must be taken to making sure that the initial floor planning of the PCB layout is done with good power integrity design guidelines in mind. The following points are important for optimizing a PCB’s PDN: • Minimizing the physical distance between power sources and key high load components is the first step toward optimization. Placing source and load components on the same side of the PCB is desirable. This will minimize via inductance impact for high current loads and steps • External trace routing between components must be as wide as possible. The wider the traces, the lower the DC resistance and consequently the lower the static IR drop. • Whenever possible for the internal layers (routing and plane), wide traces and copper area fills are preferred for PDN layout. The routing of power nets in plane provide for more interplane capacitance and improved high frequency performance of the PDN. • Whenever possible, use a via to component pin/pad ratio of 1:1 or better (i.e. especially decoupling capacitors, power inductors and current sensing resistors). Do not share vias among multiple capacitors for connecting power supply and ground planes. • Placement of vias must be as close as possible or even within a component’s solder pad if the PCB technology you are using provides this capability. • To avoid any "ampacity” issue – maximum current-carrying capacity of each transitional via should be evaluated to determine the appropriate number of vias required to connect components. Adding vias to bring the "via-to-pad” ratio to 1:1 will improve PDN performance. • For noise sensitive power supplies (i.e. Phase Lock-Loops, analog signals like audio and video), a Gnd shield can be used to isolate coplanar supplies that may have high step currents or high frequency switching transitions from coupling into low-noise supplies. 208 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 vdd_mpu vss vdd SPRS91v_PCB_PHYS_05 Figure 7-2. Coplanar Shielding of Power Net Using Ground Guard-band 7.2.3 Step 3: Static Analysis Delivering reliable power to circuits is always of critical importance because voltage drops (also known as IR drops) can happen at every level within an electronic system, on-chip, within a package, and across the board. Robust system performance can only be ensured by understanding how the system elements will perform under typical stressful Use Cases. Therefore, it is a good practice to perform a Static or DC Analysis. Static or DC analysis and design methodology results in a PDN design that minimizes voltage or IR drops across power and ground planes, traces and vias. This ensures the application processor’s internal transistors will be operating within their specified voltage ranges for proper functionality. The amount of IR drop that will be encounter is based upon amount power drawn for a desired Use Case and PCB trace (widths, geometry and number of parallel traces) and via (size, type and number) characteristics. Components that are distant from their power source are particularly susceptible to IR drop. Designs that rely on battery power must minimize voltage drops to avoid unacceptable power loss that can negatively impact system performance. Early assessments a PDN’s static (DC) performance helps to determine basic power distribution parameters such as best system input power point, optimal PCB layer stackup, and copper area needed for load currents. The resistance Rs of a plane conductor for a unit length and unit width is called the surface resistivity (ohms per square). L r 1 = σ ×t t l R = Rs × w Rs = W t SPRS91v_PCB_STATIC_01 Figure 7-3. Depiction of Sheet Resistivity and Resistance Ohm’s Law (V = I × R) relates conduction current to voltage drop. At DC, the relation coefficient is a constant and represents the resistance of the conductor. Even current carrying conductors will dissipate power at high currents even though their resistance may be very small. Both voltage drop and power dissipation are proportional to the resistance of the conductor. Figure 7-4 shows a PCB-level static IR drop budget defined between the power management device (PMIC) pins and the application processor’s balls when the PMIC is supplying power. • It is highly recommended to physically place the PMIC as close as possible to the processor and on the same side. The orientation of the PMIC vs. the processor should be aligned to minimize distance for the highest current rail. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 209 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com PCB Static IR drop and Effective Resistance Source Component Load Component BGA pad on PCB SPRS977_PCB_STATIC_02 Figure 7-4. Static IR Drop Budget for PCB Only The system-level IR drop budget is made up of three portions: on-chip, package, and PCB board. Static IR or dc analysis/design methodology consists of designing the PDN such that the voltage drop (under dc operating conditions) across power and ground pads of the transistors of the application processor device is within a specified value of the nominal voltage for proper functionality of the device. A PCB system-level voltage drop budget for proper device functionality is typically 1.5% of nominal voltage. For a 1.35-V supply, this would be ≤20 mV. To accurately analyze PCB static IR drop, the actual geometry of the PDN must be modeled properly and simulated to accurately characterize long distribution paths, copper weight impacts, electro-migration violations of current-carrying vias, and "Swiss-cheese” effects via placement has on power rails. It is recommended to perform the following analyses: • Lumped resistance/IR drop analysis • Distributed resistance/IR drop analysis NOTE The PMIC companion device supporting Processor has been designed with voltage sensing feedback loop capabilities that enable a remote sense of the SMPS output voltage at the point of use. The NOTE above means the SMPS feedback signals and returns must be routed across PCB and connected to the Device input power ball for which a particular SMPS is supplying power. This feedback loop provides compensation for some of the voltage drop encountered across the PDN within limits. As such, the effective resistance of the PDN within this loop should be determined in order to optimize voltage compensation loop performance. The resistance of two PDN segments are of interest: one from the power inductor/bulk power filtering capacitor node to the Processor’s input power and second is the entire PDN route from SMPS output pin/ball to the Processor input power. In the following sections each methodology is described in detail and an example has been provided of analysis flow that can be used by the PCB designer to validate compliance to the requirements on their PCB PDN design. 210 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.2.3.1 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 PDN Resistance and IR Drop Lumped methodology consists of grouping all of the power pins on both the PMIC (voltage source) and processor (current sink) devices. Then the PMIC source is set to an expected Use Case voltage level and the processor load has its Use Case current sink value set as well. Now the lumped/effective resistance for the power rail trace/plane routes can be determine based upon the actual layout’s power rail etch wide, shape, length, via count and placement Figure 7-5 illustrates the pin-grouping/lumped concept. The lumped methodology consists of importing the PCB layout database (from Cadence Allegro tool or any other layout design tool) into the static IR drop modeling and simulation tool of preference for the PCB designer. This is followed by applying the correct PCB stack-up information (thickness, material properties) of the PCB dielectric and metallization layers. The material properties of dielectric consist of permittivity (Dk) and loss tangent (Df). For the conductor layers, the correct conductivity needs to be programmed into the simulation tool. This is followed by pin-grouping of the power and ground nets, and applying appropriate voltage/current sources. The current and voltage information can be obtained from the power and voltage specifications of the device under different operating conditions / Use Cases. Sources Multiport net Sources Branch Grouped Power/Ground pins to create 1 equivalent resistive branch Port/Pin Sinks Sinks SPRS91v_PCB_PDN_01 Figure 7-5. Pin-grouping concept: Lumped and Distributed Methodologies 7.2.4 Step 4: Frequency Analysis Delivering low noise voltage sources are very important to allowing a system to operate at the lowest possible Operational Performance Point (OPP) for any one Use Case. An OPP is a combination of the supply voltage level and clocking rate for key internal processor domains. A SCH and PCB designed to provide low noise voltage supplies will then enable the processor to enter optimal OPPs for each Use Case that in turn will minimize power dissipation and junction temperatures on-die. Therefore, it is a good engineering practice to perform a Frequency Analysis over the key power domains. Frequency analysis and design methodology results in a PDN design that minimizes transient noise voltages at the processor’s input power balls. This allows the processor’s internal transistors to operate near the minimum specified operating supply voltage levels. To accomplish this one must evaluate how a voltage supply will change due to impedance variations over frequency. This analysis will focus on the decoupling capacitor network (VDD_xxx and VSS/Gnd rails) at the load. Sufficient capacitance with a distribution of self-resonant points will provide for an overall lower impedance vs frequency response for each power domain. Decoupling components that are distant from their load’s input power are susceptible to encountering spreading loop inductance from the PCB design. Early analysis of each key power domain’s frequency response helps to determine basic decoupling capacitor placement, optimal footprint, layer assignment, and types needed for minimizing supply voltage noise/fluctuations due to switching and load current transients. NOTE Evaluation of loop inductance values for decoupling capacitors placed ~300mils closer to the load’s input power balls has shown an 18% reduction in loop inductance due to reduced distance. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 211 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • www.ti.com Decoupling capacitors must be carefully placed in order to minimize loop inductance impact on supply voltage transients. A real capacitor has characteristics not only of capacitance but also inductance and resistance. Figure 7-6 shows the parasitic model of a real capacitor. A real capacitor must be treated as an RLC circuit with effective series resistance (ESR) and effective series inductance (ESL). C ESL ESR SPRS91v_PCB_FREQ_01 Figure 7-6. Characteristics of a Real Capacitor With ESL and ESR The magnitude of the impedance of this series model is given as: Z = 1 ö æ ESR 2 +ωESL ç ωESL - ωC ÷ ø è 2 where : w = 2π¦ SPRS91v_PCB_FREQ_02 Figure 7-7. Series Model Impedance Equation Figure 7-8 shows the resonant frequency response of a typical capacitor with a self-resonant frequency of 55 MHz. The impedance of the capacitor is a combination of its series resistance and reactive capacitance and inductance as shown in the equation above. S-Parameter Magnitude Job: GCM155R71E153KA55_15NF; 1.0e+01 1.0e+00 1.0e–01 1.0e–02 XC=1/ωC XL=ωL 1.0e–03 Resonant frequency (55 MHz) (minimum) 1.0e–04 1.00e–002 1.00e+000 1.00e+002 1.00e+004 1.00e+006 1.00e+008 Frequency (MHz) SPRS91v_PCB_FREQ_03 Figure 7-8. Typical Impedance Profile of a Capacitor 212 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Because a capacitor has series inductance and resistance that impacts its effectiveness, it is important that the following recommendations are adopted in placing capacitors on the PDN. Wherever possible, mount the capacitor with the geometry that minimizes the mounting inductance and resistance. This was shown earlier in Figure 7-1. The capacitor mounting inductance and resistance values include the inductance and resistance of the pads, trace, and vias. Whenever possible, use footprints that have the lowest inductance configuration as shown in Figure 7-9 The length of a trace used to connect a capacitor has a big impact on parasitic inductance and resistance of the mounting. This trace must be as short and as wide as possible. wherever possible, minimize distance to supply and Gnd vias by locating vias nearby or within the capacitor’s solder pad landing. Further improvements can be made to the mounting by placing vias to the side of capacitor lands or doubling the number of vias as shown in Figure 7-9. If the PCB manufacturing processes allow it and if cost-effective, via-in-pad (VIP) geometries are strongly recommended. In addition to mounting inductance and resistance associated with placing a capacitor on the PCB, the effectiveness of a decoupling capacitor also depends on the spreading inductance and resistance that the capacitor sees with respect to the load. The spreading inductance and resistance is strongly dependent on the layer assignment in the PCB stack-up. Therefore, try to minimize X, Y and Z dimensions where the Z is due to PCB thickness (as shown in Figure 7-9). From left (highest inductance) to right (lowest inductance) the capacitor footprint types shown in Figure 79 are known as: • 2-via, Skinny End Exit (2vSEE) • 2-via, Wide End Exit (2vWEE) • 2-via, Wide Side Exit (2vWSE) • 4-via, Wide Side Exit (4vWSE) • 2-via, In-Pad (2vIP) Via Via-in-pad Pad Trace Mounting geometry for reduced inductance SPRS91v_PCB_FREQ_04 Figure 7-9. Capacitor Placement Geometry for Improved Mounting Inductance NOTE Evaluation of loop inductance values for decoupling capacitor footprints 2vSEE (worst case) vs 4vWSE (2nd best) has shown a 30% reduction in inductance when 4vWSE footprint was used in place of 2vSEE. Decoupling Capacitor (Dcap) Strategy: Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 213 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 1. Use lowest inductance footprint and trace connection scheme possible for given PCB technology and layout area in order to minimize Dcap loop inductance to power pin as much as possible (see Figure 79). 2. Place Dcaps on "same-side” as component within their power plane outline to minimize "decoupling loop inductance”. Target distance to power pin should be less than ~500mils depending upon PCB layout characteristics (plane's layer assignment and solid nature). Use PI modeling CAD tool to verify minimum inductance for top vs bottom-side placement. 3. Place Dcaps on "opposite-side” as component within their power plane outline if "same-side” is not feasible or if distance to power pin is greater than ~500mils for top-side location. Use PI modeling CAD tool to verify minimum inductance for top vs bottom-side placement. 4. Use minimum 10mil trace width for all voltage and gnd planes connections (i.e. Dcap pads, component power pins, etc.). 5. Place all voltage and gnd plane vias "as close as possible” to point of use (i.e. Dcap pads, component power pins, etc.). 6. Use a "Power/Gnd pad/pin to via” ratio of 1:1 whenever possible. Do not exceed 2:1 ratio for small number of vias within restricted PCB areas (i.e. underneath BGA components). Frequency analysis for the CORE power domain (vdd) has yielded the Impedance vs Frequency responses shown in Section 7.3.7.2, vdd Example Analysis. 7.2.5 System ESD Generic Guidelines 7.2.5.1 System ESD Generic PCB Guideline Protection devices must be placed close to the ESD source which means close to the connector. This allows the device to subtract the energy associated with an ESD strike before it reaches the internal circuitry of the application board. To help minimize the residual voltage pulse that will be built-up at the protection device due to its nonzero turn-on impedance, it is mandatory to route the ESD device with minimum stub length so that the lowresistive, low-inductive path from the signal to the ground is granted and not increasing the impedance between signal and ground. For ESD protection array being railed to a power supply when no decoupling capacitor is available in close vicinity, consider using a decoupling capacitor (≥ 0.1 µF) tight to the VCC pin of the ESD protection. A positive strike will be partially diverted to this capacitance resulting in a lower residual voltage pulse. Ensure that there is sufficient metallization for the supply of signals at the interconnect side (VCC and GND in Figure 7-10) from connector to external protection because the interconnect may see between 15A to 30-A current in a short period of time during the ESD event. 214 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Bypass capacitor 0.1 mf (minimum) Stub inductance Connector Stub inductance Interconnection inductance vcc Signal VCC VCC Protected circuit Stub inductance Minimize such inductance by optimizing layout ESD strike External protection Ground inductance Keep distance between protected circuit and external protection Signal Keep external protection closed by connector SPRS91v_PCB_ESD_01 Figure 7-10. Placement Recommendation for an ESD External Protection NOTE To ensure normal behavior of the ESD protection (unwanted leakage), it is better to ground the ESD protection to the board ground rather than any local ground (example isolated shield or audio ground). 7.2.5.2 • • • • • • • • Miscellaneous EMC Guidelines to Mitigate ESD Immunity Avoid running critical signal traces (clocks, resets, interrupts, control signals, and so forth) near PCB edges. Add high frequency filtering: Decoupling capacitors close to the receivers rather than close to the drivers to minimize ESD coupling. Put a ground (guard) ring around the entire periphery of the PCB to act as a lightning rod. Connect the guard ring to the PCB ground plane to provide a low impedance path for ESD-coupled current on the ring. Fill unused portions of the PCB with ground plane. Minimize circuit loops between power and ground by using multilayer PCB with dedicated power and ground planes. Shield long line length (strip lines) to minimize radiated ESD. Avoid running traces over split ground planes. It is better to use a bridge connecting the two planes in one area. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 215 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com BAD BETTER SPRS91v_PCB_EMC_01 • 7.2.5.3 Figure 7-11. Trace Examples Always route signal traces and their associated ground returns as close to one another as possible to minimize the loop area enclosed by current flow: – At high frequencies current follows the path of least inductance. – At low frequencies current flows through the path of least resistance. ESD Protection System Design Consideration ESD protection system design consideration is covered in of this document. The following are additional considerations for ESD protection in a system. • Metallic shielding for both ESD and EMI • Chassis GND isolation from the board GND • Air gap designed on board to absorb ESD energy • Clamping diodes to absorb ESD energy • Capacitors to divert ESD energy • The use of external ESD components on the DP/DM lines may affect signal quality and are not recommended. 7.2.6 EMI / EMC Issues Prevention All high-speed digital integrated circuits can be sources of unwanted radiation, which can affect nearby sensitive circuitry and cause the final product to have radiated emissions levels above the limits allowed by the EMC regulations if some preventative steps are not taken. Likewise, analog and digital circuits can be susceptible to interference from the outside world and picked up by the circuitry interconnections. To minimize the potential for EMI/EMC issues, the following guidelines are recommended to be followed. 7.2.6.1 Signal Bandwidth To evaluate the frequency of a digital signal, an estimated rule of thumb is to consider its bandwidth fBW with respect to its rise time, tR: fBW ≈ 0.35 / tR This frequency actually corresponds to the break point in the signal spectrum, where the harmonics start to decay at 40 dB per decade instead of 20 dB per decade. 216 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.2.6.2 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Signal Routing 7.2.6.2.1 Signal Routing—Sensitive Signals and Shielding Keep radio frequency (RF) sensitive circuitry (like GPS receivers, GSM/WCDMA, Bluetooth/WLAN transceivers, frequency modulation (FM) radio) away from high-speed ICs (the device, power and audio manager, chargers, memories, and so forth) and ideally on the opposite side of the PCB. For improved protection it is recommended to place these emission sources in a shield can. If the shield can have a removable lid (two-piece shield), ensure there is low contact impedance between the fence and the lid. Leave some space between the lid and the components under it to limit the high-frequency currents induced in the lid. Limit the shield size to put any potential shield resonances above the frequencies of interest; see Figure 7-8, Typical Impedance Profile of a Capacitor. 7.2.6.2.2 Signal Routing—Outer Layer Routing In case there is a need to use the outer layers for routing outside of shielded areas, it is recommended to route only static signals and ensure that these static signals do not carry any high-frequency components (due to parasitic coupling with other signals). In case of long traces, make provision for a bypass capacitor near the signal source. Routing of high-frequency clock signals on outer layers, even for a short distance, is discouraged, because their emissions energy is concentrated at the discrete harmonics and can become significant even with poor radiators. Coplanar shielding of traces on outer layers (placing ground near the sides of a track along its length) is effective only if the distance between the trace sides and the ground is smaller that the trace height above the ground reference plane. For modern multilayer PCBs this is often not possible, so coplanar shielding will not be effective. Do not route high-frequency traces near the periphery of the PCB, as the lack of a ground reference near the trace edges can increase EMI: see Section 7.2.6.3, Ground Guidelines. 7.2.6.3 Ground Guidelines 7.2.6.3.1 PCB Outer Layers Ideally the areas on the top and bottom layers of the PCB that are not enclosed by a shield should be filled with ground after the routing is completed and connected with an adequate number of vias to the ground on the inner ground planes. 7.2.6.3.2 Metallic Frames Ensure that all metallic parts are well connected to the PCB ground (like LCD screens metallic frames, antennas reference planes, connector cages, flex cables grounds, and so forth). If using flex PCB ribbon cables to bring high-frequency signals off the PCB, ensure they are adequately shielded (coaxial cables or flex ribbons with a solid reference ground). 7.2.6.3.3 Connectors For high-frequency signals going to connectors choose a fully shielded connector, if possible (for example, SD card connectors). For signals going to external connectors or which are routed over long distances, it is recommended to reduce their bandwidth by using low-pass filters (resistor, capacitor (RC) combinations or lossy ferrite inductors). These filters will help to prevent emissions from the board and can also improve the immunity from external disturbances. 7.2.6.3.4 Guard Ring on PCB Edges The major advantage of a multilayer PCB with ground-plane is the ground return path below each and every signal or power trace. As shown in Figure 7-12 the field lines of the signal return to PCB ground as long as an infinite ground is available. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 217 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Traces near the PCB-edges do not have this infinite ground and therefore may radiate more than the others. Thus, signals (clocks) or power traces (core power) identified to be critical must not be routed in the vicinity of PCB edges, or, if not avoidable, must be accompanied by a guard ring on the PCB edge. SPRS91v_PCB_EMC_02 Figure 7-12. Field Lines of a Signal Above Ground Signal Power Ground Signal SPRS91v_PCB_EMC_03 Figure 7-13. Guard Ring Routing The intention of the guard ring is that HF-energy, that otherwise would have been emitted from the PCB edge, is reflected back into the board where it partially will be absorbed. For this purpose ground traces on the borders of all layers (including power layer) must be applied as shown in Figure 7-13. As these traces must have the same (HF–) potential as the ground plane they must be connected to the ground plane at least every 10 mm. 7.2.6.3.5 Analog and Digital Ground For the optimum solution, the AGND and the DGND planes must be connected together at the power supply source in a same point. This ensures that both planes are at the same potential, while the transfer of noise from the digital to the analog domain is minimized. 7.3 Core Power Domains This section provides boundary conditions and theoretical background to be applied as a guide for optimizing a PCB design. The decoupling capacitor and PDN characteristics tables shown below give recommended capacitors and PCB parameters to be followed for schematic and PCB designs. Board designs that meet the static and dynamic PDN characteristics shown in tables below will be aligned to the expected PDN performance needed to optimize SoC performance. 7.3.1 General Constraints and Theory • • 218 Max PCB static/DC voltage drop (IRd) budget of 1.5% of supply voltage when using PMICs without remote sensing as measured from PMIC’s power inductor and filter capacitor node to Processor input including any ground return losses. Max PCB static/DC voltage drop (IRd) budget can be relaxed to 7.5% of supply voltage when using TI recommended PMICs with remote sensing at the load as measured from PMIC’s power inductor and filter capacitor node to Device’s supply input including any ground return losses. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • • • • • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 PMIC component DM and guidelines should be referenced for the following: – Routing remote feedback sensing to optimize per each SMPS’s implementation – Selecting power filtering capacitor values and PCB placement. Max Total Effective Resistance (Reff) budget can range from 4 – 100mΩ for key Device power rails not including ground returns depending upon maximum load currents and maximum DC voltage drop budget (as discussed above). Max Device supply input voltage difference budget of 5mV under max current loading shall be maintained across all balls connected to a common power rail. This represents any voltage difference that may exist between a remote sense point to any power input. Max PCB Loop Inductance (LL) budget between Device’s power inputs and local bulk and high frequency decoupling capacitors including ground returns should range from 0.4 – 2.5nH depending upon maximum transient load currents. Max PCB dynamic/AC peak-to-peak transient noise voltage budgets between PMIC and Device including ground returns are as follows: – +/-3% of nominal supply voltage for frequencies below the PMIC bandwidth (typ Fpmic ~ 200kHz) – +/-5% of nominal supply voltage for frequencies between Fpmic to Fpcb (typ 20 – 100MHz) Max PCB Impedance (Z) vs Frequency (F) budget between Device’s power inputs and PMIC’s output power filter node including ground return is determined by applying the Frequency Domain Target Impedance Method to determine the PCB’s maximum frequency of interest (Fpcb). Ideally a properly designed and decoupled PDN will exhibit smoothly increasing Z vs. F curve. There are 2 general regions of interest as can be seen in Figure 7-14. – 1st area is from DC (0Hz) up to Fpmic (typ a few 100 kHz) where a PMIC’s transient response characteristic (i.e. Switching Freq, Compensation Loop BW) dominate. A PDN’s Z is typically very low due to power filtering & bulk capacitor values when PDN has very low trace resistance (i.e. good Reff performance). The goal is to maintain a smoothly increasing Z that is less than Zt1 over this low frequency range. This will ensure that a max transient current event will not cause a voltage drop more than the PMIC’s current step response can support (typ 3%). – 2nd area is from Fpmic up to Fpcb (typ 20-100MHz) where a PCB’s inherent characteristics (i.e. parasitic capacitance, planar spreading inductances) dominate. A PDN’s Z will naturally increase with frequency. At frequencies between Fpmic up to Fpcb, the goal is to maintain a smoothly increasing Z to be less than Zt2. This will ensue that the high frequency content of a max transient current event will not cause a voltage drop to be more than 5% of the min supply voltage. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 219 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Figure 7-14. PDN’s Target impedance 1.Voltage Rail Drop includes regulation accuracy, voltage distribution drops, and all dynamic events such as transient noise, AC ripple, voltage dips etc. 2.Typical max transient current is defined as 50% of max current draw possible. 7.3.2 Voltage Decoupling Recommended power supply decoupling capacitors main characteristics for commercial products whose ambient temperature is not to exceed +85C are shown in table below: Table 7-1. Commercial Applications Recommended Decoupling Capacitors Characteristics(1)(2)(3) Value Voltage [V] Package Stability Dielectric Capacitan ce Tolerance Temp Range [°C] Temp Sensitivity [%] REFERENCE 22µF 6,3 0603 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM188R60J226MEA0L 10µF 4,0 0402 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM155R60G106ME44 4.7µF 6,3 0402 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM155R60J475ME95 2.2µF 6,3 0402 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM155R60J225ME95 1µF 6,3 0201 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM033R60J105MEA2 220 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 7-1. Commercial Applications Recommended Decoupling Capacitors Characteristics(1)(2)(3) (continued) Value Voltage [V] Package Stability Dielectric Capacitan ce Tolerance Temp Range [°C] Temp Sensitivity [%] REFERENCE 470nF 6,3 0201 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM033R60G474ME90 220nF 6,3 0201 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM033R60J224ME90 100nF 6,3 0201 Class 2 X5R - / + 20% -55 to + 85 - / + 15 GRM033R60J104ME19 (1) Minimum value for each PCB capacitor: 100 nF. (2) Among the different capacitors, 470 nF is recommended (not required) to filter at 5-MHz to 10-MHz frequency range. (3) In comparison with the EIA Class 1 dielectrics, Class 2 dielectric capacitors tend to have severe temperature drift, high dependence of capacitance on applied voltage, high voltage coefficient of dissipation factor, high frequency coefficient of dissipation, and problems with aging due to gradual change of crystal structure. Aging causes gradual exponential loss of capacitance and decrease of dissipation factor. Recommended power supply decoupling capacitors main characteristics for automotive products are shown in table below: Table 7-2. Automotive Applications Recommended Decoupling Capacitors Characteristics Value Voltage [V] Package Stability Dielectric Capacitanc Temp e Range [°C] Tolerance 22µF 6,3 1206 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% (1)(2) Temp Sensitivity [%] REFERENCE -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM31CR70J226ME23 10µF 6,3 0805 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM21BR70J106ME22 4.7µF 10 0805 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM21BC71A475MA73 2.2µF 6,3 0603 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM188R70J225ME22 1µF 16 0603 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM188R71C105MA64 470nF 16 0603 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM188R71C474MA55 220nF 25 0603 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM188L81C224MA37 100nF 16 0402 Class 2 X7R - / + 20% -55 to + 125 - / + 15 GCM155R71C104MA55 (1) Minimum value for each PCB capacitor: 100 nF. (2) Among the different capacitors, 470 nF is recommended (not required) to filter at 5-MHz to 10-MHz frequency range. 7.3.3 Static PDN Analysis One power net parameter derived from a PCB’s PDN static analysis is the Effective Resistance (Reff). This is the total PCB power net routing resistance that is the sum of all the individual power net segments used to deliver a supply voltage to the point of load and includes any series resistive elements (i.e. current sensing resistor) that may be installed between the PMIC outputs and Processor inputs. 7.3.4 Dynamic PDN Analysis Three power net parameters derived from a PCB’s PDN dynamic analysis are the Loop Inductance (LL), Impedance (Z) and PCB Frequency of Interest (Fpcb). • LL values shown are the recommended max PCB trace inductance between a decoupling capacitor’s power supply and ground reference terminals when viewed from the decoupling capacitor with a "theoretical shorted” applied across the Processor’s supply inputs to ground reference. • Z values shown are the recommended max PCB trace impedances allowed between Fpmic up to Fpcb frequency range that limits transient noise drops to no more than 5% of min supply voltage during max transient current events. • Fpcb (Frequency of Interest) is defined to be a power rail’s max frequency after which adding a reasonable number of decoupling capacitors no longer significantly reduces the power rail impedance below the desired impedance target (Zt2). This is due to the dominance of the PCB’s parasitic planar spreading and internal package inductances. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 221 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 7-3. Recommended PDN and Decoupling Characteristics PDN Analysis: Supply Static Dynamic (1)(2)(3)(4)(5) Number of Recommended Decoupling Capacitors per Supply Max Impedance [mΩ] Frequency range of Interest [MHz] 100 nF(6) 220 nF 470 nF 1μF [mΩ] Dec. Cap. Max LL(8) (6) [nH] vdd_dspeve 33 2.5 54 ≤20 6 1 1 1 1 1 vdd 83 2 87 ≤50 6 1 1 1 1 1 vdds_ddr1, vdds_ddr2, vdds_ddr3 33 2.5 200 ≤100 8 4 cap_vddram_cor e1 N/A 6 N/A N/A 1 cap_vddram_cor e2 N/A 6 N/A N/A 1 cap_vddram_dsp eve N/A 6 N/A N/A 1 Max Reff (7) 2 2.2 μF 4.7 μF 10 μF 22 μF 2 1 1 (1) For more information on peak-to-peak noise values, see the Recommended Operating Conditions table of the Electrical Characteristics chapter. (2) ESL must be as low as possible and must not exceed 0.5 nH. (3) The PDN (Power Delivery Network) impedance characteristics are defined versus the device activity (that runs at different frequency) based on the Recommended Operating Conditions table of the Electrical Characteristics chapter. (4) The static drop requirement drives the maximum acceptable PCB resistance between the PMIC or the external SMPS and the processor power balls. (5) Assuming that the external SMPS (power IC) feedback sense is taken close to processor power balls. (6) High-frequency (30 to 70MHz) PCB decoupling capacitors (7) Maximum Total Reff from PMIC output to remote sensing feedback point located as close to the Device's point of load as possible. (8) Maximum Loop Inductance for decoupling capacitor. 7.3.5 Power Supply Mapping TPS65917 is a Power management IC (PMIC) that can be used for the Device design. TI is now investigating an optimized solution for high power use cases so the TPS65917 is subject to change. An alternate dual converter power solution using LP8732Q and LP8733Q are recommended. TI requires the use of one of these PMIC solutions for the following reasons: • TI has validated its use with the Device • Board level margins including transient response and output accuracy are analyzed and optimized for the entire system • Support for power sequencing requirements (refer to Section 5.9.3 Power Sequencing) • Support for Adaptive Voltage Scaling (AVS) Class 0 requirements, including TI provided software It is possible that some voltage domains on the device are unused in some systems. In such cases, to ensure device reliability, it is still required that the supply pins for the specific voltage domains are connected to some core power supply output. These unused supplies though can be combined with any of the core supplies that are used (active) in the system. e.g. if IVA and GPU domains are not used, they can be combined with the CORE domain, thereby having a single power supply driving the combined CORE, IVA and GPU domains. For the combined rail, the following relaxations do apply: • The AVS voltage of active rail in the combined rail needs to be used to set the power supply • The decoupling capacitance should be set according to the active rail in the combined rail Whenever we allow for combining of rails mapped on any of the SMPSes, the PDN guidelines that are the most stringent of the rails combined should be implemented for the particular supply rail. 222 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 7-4 illustrates the approved and validated power supply connections to the Device for the SMPS outputs of the TPS65917 and LP8732 combined with LP8733 PMICs. Table 7-4. Power Supply Connections TPS65917 Dual Converter Solution Valid Combination 1: SMPS1 LP8733Q Buck0 vdd_dspeve SMPS2 LP8733Q Buck1 vdd SMPS3 LP8732Q Buck0 vdds18v, vdds18v_ddr[3:1], vddshv[6:1] SMPS4 LP8732Q Buck1 vdds_ddr1, vdds_ddr2, vdds_ddr3 Table 7-5 illustrates the LP8733 and LP8732 OTP IDs required for DM50x processor systems using different DDR memory types. Table 7-5. OTP ID Memory Types Support DDR Type 7.3.6 LP8733Q LP8732Q OTP Version OTP Version DDR2 2A 2D LPDDR2 2A 2B DDR3 2A 2F DDR3L 2A 2E DPLL Voltage Requirement The voltage input to the DPLLs has a low noise requirement. Board designs should supply these voltage inputs with a low noise LDO to ensure they are isolated from any potential digital switching noise. The TPS65917 PMIC LDOLN output or LDO0 on LP8733Q dual power solution is specifically designed to meet this low noise requirement. NOTE For more information about Input Voltage Sources, see DPLLs, DLLs Specifications Table 7-6 presents the voltage inputs that supply the DPLLs. Table 7-6. Input Voltage Power Supplies for the DPLLs POWER SUPPLY 7.3.7 DPLLs vdda_per DPLL_PER and PER HSDIVIDER analog power supply vdda_ddr_dsp DPLL_DSP, DPLL_DDR and DDR HSDIVIDER analog power supply vdda_gmac_core GMAC PLL, GMAC HSDIVIDER, DPLL_CORE and CORE HSDIVIDER analog power supply Example PCB Design The following sections describe an example PCB design and its resulting PDN performance for the vdd_dspeve key processor power domain. NOTE Materials presented in this section are based on generic PDN analysis on PCB boards and are not specific to systems integrating the Device. 7.3.7.1 Example Stack-up Layer Assignments: Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 223 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • • • • • • • • www.ti.com Layer Top: Signal and Segmented Power Plane – Processor and PMIC components placed on Top-side Layer 2: Gnd Plane1 Layer 3: Signals Layer n: Power Plane1 Layer n+1: Power Plane 2 Layer n+2: Signal Layer n+3: Gnd Plane2 Layer Bottom: Signal and Segmented Power Planes – Decoupling caps, etc. Via Technology: Through-hole Copper Weight: • ½ oz for all signal layers. • 1-2oz for all power plane for improved PCB heat spreading. 7.3.7.2 vdd_dspeve Example Analysis Maximum acceptable PCB resistance (Reff) between the PMIC and Processor input power balls should not exceed 33mΩ per Table 7-3 and (7). Maximum decoupling capacitance loop inductance (LL) between Processor input power balls and decoupling capacitances should not exceed 2.5nH per Table 7-3 and (7) (ESL NOT included). Impedance target for key frequency of interest between Processor input power balls and PMIC’s SMPS output power balls should not exceed 54mΩ per Table 7-3 and (7). Table 7-7. Example PCB vdd_dspeve PI Analysis Summary 224 Parameter Recommendation OPP OPP_NOM Clocking Rate 500 MHz Voltage Level 1V Example PCB 1V Max Current Draw 1A 1A Max Effective Resistance: Power Inductor Segment Total Reff 13 mΩ 11.4mΩ Max Loop Inductance < 2.5 nH 0.73 - 1.58 nH Impedance Target 54 mΩ for F < 20 MHz 28.8 mΩ for F < 20MHz Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Figure 7-15 shows a PCB layout example and the resulting PI analysis results. U1401 LP8733 PMIC Buck0 (3A) FB_VPO_S1_AVS U5000 VDD_DSPEVE_AVS FB_B0 (2) DM50x L1402 Buck 0_SW _ (22,23) VPO_S1_SW 0.47uH, 4A, 2520 DFE252012PD-R47M VDD_DSPEVE VPO_S1_AVS (P12, P11, M9, P9, K8, L8, P8) C5079, 5080, 5085, 5100, 5101, 5111 C1409 R1010 22uF, 6.3V, X7R, 1206 GCM31CR70J226ME23 10mOhm, 1210 INA226& Power Bench 0.1uF, 16V, X7R, 0402 GCM155R71C104KA55 C5021 0.22uF, 25V, X7R, 0603 GCM188R71E224KA55 C5019 0.47uF, 16V, X7R, 0603 GCM188R71C474KA55 C5018 1.0uF, 16V, X7R, 0603 GCM188R71C105KA64 C5037 2.2uF, 6.3V, X5R, 0603 C1005X5R0J225M C5030 4.7uF, 16V, X7R, 0805 GCM21BR71C475KA73 C5026 22uF, 6.3V, X7R, 1206 GCM31CR70J226ME23 SPRS977_PCB_CORE_02 Figure 7-15. vdd_dspeve Simplified SCH Diagram Table 7-8. DCap Scheme Vaule [uF] Size Qty Capacitance [uF] Cap Type: Automotive GCM series, X7R 22 1206 1 22 4.7 805 1 4.7 2.2 603 1 2.2 1 603 1 1 0.47 603 1 0.47 0.22 603 1 0.22 0.1 402 6 0.6 12 31.19 Totals Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 225 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com IR Drop: vdd_dspeve Figure 7-16. vdd_dspeve Voltage/IR Drop [All Layers] Dynamic analysis of this PCB design for the CORE power domain determined the vdd_dspeve decoupling capacitor loop inductance and impedance vs frequency analysis shown below. As you can see, the loop inductance values ranged from 0.68 –1.79nH and were less than maximum 2.0nH recommended. Table 7-9. Decoupling Design Detail Summary Cap Reference Description Loop Inductacne at 50MHz [nH] Footprint Types PCB Side C5101 0.73 2vWEE C5100 0.78 2vWEE C5085 0.84 2vWEE Bottom C5019 1.09 4vWE Top C5111 1.09 4vWE Bottom C5030 1.11 4vWE C5037 1.11 4vWE C5018 1.14 C5021 226 Distance to Ball-Field [mils] Value Size Bottom 82 0.1 0402 Bottom 107 0.1 0402 35 0.1 0402 631 0.47 0603 681 0.1 0402 Top 738 4.7 0805 Top 563 2.2 0603 4vWE Top 681 1 0603 1.17 4vWE Top 761 0.22 0603 C5026 1.18 4vWE Top 792 22 1206 C5079 1.32 4vWE Bottom 542 0.1 0402 C5080 1.58 4vWE Bottom 602 0.1 0402 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 (1) Distances are wrt "middle of Ball Field", Ref pt between: U5000-M9 to middle of Dcap's power pad unless specifed Figure 7-17 shows vdd_dspeve Impedance vs Frequency characteristics. Figure 7-17. vdd_dspeve Impedance vs Frequency 7.4 7.4.1 Single-Ended Interfaces General Routing Guidelines The following paragraphs detail the routing guidelines that must be observed when routing the various functional LVCMOS interfaces. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 227 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 • www.ti.com Line spacing: – For a line width equal to W, the spacing between two lines must be 2W, at least. This minimizes the crosstalk between switching signals between the different lines. On the PCB, this is not achievable everywhere (for example, when breaking signals out from the device package), but it is recommended to follow this rule as much as possible. When violating this guideline, minimize the length of the traces running parallel to each other (see Figure 7-18). W D+ S = 2 W = 200 µm SPRS91v_PCB_SE_GND_01 • • • 7.4.2 Figure 7-18. Ground Guard Illustration Length matching (unless otherwise specified): – For bus or traces at frequencies less than 10 MHz, the trace length matching (maximum length difference between the longest and the shortest lines) must be less than 25 mm. – For bus or traces at frequencies greater than 10 MHz, the trace length matching (maximum length difference between the longest and the shortest lines) must be less than 2.5 mm. Characteristic impedance – Unless otherwise specified, the characteristic impedance for single-ended interfaces is recommended to be between 35-Ω and 65-Ω. Multiple peripheral support – For interfaces where multiple peripherals have to be supported in the star topology, the length of each branch has to be balanced. Before closing the PCB design, it is highly recommended to verify signal integrity based on simulations including actual PCB extraction. QSPI Board Design and Layout Guidelines The following section details the routing guidelines that must be observed when routing the QSPI interfaces. 7.4.2.1 • • • • • 228 If QSPI is operated in Mode 0 (POL=0, PHA=0): The qspi1_sclk output signal must be looped back into the qspi1_rtclk input. The signal propagation delay from the qspi1_sclk ball to the QSPI device CLK input pin (A to C) must be approximately equal to the signal propagation delay from the QSPI device CLK pin to the qspi1_rtclk ball (C to D). The signal propagation delay from the QSPI device CLK pin to the qspi1_rtclk ball (C to D) must be approximately equal to the signal propagation delay of the control and data signals between the QSPI device and the SoC device (E to F, or F to E). The signal propagation delay from the qspi1_sclk signal to the series terminators (R2 = 10 Ω) near the QSPI device must be < 450pS (~7cm as stripline or ~8cm as microstrip) 50 Ω PCB routing is recommended along with series terminations, as shown in Figure 7-19. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Propagation delays and matching: – A to C = C to D = E to F – Matching skew: < 60pS – A to B < 450pS – B to C = as small as possible (<60pS) Locate both R2 resistors close together near the QSPI device A B C R1 R2 0 Ω* 10 Ω R2 10 Ω qspi1_sclk QSPI device clock input D qspi1_rtclk E F QSPI device IOx, CS# qspi1_d[x], qspi1_cs[y] SPRS906_PCB_QSPI_01 Figure 7-19. QSPI Interface High Level Schematic Mode 0 (POL=0, PHA=0) NOTE *0 Ω resistor (R1), located as close as possible to the qspi1_sclk pin, is placeholder for finetuning if needed. 7.4.2.2 • • • • • If QSPI is operated in Mode 3 (POL=1, PHA=1): The qspi1_rtclk input can be left unconnected. The signal propagation delay from the qspi1_sclk signal to the QSPI device CLK pin (A to C) must be approximately equal to the signal propagation delay of the control and data signals between the QSPI device and the SoC device (E to F, or F to E). The signal propagation delay from the qspi1_sclk signal to the QSPI device CLK pin (A to C) must be < 450pS (~7cm as stripline or ~8cm as microstrip). 50 Ω PCB routing is recommended along with series terminations, as shown in Figure 7-20. Propagation delays and matching: – A to C = E to F. – Matching skew: < 60Ps – A to B < 450pS Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 229 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com A C R1 0 Ω* qspi1_sclk QSPI device clock input E F QSPI deice IOx, CS# qspi1_d[x], qspi1_cs[y] SPRS91v_PCB_QSPI_01 Figure 7-20. QSPI Interface High Level Schematic Mode 3 (POL=1, PHA=1) NOTE *0 Ω resistor (R1), located as close as possible to the qspi1_sclk pin, is placeholder for finetuning if needed. 7.5 7.5.1 Differential Interfaces General Routing Guidelines To maximize signal integrity, proper routing techniques for differential signals are important for high-speed designs. The following general routing guidelines describe the routing guidelines for differential lanes and differential signals. • As much as possible, no other high-frequency signals must be routed in close proximity to the differential pair. • Must be routed as differential traces on the same layer. The trace width and spacing must be chosen to yield the differential impedance value recommended. • Minimize external components on differential lanes (like external ESD, probe points). • Through-hole pins are not recommended. • Differential lanes mustn’t cross image planes (ground planes). • No sharp bend on differential lanes. • Number of vias on the differential pairs must be minimized, and identical on each line of the differential pair. In case of multiple differential lanes in the same interface, all lines should have the same number of vias. • Shielded routing is to be promoted as much as possible (for instance, signals must be routed on internal layers that are inside power and/or ground planes). 230 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.5.2 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 CSI2 Board Design and Routing Guidelines The MIPI D-PHY signals include the CSI2 camera serial interfaces to or from the Device. For more information regarding the MIPI-PHY signals and corresponding balls, see Table 4-8, CSI2 Signal Descriptions. For more information, you can also see the MIPI D-PHY specification v1-01-00_r0-03 (specifically the Interconnect and Lane Configuration and Annex B Interconnect Design Guidelines chapters). In the next section, the PCB guidelines of the following differential interfaces are presented: • CSI2_0 MIPI CSI-2 at 1.5 Gbps Table 7-10 lists the MIPI D-PHY interface signals in the Device. Table 7-10. MIPI D-PHY Interface Signals in the Device 7.5.2.1 SIGNAL NAME BALL SIGNAL NAME BALL csi2_0_dx0 A11 csi2_0_dy0 B11 csi2_0_dx1 A12 csi2_0_dy1 B12 csi2_0_dx2 A13 csi2_0_dy2 B13 csi2_0_dx3 A15 csi2_0_dy3 B15 csi2_0_dx4 A16 csi2_0_dy4 B16 CSI2_0 MIPI CSI-2 (1.5 Gbps) 7.5.2.1.1 General Guidelines The general guidelines for the PCB differential lines are: • Differential trace impedance Z0 = 100 Ω (minimum = 85 Ω, maximum = 115 Ω) • Total conductor length from the Device package pins to the peripheral device package pins is 25 to 30 cm with common FR4 PCB and flex materials. NOTE Longer interconnect length can be supported at the expense of detailed simulations of the complete link including driver and receiver models. The general rule of thumb for the space S = 2 × W is not designated (see Figure 7-18, Guard Illustration). It is because although the S = 2 × W rule is a good rule of thumb, it is not always the best solution. The electrical performance will be checked with the frequency-domain specification. Even though the designer does not follow the S = 2 × W rule, the differential lines are ok if the lines satisfy the frequency-domain specification. Because the MIPI signals are used for low-power, single-ended signaling in addition to their high-speed differential implementation, the pairs must be loosely coupled. 7.5.2.1.2 Length Mismatch Guidelines 7.5.2.1.2.1 CSI2_0 MIPI CSI-2 (1.5 Gbps) The guidelines of the length mismatch for CSI-2 are presented in Table 7-11. Table 7-11. Length Mismatch Guidelines for CSI-2 (1.5 Gbps) PARAMETER TYPICAL VALUE UNIT Operating speed 1500 Mbps UI (bit time) 667 ps Intralane skew Have to satisfy mode-conversion S parameters(1) Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 231 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 7-11. Length Mismatch Guidelines for CSI-2 (1.5 Gbps) (continued) PARAMETER TYPICAL VALUE UNIT 13.34 ps Interlane skew (UI / 50) (1) sdc12, scd21, scd12, sdc21, scd11, sdc11, scd22, and sdc22 7.5.2.1.3 Frequency-domain Specification Guidelines After the PCB design is finished, the S-parameters of the PCB differential lines will be extracted with a 3D Maxwell Equation Solver such as the high-frequency structure simulator (HFSS) or equivalent, and compared to the frequency-domain specification as defined in the section 7 of the MIPI Alliance Specification for D-PHY Version v1-01-00_r0-03. If the PCB lines satisfy the frequency-domain specification, the design is finished. Otherwise, the design needs to be improved. 7.6 7.6.1 Clock Routing Guidelines Oscillator Ground Connection Although the impedance of a ground plane is low it is, of course, not zero. Therefore, any noise current in the ground plane causes a voltage drop in the ground. Figure 7-21 shows the grounding scheme for slow (low frequency) clock generated from the internal oscillator. Device rtc_osc_xo rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf1 Cf2 SPRS91v_PCB_CLK_OSC_02 Figure 7-21. Grounding Scheme for Low-Frequency Clock Figure 7-22 shows the grounding scheme for high-frequency clock. 232 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Device xi_oscj xo_oscj vssa_oscj Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf2 Cf1 SPRS91v_PCB_CLK_OSC_03 (1) j in *_osc = 0 or 1 Figure 7-22. Grounding Scheme for High-Frequency Clock 7.7 LPDDR2 Board Design and Layout Guidelines 7.7.1 LPDDR2 Board Designs TI only supports board designs using LPDDR2 memory that follow the guidelines in this document. The switching characteristics and timing diagram for the LPDDR2 memory interface are shown in Table 7-12 and Figure 7-23. Table 7-12. Switching Characteristics for LPDDR2 Memory Interface NO. PARAMETER 1 tc(DDR_CK) Cycle time, ddr1_ck and ddr1_nck MIN MAX 7.52 (1) 3.00 UNIT ns (1) The JEDEC JESD209-2F standard defines the maximum clock period of 100 ns for all standard-speed bin LPDDR2 memory. The device has only been tested per the limits published in this table. 1 ddr1_ck ddr1_nck SPRS917_LPDDR2_01 Figure 7-23. LPDDR2 Memory Interface Clock Timing 7.7.2 LPDDR2 Device Configurations There is signal device configuration supported, supporting either 32b or 16b data widths. Table 7-13 lists all the supported configuration. Table 7-13. Supported LPDDR2 Device Combinations NUMBER OF LPDDR2 DEVICES LPDDR2 DEVICE WIDTH (BITS) MIRRORED? LPDDR2 EMIF WIDTH (BITS) 1 32 / 16 N 32 / 16 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 233 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.7.3 www.ti.com LPDDR2 Interface 7.7.3.1 LPDDR2 Interface Schematic Figure 7-24 shows the schematic connections for 32-bit interface with or without ECC using one x32 LPDDR2 device. 32-Bit LPDDR2 Interface 32-Bit LPDDR2 Device DQ[31:0] ddr1_d[31:0] RDAT ddr1_dqm[3:0] RDAT DM[3:0] ddr1_dqs[3:0] RDAT DQS_t[3:0] ddr1_dqsn[3:0] RDAT DQS_c[3:0] ddr1_ck RCA CK_t ddr1_nck RCA CK_c ddr1_cke0 RCA CKE ddr1_csn0 RCA CS_n ddr1_rasn (ddr1_ca0)(1) RCA CA[0] ddr1_casn (ddr1_ca1)(1) RCA CA[1] ddr1_wen (ddr1_ca2)(1) RCA CA[2] ddr1_a13 (ddr1_ca3)(1) RCA CA[3] ddr1_a10 (ddr1_ca4)(1) RCA CA[4] ddr1_a1 (ddr1_ca5)(1) RCA CA[5] ddr1_a2 (ddr1_ca6)(1) RCA CA[6] ddr1_ba0 (ddr1_ca7)(1) RCA CA[7] ddr1_ba1 (ddr1_ca8)(1) RCA CA[8] ddr1_ba2 (ddr1_ca9)(1) RCA CA[9] ddr1_ecc_d[7:0] ddr1_dqm_ecc ddr1_dqs_ecc ddr1_dqsn_ecc 8 vdds_ddr vdds_ddr ZQ 1K ZQ0/1 Vref(CA) Vref(DQ) 0.1 µF 1K DDR_VREF vdds_ddr 0.1 µF 0.1 µF 1K 1K SPRS917_LPDDR2_02 Figure 7-24. 32-Bit Interface with and without ECC using one x32 LPDDR2 device(1)(3)(4) (1) When LPDDR2 memory are used, these signal function as ddr1_ca[9:0]. For more information, see Table 4-9, EMIF1 Signal Descriptions (2) Rca is 10 Ω resistor and is to be placed near DM50x device. (3) The RDAT is 22 Ω resistor and is to be placed near DM50x device (4) If ECC is required, pins available behind data lane 3 (data would then only use 16bit (lanes 1 and 2)) When not using a part of LPDDR2 interface (using x16 or not using the LPDDR2 interface): • Connect the vdds_ddr supply to 1.8 V • Tie off ddr1_dqsx (x=0,1,2,3) that are unused to vss via 1 kΩ • Tie off ddr1_dqsnx (x=0,1,2,3) that are unused to vdds_ddr via 1 kΩ • All other unused pins can be left as NC. 234 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Note: All the unused DDR ADDR_CTRL lines used for DDR3 operation should be left as NC. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 235 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.7.3.2 www.ti.com Compatible JEDEC LPDDR2 Devices Table 7-14 shows the supported LPDDR2 device configurations which are compatible with this interface. Table 7-14. Compatible JEDEC LPDDR2 Devices (Per Interface) NO. PARAMETER CONDITION 1 JEDEC LPDDR2 device speed grade 2 JEDEC LPDDR2 device bit width 3 JEDEC LPDDR2 device count 7.7.3.3 MIN tc(DDR_CK) and tc(DDR_NCK) MAX UNIT LPDDR2-667 x16 x32 1 1 Bits Devices LPDDR2 PCB Stackup Table 7-15 shows the minimum stackup requirements. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stackup to accommodate other circuitry, enhance signal integrity and electromagnetic interference performance, or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. Table 7-15. Six-Layer PCB Stackup Suggestion LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal Top signal routing 2 Plane Ground 3 Signal Signal routing 4 Plane Split power plane 5 Plane Ground 6 Signal Bottom signal routing PCB stackup specifications for LPDDR2 interface are listed in Table 7-16. Table 7-16. PCB Stackup Specifications NO. PARAMETER MIN 1 PCB routing and plane layers 6 2 Signal routing layers 3 3 Full ground reference layers under LPDDR2 routing region(1) TYP MAX UNIT 1 (1) 4 Full vdds_ddr power reference layers under the LPDDR2 routing region 5 Number of reference plane cuts allowed within LPDDR2 routing region(2) 1 0 6 Number of layers between LPDDR2 routing layer and reference plane(3) 0 7 PCB routing feature size 4 8 PCB trace width, w 4 9 PCB BGA escape via pad size(4) 10 PCB BGA escape via hole size 8 11 Single-ended impedance, Zo(5) 50 75 Ω 12 Impedance control(6)(7) Zo Zo+5 Ω 18 Zo-5 mils mils 20 mils mils (1) Ground reference layers are preferred over power reference layers. Be sure to include bypass caps to accommodate reference layer return current as the trace routes switch routing layers. (2) No traces should cross reference plane cuts within the LPDDR2 routing region. High-speed signal traces crossing reference plane cuts create large return current paths which can lead to excessive crosstalk and EMI radiation. (3) Reference planes are to be directly adjacent to the signal plane to minimize the size of the return current loop. (4) An 18-mil pad assumes Via Channel is the most economical BGA escape. A 20-mil pad may be used if additional layers are available for power routing. An 18-mil pad is required for minimum layer count escape. (5) Zo is the nominal singled-ended impedance selected for the PCB. (6) This parameter specifies the AC characteristic impedance tolerance for each segment of a PCB signal trace relative to the chosen Zo defined by the single-ended impedance parameter. (7) Tighter impedance control is required to ensure flight time skew is minimal. 236 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.7.3.4 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 LPDDR2 Placement Figure 7-25 shows the placement rules for the device as well as the LPDDR2 memory device. Placement restrictions are provided as a guidance to restrict maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. X1 LPDDR2 DATA Y LPDDR2 ADDT_CTRL SPRS917_LPDDR2_04 Figure 7-25. Placement Specifications Table 7-17. Placement Specifications(1) NO. PARAMETER MIN (2)(3) MAX UNIT 1 X1 Offset 900 mils 2 Y Offset 200 mils 3 Clearance from non-LPDDR2 signal to LPDDR2 keepout region(4)(5) 4 w (1) LPDDR2 keepout region to encompass entire LPDDR2 routing area. (2) Measurements from center of device to center of LPDDR2 device. (3) Minimizing X1 and Y improves timing margins. (4) w is defined as the signal trace width. (5) Non-LPDDR2 signals allowed within LPDDR2 keepout region provided they are separated from LPDDR2 routing layers by a ground plane. 7.7.3.5 LPDDR2 Keepout Region The region of the PCB used for LPDDR2 circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The LPDDR2 keepout region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 7-26. This region should encompass all LPDDR2 circuitry and the region size varies with component placement and LPDDR2 routing. NonLPDDR2 signals should not be routed on the same signal layer as LPDDR2 signals within the LPDDR2 keepout region. Non-LPDDR2 signals may be routed in the region provided they are routed on layers separated from LPDDR2 signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground or vdds_ddr power plane in this region. In addition, the vdds_ddr power plane should cover the entire keepout region. LPDDR2 Keepout Region Encompasses Entire LPDDR2 Routing Area LPDDR2 DATA LPDDR2 ADDT_CTRL SPRS917_LPDDR2_05 Figure 7-26. LPDDR2 Keepout Region Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 237 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.7.3.6 www.ti.com LPDDR2 Net Classes Table 7-18. Clock Net Class Definitions for the LPDDR2 Interface CLOCK NET CLASS CK PIN NAMES ddr1_ck and ddr1_nck DQS0 ddr1_dqs0 and ddr1_dqsn0 DQS1 ddr1_dqs1 and ddr1_dqsn1 DQS2 ddr1_dqs2 and ddr1_dqsn2 DQS3 ddr1_dqs3 and ddr1_dqsn3 Table 7-19. Signal Net Class and Associated Clock Net Class for LPDDR2 Interface SIGNAL NET CLASS ASSOCIATED CLOCK NET CLASS ADDR_CTRL CK DQ0 DQS0 ddr1_d[7:0], ddr1_dqm0, ddr1_dqs0, ddr1_dqsn0 DQ1 DQS1 ddr1_d[15:8], ddr1_dqm1, ddr1_dqs1, ddr1_dqsn1 DQ2 DQS2 ddr1_d[23:16], ddr1_dqm2, ddr1_dqs2, ddr1_dqsn2 (1) DQ3 DQS3 ddr1_d[31:24], ddr1_dqm3, ddr1_dqs3, ddr1_dqsn3 (1) BALL NAMES ddr1_ba[2:0], ddr1_csn0, ddr1_cke0, ddr1_rasn, ddr1_casn, ddr1_wen, ddr1_a1, ddr1_a2, dr1_a10, ddr1_a13 (1) (1) (1) DQ data class includes DQS/N pins 7.7.3.7 LPDDR2 Signal Termination On-device termination (ODT) is available for DQ[3:0] signal net classes, but is not specifically required for normal operation. System designers may evaluate the need for additional series termination if required based on signal integrity, EMI and overshoot/undershoot reduction. On board series termination is recommended for all ADDR_CTRL and CK class signals. It is recommended a resistor with value of 10 Ω to be placed close to the DM50x source pin (within 350 mils). On board series termination is recommended for all DQx and DQSx class signals. It is recommended a resistor with value of 22 Ω to be placed close to the DM50x source pin (within 500 mils). 7.7.3.8 LPDDR2 DDR_VREF Routing DDR_VREF is the reference voltage for the input buffers on the LPDDR2 memory. DDR_VREF is intended to be half the LPDDR2 power supply voltage and is typically generated with a voltage divider connected to the VDDS_DDR power supply. It should be routed as a nominal 20-mil wide trace with 0.1µF bypass capacitors near each device connection. Narrowing of DDR_VREF is allowed to accommodate routing congestion. 7.7.4 Routing Specification 7.7.4.1 DQS[x] and DQ[x] Routing Specification DQS[x] lines are point-to-point differential and DQ[x] lines are point-to-point single ended. Figure 7-27 and Figure 7-28 represent the supported topologies. Figure 7-29 and Figure 7-30 show the DQS[x] and DQ[x] routing. Figure 7-31 shows the DQLM for the LPDDR2 interface. 238 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Device DQS[x] IO Buffer DQS[x]+ DQS[x]- DDR3 DQS[x] IO Buffer Routed Differentially SPRS917_LPDDR2_06 x = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 7-27. DQS[x] Topology Device DQ[x] IO Buffer DQ[x] DDR3 DQ[x] IO Buffer SPRS917_LPDDR2_07 x = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 7-28. DQ[x] Topology LPDDR2 DATA RDAT RDAT LPDDR2 ADDT_CTRL Routed Differentially SPRS917_LPDDR2_08 x = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 7-29. DQS[x] Routing LPDDR2 DATA LPDDR2 ADDT_CTRL DQ[x] SPRS917_LPDDR2_09 x = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 7-30. DQ[x] Routing Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 239 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com DQLMXi DQi LPDDR2 interface i = 0, 1, 2, 3 DQLMYi DQLM0 = DQLMX0 + DQLMY0 DQLM1 = DQLMX1 + DQLMY1 DQLM2 = DQLMX2 + DQLMY2 DQLM3 = DQLMX3 + DQLMY3 DQ0 - DQ3 represent data bytes 0 - 3. SPRS917_LPDDR2_10 There are four DQLMs, one for each data byte, in a 32-bit interface and two DQLMs, one for each data byte, in a 16bit interface. Each DQLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the byte. Figure 7-31. DQLM for LPDDR2 Interface Trace routing specifications for the DQ[x] and the DQS[x] are specified in Table 7-20. Table 7-20. DQS[x] and DQ[x] Routing Specification(1)(2) NO. MAX UNIT 1 DQ0 nominal length(3)(4) PARAMETER MIN DQLM0 mils 2 (3)(5) DQ1 nominal length DQLM1 mils 3 DQ2 nominal length (3)(6) DQLM2 mils 4 DQ3 nominal length (3)(7) DQLM3 mils 5 (8) DQ[x] skew 10 ps 6 DQS[x] skew 5 ps 7 Via count per each trace in DQ[x], DQS[x] 2 8 Via count difference across a given DQ[x], DQS[x] 0 (8)(9) TYP 9 DQS[x]-to-DQ[x] skew 10 Center-to-center DQ[x] to other LPDDR2 trace spacing(10)(11) 4 10 ps w 11 Center-to-center DQ[x] to other DQ[x] trace spacing(10)(12) 3 w 4 w (13) 12 DQS[x] center-to-center spacing 13 DQS[x] center-to-center spacing to other net(10) (1) DQS[x] represents the DQS0, DQS1, DQS2, DQS3 clock net classes, and DQ[x] represents the DQ0, DQ1, DQ2, DQ3 signal net classes. (2) External termination disallowed. Data termination should use built-in ODT functionality. (3) DQLMn is the longest Manhattan distance of a byte. (4) DQLM0 is the longest Manhattan length for the DQ0 net class. (5) DQLM1 is the longest Manhattan length for the DQ1 net class. (6) DQLM2 is the longest Manhattan length for the DQ2 net class. (7) DQLM3 is the longest Manhattan length for the DQ3 net class. (8) Length matching is only done within a byte. Length matching across bytes is not required. (9) Each DQS clock net class is length matched to its associated DQ signal net class. (10) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum for up to 1000 mils of routed length. (11) Other LPDDR2 trace spacing means signals that are not part of the same DQ[x] signal net class. (12) This applies to spacing within same DQ[x] signal net class. (13) DQS[x] pair spacing is set to ensure proper differential impedance. Differential impedance should be Zo x 2, where Zo is the singleended impedance. 240 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.7.4.2 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification CK signals are routed as point-to-point differential, and ADDR_CTRL signals are routed as point-to-point single ended. The supported topology for CK and ADDR_CTRL are shown in Figure 7-32 through Figure 7-35. Note that ADDR_CTRL are routed very similar to DQ and CK is routed very similar to DQS. CK+ Device CK Output Buffer LPDDR2 Input Buffer CKRouted Differentially SPRS917_LPDDR2_11 Figure 7-32. CK Signals Topology Device ADDR_CTRL Output Buffer LPDDR2 ADDR_CTRL Input Buffer ADDR_CTRL SPRS917_LPDDR2_12 RDAT Figure 7-33. ADDR_CTRL Signals Topology LPDDR2 DATA LPDDR2 ADDT_CTRL SPRS917_LPDDR2_13 Figure 7-34. CK Signals Routing LPDDR2 DATA LPDDR2 ADDT_CTRL ADDR_CTRL SPRS917_LPDDR2_14 Figure 7-35. ADDR_CTRL Signals Routing Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 241 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com CACLMX LPDDR2 interface CACLM = CACLMX + CACLMY CACLMY SPRS917_LPDDR2_15 CACLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the CK/ADDR_CTRL signal class. Figure 7-36. CACLM for LPDDR2 Interface Trace routing specifications for the CK and the ADD_CTRL are specified in Table 7-21. Table 7-21. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification NO. PARAMETER 1 CK and ADDR_CTRL nominal trace length(1) 2 ADDR_CTRL skew 3 MIN TYP MAX UNIT CACLM mils 20 ps CK skew 5 ps 4 Via count per each trace ADDR_CTRL, CK 2 5 Via count difference across ADDR_CTRL, CK 6 ADDR_CTRL-to-CK skew 0 20 (2)(3) 7 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other LPDDR2 trace spacing 8 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing(2) 9 CK center-to-center spacing(4) 10 CK center-to-center spacing to other net(2) ps 4 w 3 w 4 w (1) CACLM is the longest Manhattan distance of ADDR_CTRL and CK. (2) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum for up to 1000 mils of routed length. (3) Other LPDDR2 trace spacing means signals that are not part of the same CK, ADDR_CTRL signal net class. (4) CK pair spacing is set to ensure proper differential impedance. Differential impedance should be Zo x 2, where Zo is the single ended impedance. 7.8 7.8.1 DDR2 Board Design and Layout Guidelines DDR2 General Board Layout Guidelines To • • • • • • • • • 242 help ensure good signaling performance, consider the following board design guidelines: Avoid crossing splits in the power plane. Minimize Vref noise. Use the widest trace that is practical between decoupling capacitors and memory module. Maintain a single reference. Minimize ISI by keeping impedances matched. Minimize crosstalk by isolating sensitive bits, such as strobes, and avoiding return path discontinuities. Use proper low-pass filtering on the Vref pins. Keep the stub length as short as possible. Add additional spacing for on-clock and strobe nets to eliminate crosstalk. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com • • 7.8.2 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Maintain a common ground reference for all bypass and decoupling capacitors. Take into account the differences in propagation delays between microstrip and stripline nets when evaluating timing constraints. DDR2 Board Design and Layout Guidelines 7.8.2.1 Board Designs TI only supports board designs that follow the guidelines outlined in this document. The switching characteristics and the timing diagram for the DDR2 memory controller are shown in Table 7-22 and Figure 7-37. Table 7-22. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR2 Memory Controller NO. DDR21 PARAMETE R tc(DDR_CLK) DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT Cycle time, DDR_CLK 2.5 8 ns 1 ddrx_ck PCB_DDR2_0 Figure 7-37. DDR2 Memory Controller Clock Timing 7.8.2.2 DDR2 Interface This section provides the timing specification for the DDR2 interface as a PCB design and manufacturing specification. The design rules constrain PCB trace length, PCB trace skew, signal integrity, cross-talk, and signal timing. These rules, when followed, result in a reliable DDR2 memory system without the need for a complex timing closure process. For more information regarding the guidelines for using this DDR2 specification, see the Understanding TI’s PCB Routing Rule-Based DDR Timing Specification Application Report (Literature Number: SPRAAV0). 7.8.2.2.1 DDR2 Interface Schematic Figure 7-38 shows the DDR2 interface schematic for a x32 DDR2 memory system. In Figure 7-39 the x16 DDR2 system schematic is identical except that the high-word DDR2 device is deleted. When not using all or part of a DDR2 interface, the proper method of handling the unused pins is to tie off the ddrx_dqsi pins to ground via a 1k-Ω resistor and to tie off the ddrx_dqsni pins to the corresponding vdds_ddrx supply via a 1k-Ω resistor. This needs to be done for each byte not used. The vdds_ddrx and ddrx_vref0 power supply pins need to be connected to their respective power supplies even if DDRx is not being used. All other DDR interface pins can be left unconnected. Note that the supported modes for use of the DDR EMIF are 32-bits wide, 16-bits wide, or not used. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 243 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com DDR2 ddrx_d0 DQ0 ddrx_d7 ddrx_dqm0 ddrx_dqs0 DQ7 DQM0 DQS0 ddrx_dqsn0 ddrx_d8 DQS0n DQ8 ddrx_d15 ddrx_dqm1 ddrx_dqs1 DQ15 DQM1 DQS1 ddrx_dqsn1 DQS1n ddrx_odt0 ODT ddrx_d16 DQ16 ddrx_d23 ddrx_dqm2 ddrx_dqs2 ddrx_dqsn2 ddrx_d24 DQ23 DQM2 DQS2 DQS2n DQ24 ddrx_d31 ddrx_dqm3 ddrx_dqs3 ddrx_dqsn3 DQ31 DQM3 DQS3 DQS3n ddrx_ba0 BA0 ddrx_ba2 ddrx_a0 BA2 A0 ddrx_a14 ddrx_csn0 A14 CS ddrx_casn ddrx_rasn CAS ddrx_wen ddrx_cke ddrx_ck WE CKE CK CK vdds_ddrx RAS ddrx_nck 0.1 µF VREF 1 K Ω 1% VREF 0.1 µF ddrx_rst (A) 1 K Ω 1% NC PCB_DDR2_1 A. B. vdds_ddrx is the power supply for the DDR2 memories and the Device DDR2 interface. One of these capacitors can be eliminated if the divider and its capacitors are placed near a VREF pin. Figure 7-38. 32-Bit DDR2 High-Level Schematic 244 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DDR2 ddrx_d0 DQ0 ddrx_d7 ddrx_dqm0 ddrx_dqs0 DQ7 LDM LDQS ddrx_dqsn0 ddrx_d8 LDQS DQ8 ddrx_d15 ddrx_dqm1 ddrx_dqs1 ddrx_dqsn1 ddrx_odt0 DQ15 UDM UDQS UDQS ODT ddrx_d16 ddrx_d23 ddrx_dqm2 NC NC NC 1 KΩ vdds_ddrx (A) ddrx_dqsn2 ddrx_dqs2 ddrx_d24 NC 1 KΩ ddrx_d31 ddrx_dqm3 ddrx_dqsn3 ddrx_dqs3 NC NC 1 KΩ vdds_ddrx (A) 1 KΩ ddrx_ba0 NC BA0 ddrx_ba2 ddrx_a0 BA2 A0 ddrx_a14 ddrx_csn0 A14 CS ddrx_casn ddrx_rasn CAS vdds_ddrx RAS WE CKE CK CK ddrx_wen ddrx_cke ddrx_ck ddrx_nck 0.1 µF VREF 1 K Ω 1% VREF 0.1 µF ddrx_rst (A) 1 K Ω 1% NC PCB_DDR2_2 A. B. vdds_ddrx is the power supply for the DDR2 memories and the Device DDR2 interface. One of these capacitors can be eliminated if the divider and its capacitors are placed near a VREF pin. Figure 7-39. 16-Bit DDR2 High-Level Schematic Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 245 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 7.8.2.2.2 Compatible JEDEC DDR2 Devices Table 7-23 shows the parameters of the JEDEC DDR2 devices that are compatible with this interface. Generally, the DDR2 interface is compatible with x16/x32 DDR2-800 speed grade DDR2 devices. Table 7-23. Compatible JEDEC DDR2 Devices (Per Interface) NO. PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT CJ21 JEDEC DDR2 device speed grade(1) CJ22 JEDEC DDR2 device bit width x16 x32 Bits CJ23 JEDEC DDR2 device count(2) 1 1 Devices DDR2-800 (1) Higher DDR2 speed grades are supported due to inherent JEDEC DDR2 backwards compatibility. (2) One DDR2 device is used for a 16-bit DDR2 and 32-bit DDR2 memory system. 7.8.2.2.3 PCB Stackup The minimum stackup required for routing the Device is a six-layer stackup as shown in Table 7-24. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stackup to accommodate other circuitry or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. Table 7-24. Minimum PCB Stackup 246 LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal External Routing 2 Plane Ground 3 Plane Power 4 Signal Internal routing 5 Plane Ground 6 Signal External Routing Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Complete stackup specifications are provided in Table 7-25. Table 7-25. PCB Stackup Specifications NO. PARAMETER MIN PS21 PCB routing/plane layers 6 PS22 Signal routing layers 3 PS23 Full ground reference layers under DDR2 routing region(1) 1 PS24 Full vdds_ddrx power reference layers under the DDR2 routing region(1) 1 PS25 Number of reference plane cuts allowed within DDR routing region(2) TYP PS26 Number of layers between DDR2 routing layer and reference plane PS27 PCB routing feature size 4 PS28 PCB trace width, w 4 PS29 Single-ended impedance, Zo PS210 0 50 Impedance control UNIT 0 (3) (4) MAX Z-5 Z Mils Mils 75 Ω Z+5 Ω (1) Ground reference layers are preferred over power reference layers. Be sure to include bypass caps to accommodate reference layer return current as the trace routes switch routing layers. A full ground reference layer should be placed adjacent to each DDR routing layer in PCB stack up. (2) No traces should cross reference plane cuts within the DDR routing region. High-speed signal traces crossing reference plane cuts create large return current paths which can lead to excessive crosstalk and EMI radiation. (3) Reference planes are to be directly adjacent to the signal plane to minimize the size of the return current loop. (4) Z is the nominal singled-ended impedance selected for the PCB specified by PS29. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 247 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 7.8.2.2.4 Placement Figure 7-40 shows the required placement for the Device as well as the DDR2 devices. The dimensions for this figure are defined in Table 7-26. The placement does not restrict the side of the PCB on which the devices are mounted. The ultimate purpose of the placement is to limit the maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. For a 16-bit DDR memory system, the high-word DDR2 device is omitted from the placement. X1 DDR2 Memory A1 DDR2 Controller Y1 PCB_DDR2_3 Figure 7-40. Device and DDR2 Device Placement Table 7-26. Placement Specifications DDR2 NO. PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT KOD21 X1 1100 Mils KOD22 Y1 500 Mils KOD24 DDR2 keepout region (1) KOD25 Clearance from non-DDR2 signal to DDR2 keepout region (2) (3) 4 W (1) DDR2 keepout region to encompass entire DDR2 routing area. (2) Non-DDR2 signals allowed within DDR2 keepout region provided they are separated from DDR2 routing layers by a ground plane. (3) If a device has more than one DDR controller, the signals from the other controller(s) are considered non-DDR2 and should be separated by this specification. 248 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.8.2.2.5 DDR2 Keepout Region The region of the PCB used for the DDR2 circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The DDR2 keepout region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 7-41. The size of this region varies with the placement and DDR routing. Additional clearances required for the keepout region are shown in Table 7-26. The region shown in Table 7-26 should encompass all the DDR2 circuitry and varies depending on placement. Non-DDR2 signals should not be routed on the DDR signal layers within the DDR2 keepout region. Non-DDR2 signals may be routed in the region, provided they are routed on layers separated from DDR2 signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground layers in this region. In addition, the vdds_ddrx power plane should cover the entire keepout region. Routes for the two DDR interfaces must be separated by at least 4x; the more separation, the better. DDR2 Controller DDR2 Device DDR2 Controller A1 Device PCB_DDR2_4 Figure 7-41. DDR2 Keepout Region 7.8.2.2.6 Bulk Bypass Capacitors Bulk bypass capacitors are required for moderate speed bypassing of the DDR2 and other circuitry. Table 7-27 contains the minimum numbers and capacitance required for the bulk bypass capacitors. Note that this table only covers the bypass needs of the DDR2 interfaces and DDR2 device. Additional bulk bypass capacitance may be needed for other circuitry. Table 7-27. Bulk Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER BC21 vdds_ddrx bulk bypass capacitor (≥1µF) count BC22 vdds_ddrx bulk bypass total capacitance MIN (1) TYP MAX UNIT 10 Devices 50 μF (1) These devices should be placed near the devices they are bypassing, but preference should be given to the placement of the highspeed (HS) bypass capacitors and DDR2 signal routing. 7.8.2.2.7 High-Speed Bypass Capacitors TI recommends that a PDN/power integrity analysis is performed to ensure that capacitor selection and placement is optimal for a given implementation. This section provides guidelines that can serve as a good starting point. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 249 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com High-speed (HS) bypass capacitors are critical for proper DDR2 interface operation. It is particularly important to minimize the parasitic series inductance of the HS bypass capacitors, processor/DDR power, and processor/DDR ground connections. Table 7-28 contains the specification for the HS bypass capacitors as well as for the power connections on the PCB. Generally speaking, it is good to: 1. Fit as many HS bypass capacitors as possible. 2. HS bypass capacitor value is < 1µF 3. Minimize the distance from the bypass cap to the pins/balls being bypassed. 4. Use the smallest physical sized capacitors possible with the highest capacitance readily available. 5. Connect the bypass capacitor pads to their vias using the widest traces possible and using the largest hole size via possible. 6. Minimize via sharing. Note the limites on via sharing shown in Table 7-28. Table 7-28. High-Speed Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN HS21 HS bypass capacitor package size(1) HS22 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to processor being bypassed(2)(3)(4) Processor HS bypass capacitor count HS24 Processor HS bypass capacitor total capacitance per vdds_ddrx rail HS25 Number of connection vias for each device power/ground ball per vdds_ddrx rail (5) HS26 Trace length from device power/ground ball to connection via(2) MAX UNIT 0402 10 Mils 400(12) (12) HS23 TYP 0201 12 (11) 3.4 (12) Vias 35 HS27 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to DDR device being bypassed HS28 Number of connection vias for each HS capacitor(8)(9) 4 HS29 DDR2 device HS bypass capacitor count(7) 12 HS210 DDR2 device HS bypass capacitor total capacitance HS211 Trace length from bypass capacitor connect to connection via(2)(9) HS212 Number of connection vias for each DDR2 device power/ground ball(10) HS213 Trace length from DDR2 device power/ground ball to connection via(2)(8) μF 1 (6) (7) Mils Devices 70 Mils 150 Mils (14) Vias (13) Devices 0.85 μF 35 100 1 Mils Vias 35 60 Mils (1) LxW, 10-mil units, that is, a 0402 is a 40x20-mil surface-mount capacitor. (2) Closer/shorter is better. (3) Measured from the nearest processor power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (4) Three of these capacitors should be located underneath the processor, between the cluster of vdds_ddrx balls and ground balls, between the DDR interfaces on the package. (5) See the Via Channel™ escape for the processor package. (6) Measured from the DDR2 device power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (7) Per DDR2 device. (8) An additional HS bypass capacitor can share the connection vias only if it is mounted on the opposite side of the board. No sharing of vias is permitted on the same side of the board. (9) An HS bypass capacitor may share a via with a DDR device mounted on the same side of the PCB. A wide trace should be used for the connection and the length from the capacitor pad to the DDR device pad should be less than 150 mils. (10) Up to a total of two pairs of DDR power/ground balls may share a via. (11) The capacitor recommendations in this data manual reflect only the needs of this processor. Please see the memory vendor’s guidelines for determining the appropriate decoupling capacitor arrangement for the memory device itself. (12) For more information, see Section 7.3, Core Power Domains (13) For more information refer to DDR2 specification. (14) Preferred configuration is 4 vias: 2 to power and 2 to ground. 250 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.8.2.2.8 Net Classes Table 7-29 lists the clock net classes for the DDR2 interface. Table 7-30 lists the signal net classes, and associated clock net classes, for the signals in the DDR2 interface. These net classes are used for the termination and routing rules that follow. Table 7-29. Clock Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS CK PIN NAMES ddrx_ck / ddrx_nck DQS0 ddrx_dqs0 / ddrx_dqsn0 DQS1 ddrx_dqs1 / ddrx_dqsn1 (1) ddrx_dqs2 / ddrx_dqsn2 DQS3(1) ddrx_dqs3 / ddrx_dqsn3 DQS2 (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR2 memory systems. Table 7-30. Signal Net Class Definitions SIGNAL NET CLASS ASSOCIATED CLOCK NET CLASS ADDR_CTRL CK DQ0 DQS0 ddrx_d[7:0], ddrx_dqm0 DQ1 DQS1 ddrx_d[15:8], ddrx_dqm1 DQ2(1) DQS2 ddrx_d[23:16], ddrx_dqm2 DQ3(1) DQS3 ddrx_d[31:24], ddrx_dqm3 PIN NAMES ddrx_ba[2:0], ddrx_a[14:0], ddrx_csnj, ddrx_casn, ddrx_rasn, ddrx_wen, ddrx_cke, ddrx_odti (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR2 memory systems. 7.8.2.2.9 DDR2 Signal Termination Signal terminators are NOT required in CK, ADDR_CTRL, and DATA net classes. Serial terminators may be used to reduce EMI risk; however, serial terminations are the only type permitted. ODTs are integrated on the data byte net classes. They should be enabled to ensure signal integrity. Table 7-31 shows the specifications for the series terminators. Table 7-31. DDR2 Signal Terminations MAX UNIT ST21 NO. CK net class(1)(2) 0 10 Ω ST22 ADDR_CTRL net class(1) (2)(3)(4) 0 Zo Ω 0 Zo Ω ST23 PARAMETER Data byte net classes (DQS0-DQS3, DQ0-DQ3) MIN (5) TYP (1) Only series termination is permitted, parallel or SST specifically disallowed on board. (2) Only required for EMI reduction. (3) Terminator values larger than typical only recommended to address EMI issues. (4) Termination value should be uniform across net class. (5) No external terminations allowed for data byte net classes ODT is to be used. 7.8.2.2.10 VREF Routing VREF (ddrx_vref0) is used as a reference by the input buffers of the DDR2 memories. VREF is intended to be half the DDR2 power supply voltage and should be created using a resistive divider as shown in Figure 7-39. Other methods of creating VREF are not recommended. Figure 7-42 shows the layout guidelines for VREF. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 251 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 VREF Bypass Capacitor 0.1 µF VREF Nominal Max Trace width is 20 mils (A) DDR2 Device vdds_ddrx www.ti.com 1 K Ω 1% VREF 0.1 µF DDR2 Controller 1 K Ω 1% Neck down to minimum in BGA escape regions is acceptable. Narrowing to accomodate via congestion for short distances is also acceptable. Best performance is obtained if the width of VREF is maximized. A. vdds_ddrx is the power supply for the DDR2 memories and the Device DDR2 interface. PCB_DDR2_5 Figure 7-42. VREF Routing and Topology 7.8.2.3 DDR2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing DDR2 Device Figure 7-43 shows the topology of the routing for the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. The route is a point to point connection with required skew matching. DDR2 Controller A’ PCB_DDR2_6 Figure 7-43. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing and Topology Table 7-32. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification NO. 252 PARAMETER RSC21 Center-to-center ddrx_ck - ddrx_nck spacing RSC22 ddrx_ck / ddrx_nck skew MIN MAX UNIT 2w 5 ps CK/ADDR_CTRL trace length(3) 680 ps RSC27 ADDR_CTRL-to-CK skew mismatch 25 ps RSC28 ADDR_CTRL-to-ADDR_CTRL skew mismatch 25 ps RSC29 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other DDR2 trace spacing(2) (2) RSC25 Center-to-center CK to other DDR2 trace spacing RSC26 Applications, Implementation, and Layout 4w 4w Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 7-32. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification (continued) NO. RSC210 PARAMETER MIN Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing(2) MAX UNIT 3w (1) Series terminator, if used, should be located closest to the Device. (2) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum 2w for up to 500 mils of routed length to accommodate BGA escape and routing congestion. (3) This is the longest routing length of the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. Figure 7-44 shows the topology and routing for the DQS and DQ net classes; the routes are point to point. Skew matching across bytes is not needed nor recommended. The termination resistor should be placed near the processor. DDR2 Device E0 E1 E2 DDR2 Controller E3 PCB_DDR2_7 Figure 7-44. DQS and DQ Routing and Topology Table 7-33. DQS and DQ Routing Specification NO. PARAMETER MAX UNIT 5 ps DQS/DQ trace length (2)(3)(4) 325 ps RSDQ25 DQ-to-DQS skew mismatch(2)(3)(4) 10 ps RSDQ26 DQ-to-DQ skew mismatch(2)(3)(4) 10 ps 1 Vias 25 ps RSDQ21 Center-to-center DQS-DQSn spacing in E0|E1|E2|E3 RSDQ22 DQS-DQSn skew in E0|E1|E2|E3 RSDQ23 Center-to-center DQS to other DDR2 trace spacing(1) RSDQ24 MIN 2w 4w (2)(3)(4) RSDQ27 DQ-to-DQ/DQS via count mismatch RSDQ28 Center-to-center DQ to other DDR2 trace spacing(1)(5) 4w RSDQ29 Center-to-center DQ to other DQ trace spacing(1)(6)(7) 3w RSDQ210 DQ/DQS E skew mismatch (2)(3)(4) (1) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum 2w for up to 500 mils of routed length to accommodate BGA escape and routing congestion. (2) A 16-bit DDR memory system has two sets of data net classes; one for data byte 0, and one for data byte 1, each with an associated DQS (2 DQSs) per DDR EMIF used. (3) A 32-bit DDR memory system has four sets of data net classes; one each for data bytes 0 through 3, and each associated with a DQS (4 DQSs) per DDR EMIF used. (4) There is no need, and it is not recommended, to skew match across data bytes; that is, from DQS0 and data byte 0 to DQS1 and data byte1. (5) DQs from other DQS domains are considered other DDR2 trace. (6) DQs from other data bytes are considered other DDR2 trace. (7) This is the longest routing distance of each of the DQS and DQ net classes. 7.9 DDR3 Board Design and Layout Guidelines Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 253 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.9.1 www.ti.com DDR3 General Board Layout Guidelines To • • • • • • • • • 7.9.2 help ensure good signaling performance, consider the following board design guidelines: Avoid crossing splits in the power plane. Use the widest trace that is practical between decoupling capacitors and memory module. Maintain a single reference Minimize ISI by keeping impedances matched. Minimize crosstalk by isolating sensitive bits, such as strobes, and avoiding return path discontinuities. Keep the stub length as short as possible. Add additional spacing for on-clock and strobe nets to eliminate crosstalk. Maintain a common ground reference for all bypass and decoupling capacitors. Take into account the differences in propagation delays between microstrip and stripline nets when evaluating timing constraints. DDR3 Board Design and Layout Guidelines 7.9.2.1 Board Designs TI only supports board designs using DDR3 memory that follow the guidelines in this document. The switching characteristics and timing diagram for the DDR3 memory controller are shown in Table 7-34 and Figure 7-45. Table 7-34. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR3 Memory Controller NO. 1 PARAMETER tc(DDR_CLK) MIN Cycle time, DDR_CLK 1.875 MAX UNIT (1) 2.5 ns (1) This is the absolute maximum the clock period can be. Actual maximum clock period may be limited by DDR3 speed grade and operating frequency (see the DDR3 memory device data sheet). 1 DDR_CLK SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_01 Figure 7-45. DDR3 Memory Controller Clock Timing 7.9.2.2 DDR3 Device Combinations There are several possible combinations of device counts and single- or dual-side mounting, Table 7-35 summarizes the supported device configurations. Table 7-35. Supported DDR3 Device Combinations 254 NUMBER OF DDR3 DEVICES DDR3 DEVICE WIDTH (BITS) ECC DEVICE WIDTH (BITS) MIRRORED? DDR3 EMIF WIDTH (BITS) 1 1x16 2 2x8 - N 16 - Y(1) 2 16 2x16 - N 32 2 2x16 - Y(1) 32 2 1x16 1x8 N 16 3 2x8 1x8 N 16 3 2x16 1x8 N 32 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 (1) Two DDR3 devices are mirrored when one device is placed on the top of the board and the second device is placed on the bottom of the board. 7.9.2.3 DDR3 Interface Schematic 7.9.2.3.1 32-Bit DDR3 Interface The DDR3 interface schematic varies, depending upon the width of the DDR3 devices used and the width of the bus used (16 or 32 bits). General connectivity is straightforward and very similar. 16-bit DDR devices look like two 8-bit devices. Figure 7-46 and show the schematic connections for 32-bit interfaces using x16 devices. 7.9.2.3.2 16-Bit DDR3 Interface Note that the 16-bit wide interface schematic is practically identical to the 32-bit interface (see Figure 746); only the high-word DDR memories are removed and the unused DQS inputs are tied off. When not using all or part of a DDR interface, the proper method of handling the unused pins is to tie off the ddrx_dqsi pins to ground via a 1k-Ω resistor and to tie off the ddrx_dqsni pins to the corresponding vdds_ddrx supply via a 1k-Ω resistor. This needs to be done for each byte not used. Although these signals have internal pullups and pulldowns, external pullups and pulldowns provide additional protection against external electrical noise causing activity on the signals. The vdds_ddr and vdds18v_ddrx power supply pins need to be connected to their respective power supplies even if upper data byte lanes are not being used. All other DDR interface pins can be left unconnected. Note that the supported modes for use of the DDR EMIF are 32-bits wide, 16-bits wide, or not used. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 255 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 32-bit DDR3 EMIF 16-Bit DDR3 Devices ddrx_d31 DQ15 8 ddrx_d24 DQ8 ddrx_dqm3 ddrx_dqs3 ddrx_dqsn3 UDM UDQS UDQS ddrx_d23 DQ7 8 ddrx_d16 D08 ddrx_dqm2 ddrx_dqs2 ddrx_dqsn2 LDM LDQS LDQS ddrx_d15 DQ15 8 ddrx_d8 DQ8 ddrx_dqm1 ddrx_dqs1 ddrx_dqsn1 UDM UDQS UDQS ddrx_d7 DQ7 8 ddrx_d0 DQ0 ddrx_dqm0 ddrx_dqs0 ddrx_dqsn0 LDM LDQS LDQS ddrx_ck ddrx_nck ddrx_odt0 ddrx_csn0 ddrx_ba0 ddrx_ba1 ddrx_ba2 ddrx_a0 Zo CK CK CK CK ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 A0 Zo A15 A15 Zo CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA CAS RAS WE CKE RST 0.1 µF DDR_1V5 Zo DDR_VTT 16 ddrx_a15 ddrx_casn ddrx_rasn ddrx_wen ddrx_cke ddrx_rst ZQ 0.1 µF DDR_VREF ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA ZQ 0.1 µF Zo Termination is required. See terminator comments. ZQ Value determined according to the DDR memory device data sheet. Figure 7-46. 32-Bit, One-Bank DDR3 Interface Schematic Using Two 16-Bit DDR3 Devices 256 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com 7.9.2.4 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Compatible JEDEC DDR3 Devices Table 7-36 shows the parameters of the JEDEC DDR3 devices that are compatible with this interface. Generally, the DDR3 interface is compatible with DDR3-1066 devices in the x8 or x16 widths. Table 7-36. Compatible JEDEC DDR3 Devices N O. 1 PARAMETER CONDITION JEDEC DDR3 device speed grade(1) MIN MAX DDR clock rate = 400MHz DDR3-800 DDR3-1600 400MHz< DDR clock rate ≤ 533MHz DDR3-1066 DDR3-1600 UNIT 2 JEDEC DDR3 device bit width x8 x16 Bits 3 JEDEC DDR3 device count(2) 1 3 Devices (1) Refer to Table 7-34 Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR3 Memory Controller for the range of supported DDR clock rates. (2) For valid DDR3 device configurations and device counts, see Table 7-35 DDR3 Device Combinations. 7.9.2.5 PCB Stackup The minimum stackup for routing the DDR3 interface is a six-layer stack up as shown in Table 7-37. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stackup to accommodate other circuitry, enhance SI/EMI performance, or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. Complete stackup specifications are provided in Table 7-38. Table 7-37. Six-Layer PCB Stackup Suggestion LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal Top routing mostly vertical 2 Plane Ground 3 Plane Split power plane 4 Plane Split power plane or Internal routing 5 Plane Ground 6 Signal Bottom routing mostly horizontal Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 257 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 7-38. PCB Stackup Specifications NO. PARAMETER MIN PS1 PCB routing/plane layers 6 PS2 Signal routing layers 3 PS3 Full ground reference layers under DDR3 routing region(1) TYP MAX 1 (1) PS4 Full 1.5-V power reference layers under the DDR3 routing region PS5 Number of reference plane cuts allowed within DDR routing region(2) 0 PS6 Number of layers between DDR3 routing layer and reference plane(3) 0 PS7 PCB routing feature size 4 PS8 PCB trace width, w 4 PS9 Single-ended impedance, Zo PS10 UNIT 1 50 (5) Impedance control Z-5 Z Mils Mils 75 Ω Z+5 Ω (1) Ground reference layers are preferred over power reference layers. Be sure to include bypass caps to accommodate reference layer return current as the trace routes switch routing layers. (2) No traces should cross reference plane cuts within the DDR routing region. High-speed signal traces crossing reference plane cuts create large return current paths which can lead to excessive crosstalk and EMI radiation. (3) Reference planes are to be directly adjacent to the signal plane to minimize the size of the return current loop. (4) An 18-mil pad assumes Via Channel is the most economical BGA escape. A 20-mil pad may be used if additional layers are available for power routing. An 18-mil pad is required for minimum layer count escape. (5) Z is the nominal singled-ended impedance selected for the PCB specified by PS9. 7.9.2.6 Placement Figure 7-47 shows the required placement for the processor as well as the DDR3 devices. The dimensions for this figure are defined in Table 7-39. The placement does not restrict the side of the PCB on which the devices are mounted. The ultimate purpose of the placement is to limit the maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. For a 16-bit DDR memory system, the high-word DDR3 devices are omitted from the placement. x1 y2 DDR3 Controller y2 Three Devices SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_04 Figure 7-47. Placement Specifications 258 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 7-39. Placement Specifications MAX UNIT KOD31 No. X1 PARAMETER MIN 1700 Mils KOD34 Y1 1800 Mils KOD35 Y2 600 Mils KOD36 DDR3 keepout region(1) KOD37 Clearance from nonDDR3 signal to DDR3 keepout region (2)(3) 4 W (1) DDR3 keepout region to encompass entire DDR3 routing area. (2) Non-DDR3 signals allowed within DDR3 keepout region provided they are separated from DDR3 routing layers by a ground plane. (3) If a device has more than one DDR controller, the signals from the other controller(s) are considered non-DDR3 and should be separated by this specification. 7.9.2.7 DDR3 Keepout Region The region of the PCB used for DDR3 circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The DDR3 keepout region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 7-48. The size of this region varies with the placement and DDR routing. Additional clearances required for the keepout region are shown in Table 739. Non-DDR3 signals should not be routed on the DDR signal layers within the DDR3 keepout region. Non-DDR3 signals may be routed in the region, provided they are routed on layers separated from the DDR signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground layers in this region. In addition, the 1.5-V DDR3 power plane should cover the entire keepout region. Also note that the two signals from the DDR3 controller should be separated from each other by the specification in Table 739 (see KOD37). Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 259 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com DDR3 Keepout Region DDR3 Controller Three Devices SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_05 Figure 7-48. DDR3 Keepout Region 7.9.2.8 Bulk Bypass Capacitors Bulk bypass capacitors are required for moderate speed bypassing of the DDR3 and other circuitry. Table 7-40 contains the minimum numbers and capacitance required for the bulk bypass capacitors. Note that this table only covers the bypass needs of the DDR3 controllers and DDR3 devices. Additional bulk bypass capacitance may be needed for other circuitry. 260 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 7-40. Bulk Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT 1 vdds_ddrx bulk bypass capacitor count(1) 1 Devices 2 vdds_ddrx bulk bypass total capacitance 22 μF (1) These devices should be placed near the devices they are bypassing, but preference should be given to the placement of the highspeed (HS) bypass capacitors and DDR3 signal routing. 7.9.2.9 High-Speed Bypass Capacitors High-speed (HS) bypass capacitors are critcal for proper DDR3 interface operation. It is particularly important to minimize the parasitic series inductance of the HS bypass capacitors, processor/DDR power, and processor/DDR ground connections. Table 7-41 contains the specification for the HS bypass capacitors as well as for the power connections on the PCB. Generally speaking, it is good to: 1. Fit as many HS bypass capacitors as possible. 2. Minimize the distance from the bypass cap to the pins/balls being bypassed. 3. Use the smallest physical sized capacitors possible with the highest capacitance readily available. 4. Connect the bypass capacitor pads to their vias using the widest traces possible and using the largest hole size via possible. 5. Minimize via sharing. Note the limites on via sharing shown in Table 7-41. Table 7-41. High-Speed Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN 1 HS bypass capacitor package size(1) 2 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to processor being bypassed(2)(3)(4) 3 Processor HS bypass capacitor count per vdds_ddrx rail(12) 4 Processor HS bypass capacitor total capacitance per vdds_ddrx rail(12) TYP MAX UNIT 0201 0402 10 Mils 400 See Table 7-3 and (11) Mils Devices See Table 7-3 and (11) μF (5) 5 Number of connection vias for each device power/ground ball 6 Trace length from device power/ground ball to connection via(2) 7 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to DDR device being bypassed 8 DDR3 device HS bypass capacitor count(7) 9 DDR3 device HS bypass capacitor total capacitance(7) Vias 35 (6) (8)(9) 10 Number of connection vias for each HS capacitor 11 Trace length from bypass capacitor connect to connection via(2)(9) 12 Number of connection vias for each DDR3 device power/ground ball(10) 13 Trace length from DDR3 device power/ground ball to connection via(2)(8) 70 Mils 150 Mils 12 Devices 0.85 μF 2 Vias 35 100 1 Mils Vias 35 60 Mils (1) LxW, 10-mil units, that is, a 0402 is a 40x20-mil surface-mount capacitor. (2) Closer/shorter is better. (3) Measured from the nearest processor power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (4) Three of these capacitors should be located underneath the processor, between the cluster of DDR_1V5 balls and ground balls, between the DDR interfaces on the package. (5) See the Via Channel™ escape for the processor package. (6) Measured from the DDR3 device power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (7) Per DDR3 device. (8) An additional HS bypass capacitor can share the connection vias only if it is mounted on the opposite side of the board. No sharing of vias is permitted on the same side of the board. (9) An HS bypass capacitor may share a via with a DDR device mounted on the same side of the PCB. A wide trace should be used for the connection and the length from the capacitor pad to the DDR device pad should be less than 150 mils. (10) Up to a total of two pairs of DDR power/ground balls may share a via. (11) The capacitor recommendations in this data manual reflect only the needs of this processor. Please see the memory vendor’s guidelines for determining the appropriate decoupling capacitor arrangement for the memory device itself. (12) For more information, see Section 7.3, Core Power Domains. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 261 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 7.9.2.9.1 Return Current Bypass Capacitors Use additional bypass capacitors if the return current reference plane changes due to DDR3 signals hopping from one signal layer to another. The bypass capacitor here provides a path for the return current to hop planes along with the signal. As many of these return current bypass capacitors should be used as possible. These are returns for signal current, the signal via size may be used for these capacitors. 7.9.2.10 Net Classes Table 7-42 lists the clock net classes for the DDR3 interface. Table 7-43 lists the signal net classes, and associated clock net classes, for signals in the DDR3 interface. These net classes are used for the termination and routing rules that follow. Table 7-42. Clock Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS CK processor PIN NAMES ddrx_ck/ddrx_nck DQS0 ddrx_dqs0 / ddrx_dqsn0 DQS1 ddrx_dqs1 / ddrx_dqsn1 (1) ddrx_dqs2 / ddrx_dqsn2 DQS3(1) ddrx_dqs3 / ddrx_dqsn3 DQS2 (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR3 memory systems. Table 7-43. Signal Net Class Definitions SIGNAL NET CLASS ASSOCIATED CLOCK NET CLASS ADDR_CTRL CK DQ0 DQS0 ddrx_d[7:0], ddrx_dqm0 DQ1 DQS1 ddrx_d[15:8], ddrx_dqm1 DQ2(1) DQS2 ddrx_d[23:16], ddrx_dqm2 DQ3(1) DQS3 ddrx_d[31:24], ddrx_dqm3 processor PIN NAMES ddrx_ba[2:0], ddrx_a[15:0], ddrx_csnj, ddrx_casn, ddrx_rasn, ddrx_wen, ddrx_cke, ddrx_odti (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR3 memory systems. 7.9.2.11 DDR3 Signal Termination Signal terminators are required for the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. The data lines are terminated by ODT and, thus, the PCB traces should be unterminated. Detailed termination specifications are covered in the routing rules in the following sections. 7.9.2.12 VTT Like VREF, the nominal value of the VTT supply is half the DDR3 supply voltage. Unlike VREF, VTT is expected to source and sink current, specifically the termination current for the ADDR_CTRL net class Thevinen terminators. VTT is needed at the end of the address bus and it should be routed as a power sub-plane. VTT should be bypassed near the terminator resistors. 7.9.2.13 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies and Routing Definition The CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes are routed similarly and are length matched to minimize skew between them. CK is a bit more complicated because it runs at a higher transition rate and is differential. The following subsections show the topology and routing for various DDR3 configurations for CK and ADDR_CTRL. The figures in the following subsections define the terms for the routing specification detailed in Table 7-44. 262 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.9.2.13.1 Three DDR3 Devices Three DDR3 devices are supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of two x16 DDR3 devices and one device for ECC, arranged as one bank (CS). These three devices may be mounted on a single side of the PCB, or may be mirrored in two pairs to save board space at a cost of increased routing complexity and parts on the backside of the PCB. 7.9.2.13.1.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, Three DDR3 Devices Figure 7-49 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 7-50 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. + – + – + – AS+ AS- AS+ AS- AS+ AS- DDR Differential CK Input Buffers Clock Parallel Terminator DDR_1V5 Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 A3 A4 AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 A3 A4 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_06 Figure 7-49. CK Topology for Three DDR3 Devices Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A2 A3 AS AS AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers A4 Address and Control Terminator Rtt Vtt AT SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_07 Figure 7-50. ADDR_CTRL Topology for Three DDR3 Devices 7.9.2.13.1.2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing, Three DDR3 Devices Figure 7-51 shows the CK routing for three DDR3 devices placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 752 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 263 DM505 www.ti.com A1 A1 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DDR_1V5 A3 A3 = A4 A4 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_08 A1 Figure 7-51. CK Routing for Three Single-Side DDR3 Devices Rtt A3 = A4 AT Vtt AS A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_09 Figure 7-52. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Three Single-Side DDR3 Devices To save PCB space, the two DDR3 memories may be mounted as one mirrored pair at a cost of increased routing and assembly complexity. Figure 7-53 and Figure 7-54 show the routing for CK and ADDR_CTRL, respectively, for two DDR3 devices mirrored in a pair configuration. 264 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 A1 A1 www.ti.com DDR_1V5 A3 A3 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_10 A1 Figure 7-53. CK Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices Rtt = AT Vtt AS A3 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_11 Figure 7-54. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices 7.9.2.13.2 Two DDR3 Devices Two DDR3 devices are supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of two x8 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS), 16 bits wide, or two x16 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS), 32 bits wide. These two devices may be mounted on a single side of the PCB, or may be mirrored in a pair to save board space at a cost of increased routing complexity and parts on the backside of the PCB. 7.9.2.13.2.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, Two DDR3 Devices Figure 7-55 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 7-56 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 265 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com + – + – AS+ AS- AS+ AS- DDR Differential CK Input Buffers Clock Parallel Terminator DDR_1V5 Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 A3 AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 A3 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_12 Figure 7-55. CK Topology for Two DDR3 Devices Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A2 AS AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers A3 Address and Control Terminator Rtt Vtt AT SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_13 Figure 7-56. ADDR_CTRL Topology for Two DDR3 Devices 7.9.2.13.2.2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing, Two DDR3 Devices Figure 7-57 shows the CK routing for two DDR3 devices placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 7-58 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. 266 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 A1 A1 www.ti.com DDR_1V5 A3 A3 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_14 A1 Figure 7-57. CK Routing for Two Single-Side DDR3 Devices Rtt A3 = AT Vtt AS A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_15 Figure 7-58. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Single-Side DDR3 Devices To save PCB space, the two DDR3 memories may be mounted as a mirrored pair at a cost of increased routing and assembly complexity. Figure 7-59 and Figure 7-60 show the routing for CK and ADDR_CTRL, respectively, for two DDR3 devices mirrored in a single-pair configuration. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 267 DM505 www.ti.com A1 A1 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DDR_1V5 A3 A3 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_16 A1 Figure 7-59. CK Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices Rtt = AT Vtt AS A3 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_17 Figure 7-60. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices 7.9.2.13.3 One DDR3 Device A single DDR3 device is supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of one x16 DDR3 device arranged as one bank (CS), 16 bits wide. 7.9.2.13.3.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, One DDR3 Device Figure 7-61 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 7-62 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. 268 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DDR Differential CK Input Buffer AS+ AS- + – Clock Parallel Terminator DDR_1V5 Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 AT Cac + – 0.1 µF Rcp A1 A2 AT Routed as Differential Pair SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_18 Figure 7-61. CK Topology for One DDR3 Device AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A2 Address and Control Terminator Rtt AT Vtt SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_19 Figure 7-62. ADDR_CTRL Topology for One DDR3 Device 7.9.2.13.3.2 CK and ADDR/CTRL Routing, One DDR3 Device Figure 7-63 shows the CK routing for one DDR3 device placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 7-64 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 269 DM505 www.ti.com A1 A1 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 DDR_1V5 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT = AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_20 A1 Figure 7-63. CK Routing for One DDR3 Device Rtt AT = Vtt AS A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_21 Figure 7-64. ADDR_CTRL Routing for One DDR3 Device 7.9.2.14 Data Topologies and Routing Definition No matter the number of DDR3 devices used, the data line topology is always point to point, so its definition is simple. Care should be taken to minimize layer transitions during routing. If a layer transition is necessary, it is better to transition to a layer using the same reference plane. If this cannot be accommodated, ensure there are nearby ground vias to allow the return currents to transition between reference planes if both reference planes are ground or vdds_ddr. Ensure there are nearby bypass capacitors to allow the return currents to transition between reference planes if one of the reference planes is ground. The goal is to minimize the size of the return current loops. 270 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.9.2.14.1 DQS and DQ/DM Topologies, Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices DQS lines are point-to-point differential, and DQ/DM lines are point-to-point singled ended. Figure 7-65 and Figure 7-66 show these topologies. Processor DQS IO Buffer DDR DQS IO Buffer DQSn+ DQSnRouted Differentially n = 0, 1, 2, 3 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_22 Figure 7-65. DQS Topology Processor DQ and DM IO Buffer DDR DQ and DM IO Buffer Dn n = 0, 1, 2, 3 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_23 Figure 7-66. DQ/DM Topology 7.9.2.14.2 DQS and DQ/DM Routing, Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Figure 7-67 and Figure 7-68 show the DQS and DQ/DM routing. DQSn+ DQSn- DQS Routed Differentially n = 0, 1, 2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_24 Figure 7-67. DQS Routing With Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 271 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Dn DQ and DM n = 0, 1, 2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_25 Figure 7-68. DQ/DM Routing With Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices 7.9.2.15 Routing Specification 7.9.2.15.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification Skew within the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes directly reduces setup and hold margin and, thus, this skew must be controlled. The only way to practically match lengths on a PCB is to lengthen the shorter traces up to the length of the longest net in the net class and its associated clock. A metric to establish this maximum length is Manhattan distance. The Manhattan distance between two points on a PCB is the length between the points when connecting them only with horizontal or vertical segments. A reasonable trace route length is to within a percentage of its Manhattan distance. CACLM is defined as Clock Address Control Longest Manhattan distance. Given the clock and address pin locations on the processor and the DDR3 memories, the maximum possible Manhattan distance can be determined given the placement. Figure 7-69 and Figure 7-70 show this distance for three loads and two loads, respectively. It is from this distance that the specifications on the lengths of the transmission lines for the address bus are determined. CACLM is determined similarly for other address bus configurations; that is, it is based on the longest net of the CK/ADDR_CTRL net class. For CK and ADDR_CTRL routing, these specifications are contained in Table 7-44. 272 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 (A) A1 A8 CACLMY CACLMX A8 (A) A8 (A) A8 (A) Rtt A3 = A4 AT Vtt AS A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_26 A. It is very likely that the longest CK/ADDR_CTRL Manhattan distance will be for Address Input 8 (A8) on the DDR3 memories. CACLM is based on the longest Manhattan distance due to the device placement. Verify the net class that satisfies this criteria and use as the baseline for CK/ADDR_CTRL skew matching and length control. The length of shorter CK/ADDR_CTRL stubs as well as the length of the terminator stub are not included in this length calculation. Non-included lengths are grayed out in the figure. Assuming A8 is the longest, CALM = CACLMY + CACLMX + 300 mils. The extra 300 mils allows for routing down lower than the DDR3 memories and returning up to reach A8. Figure 7-69. CACLM for Three Address Loads on One Side of PCB Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 273 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com (A) A1 A8 CACLMY CACLMX A8 (A) A8 (A) Rtt A3 = AT Vtt AS A2 SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_27 A. It is very likely that the longest CK/ADDR_CTRL Manhattan distance will be for Address Input 8 (A8) on the DDR3 memories. CACLM is based on the longest Manhattan distance due to the device placement. Verify the net class that satisfies this criteria and use as the baseline for CK/ADDR_CTRL skew matching and length control. The length of shorter CK/ADDR_CTRL stubs as well as the length of the terminator stub are not included in this length calculation. Non-included lengths are grayed out in the figure. Assuming A8 is the longest, CALM = CACLMY + CACLMX + 300 mils. The extra 300 mils allows for routing down lower than the DDR3 memories and returning up to reach A8. Figure 7-70. CACLM for Two Address Loads on One Side of PCB Table 7-44. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification(2)(3) NO. PARAMETER MIN TYP MAX (1) UNIT CARS31 A1+A2 length 500 ps CARS32 A1+A2 skew 29 ps CARS33 A3 length 125 ps CARS34 (4) A3 skew 6 ps CARS35 A3 skew(5) 6 ps CARS36 A4 length 125 ps CARS37 A4 skew 6 ps ps CARS38 AS length 5 CARS39 AS skew 1.3 14(1) ps CARS310 AS+/AS- length 5 12 ps CARS311 AS+/AS- skew 1 ps CARS312 AT length(6) 75 ps CARS313 AT skew(7) 14 ps CARS314 (8) AT skew CARS315 CK/ADDR_CTRL trace length CARS316 Vias per trace CARS317 Via count difference 1 (9) CARS318 Center-to-center CK to other DDR3 trace spacing CARS319 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other DDR3 trace spacing(9)(10) 4w CARS320 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing(9) 3w 274 17 (1) Applications, Implementation, and Layout ps 1020 ps 3(1) vias 1(15) vias 4w Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 7-44. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification(2)(3) (continued) NO. PARAMETER CARS321 CK center-to-center spacing(11)(12) CARS322 CK spacing to other net(9) CARS323 Rcp(13) CARS324 Rtt(13)(14) MIN TYP MAX UNIT Zo-1 Zo Zo+1 Ω Zo-5 Zo Zo+5 Ω 4w (1) Max value is based upon conservative signal integrity approach. This value could be extended only if detailed signal integrity analysis of rise time and fall time confirms desired operation. (2) The use of vias should be minimized. (3) Additional bypass capacitors are required when using the DDR_1V5 plane as the reference plane to allow the return current to jump between the DDR_1V5 plane and the ground plane when the net class switches layers at a via. (4) Non-mirrored configuration (all DDR3 memories on same side of PCB). (5) Mirrored configuration (one DDR3 device on top of the board and one DDR3 device on the bottom). (6) While this length can be increased for convenience, its length should be minimized. (7) ADDR_CTRL net class only (not CK net class). Minimizing this skew is recommended, but not required. (8) CK net class only. (9) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (2w) for up to 1250 mils of routed length. (10) The ADDR_CTRL net class of the other DDR EMIF is considered other DDR3 trace spacing. (11) CK spacing set to ensure proper differential impedance. (12) The most important thing to do is control the impedance so inadvertent impedance mismatches are not created. Generally speaking, center-to-center spacing should be either 2w or slightly larger than 2w to achieve a differential impedance equal to twice the singleended impedance, Zo. (13) Source termination (series resistor at driver) is specifically not allowed. (14) Termination values should be uniform across the net class. (15) Via count difference may increase by 1 only if accurate 3-D modeling of the signal flight times – including accurately modeled signal propagation through vias – has been applied to ensure all segment skew maximums are not exceeded. 7.9.2.15.2 DQS and DQ Routing Specification Skew within the DQS and DQ/DM net classes directly reduces setup and hold margin and thus this skew must be controlled. The only way to practically match lengths on a PCB is to lengthen the shorter traces up to the length of the longest net in the net class and its associated clock. As with CK and ADDR_CTRL, a reasonable trace route length is to within a percentage of its Manhattan distance. DQLMn is defined as DQ Longest Manhattan distance n, where n is the byte number. For a 32-bit interface, there are three DQLMs, DQLM0-DQLM2. Likewise, for a 16-bit interface, there are two DQLMs, DQLM0-DQLM1. NOTE It is not required, nor is it recommended, to match the lengths across all bytes. Length matching is only required within each byte. Given the DQS and DQ/DM pin locations on the processor and the DDR3 memories, the maximum possible Manhattan distance can be determined given the placement. Figure 7-71 shows this distance for four loads. It is from this distance that the specifications on the lengths of the transmission lines for the data bus are determined. For DQS and DQ/DM routing, these specifications are contained in Table 7-45. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 275 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com DQLMX0 DB0 DB1 DQ[0:7]/DM0/DQS0 DQ[8:15]/DM1/DQS1 DQLMX1 DQ[16:23]/DM2/DQS2 DB2 DQLMY0 DQLMX2 DQLMY1 DQLMY2 2 1 0 DB0 - DB2 represent data bytes 0 - 2. SPRS91v_PCB_DDR3_28 There are three DQLMs, one for each byte (32-bit interface). Each DQLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the byte; therefore: DQLM0 = DQLMX0 + DQLMY0 DQLM1 = DQLMX1 + DQLMY1 DQLM2 = DQLMX2 + DQLMY2 Figure 7-71. DQLM for Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Table 7-45. Data Routing Specification(2) MAX UNIT DRS31 NO. DB0 length PARAMETER MIN 340 ps DRS32 DB1 length 340 ps DRS33 DB2 length 340 ps DRS35 DBn skew(3) 5 ps DRS36 DQSn+ to DQSn- skew 1 ps DRS37 DQSn to DBn skew(3)(4) 5(10) ps DRS38 Vias per trace 2(1) vias DRS39 Via count difference 0(10) vias (6) DRS310 Center-to-center DBn to other DDR3 trace spacing DRS311 Center-to-center DBn to other DBn trace spacing (7) DRS312 DQSn center-to-center spacing(8)(9) DRS313 DQSn center-to-center spacing to other net TYP 4 w(5) 3 w(5) 4 w(5) (1) Max value is based upon conservative signal integrity approach. This value could be extended only if detailed signal integrity analysis of rise time and fall time confirms desired operation. (2) External termination disallowed. Data termination should use built-in ODT functionality. (3) Length matching is only done within a byte. Length matching across bytes is neither required nor recommended. (4) Each DQS pair is length matched to its associated byte. (5) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (2w) for up to 1250 mils of routed length. (6) Other DDR3 trace spacing means other DDR3 net classes not within the byte. (7) This applies to spacing within the net classes of a byte. (8) DQS pair spacing is set to ensure proper differential impedance. (9) The most important thing to do is control the impedance so inadvertent impedance mismatches are not created. Generally speaking, center-to-center spacing should be either 2w or slightly larger than 2w to achieve a differential impedance equal to twice the singleended impedance, Zo. (10) Via count difference may increase by 1 only if accurate 3-D modeling of the signal flight times – including accurately modeled signal propagation through vias – has been applied to ensure DBn skew and DQSn to DBn skew maximums are not exceeded. 276 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 7.10 CVIDEO/SD-DAC Guidelines and Electrical Data/Timing The device's analog video CVIDEO/SD-DAC TV analog composite output can be operate in one of two modes: Normal mode and TVOUT Bypass mode. In Normal mode, the device’s internal video amplifier is used. In TVOUT Bypass mode, the internal video amplifier is bypassed and an external amplifier is required. Figure 7-72 shows a typical circuit that permits connecting the analog video output from the device to standard 75-Ω impedance video systems in Normal mode. Reconstruction (A) Filter ~9.5 MHz cvideo_tvout CAC (B) ROUT cvideo_vfb A. B. Reconstruction Filter (optional) AC coupling capacitor (optional) Figure 7-72. TV Output (Normal Mode) Figure 7-73 shows a typical circuit that permits connecting the analog video output from the device to standard 75-Ω impedance video systems in TVOUT Bypass mode. Reconstruction (A) Filter ~9.5 MHz cvideo_vfb Amplifier 3.7 V/V 75 W CAC (B) RLOAD A. B. Reconstruction Filter (optional). Note: An amplifier with an integrated reconstruction filter can alternatively be used instead of a discrete reconstruction filter. AC coupling capacitor (optional) Figure 7-73. TV Output (TVOUT Bypass Mode) During board design, the onboard traces and parasitics must be matched for the channel. The video DAC output pins (cvideo_tvout / cvideo_vfb) are very high-frequency analog signals and must be routed with extreme care. As a result, the paths of these signals must be as short as possible, and as isolated as possible from other interfering signals. In TVOUT Bypass mode, the load resistor and amplifier/buffer should be placed as close as possible to the cvideo_vfb pin. Other layout guidelines include: • Take special care to bypass the vdda_dac power supply pin with a capacitor. • In TVOUT Bypass mode, place the RLOAD resistor as close as possible to the Reconstruction Filter and Amplifier. In addition, place the 75-Ω resistor as close as possible (< 0.5 inch) to the Amplifier/buffer output pin. To maintain a high-quality video signal, the onboard traces after the 75-Ω resistor should have a characteristic impedance of 75 Ω (± 20%). • In Normal mode,cvideo_vfb is the most sensitive pin in the TV out system. The ROUT resistor should be placed as close as possible to the device pins. To maintain a high-quality video signal, the onboard traces leading to the cvideo_tvout pin should have a characteristic impedance of 75 Ω (± 20%) starting from the closest possible place to the device pin output. • Minimize input trace lengths to the device to reduce parasitic capacitance. • Include solid ground return paths. • Match trace lengths as close as possible within a video format group. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 277 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com Table 7-46 and Table 7-47 present the Static and Dynamic CVIDEO / SD-DAC TV analog composite output specifications Table 7-46. Static CVIDEO/SD-DAC Specifications MIN TYP MAX UNIT Reference Current Setting Resistor (RSET) PARAMETER Normal Mode TEST CONDITIONS 4653 4700 4747 Ω TVOUT Bypass Mode 9900 10000 10100 Ω Output resistor between cvideo_tvout and cvideo_vfb pins (ROUT) Normal Mode 2673 2700 2727 Ω Load Resistor (RLOAD) Normal Mode TVOUT Bypass Mode N/A 75-Ω Inside the Display TVOUT Bypass Mode 1485 AC-Coupling Capacitor (Optional) [CAC] Normal Mode 220 Total Capacitance from cvideo_tvout to vssa_dac Normal Mode TVOUT Bypass Mode 1500 1515 See External Amplifier Specification TVOUT Bypass Mode 300 pF 4 LSB N/A Resolution 10 Integral Non-Linearity (INL), Best Fit Normal Mode Differential Non-Linearity (DNL) Normal Mode TVOUT Bypass Mode Full-Scale Output Voltage Full-Scale Output Current -1 1 LSB -2.5 2.5 LSB -1 1 LSB Normal Mode (RLOAD = 75 Ω) 1.3 V TVOUT Bypass Mode (RLOAD = 1.5 kΩ) 0.7 V 470 uA Normal Mode N/A TVOUT Bypass Mode Gain Error Gain Mismatch (Luma-to-Chroma) Normal Mode (Composite) and TVOUT Bypass Mode -10 Normal Mode (S-Video) -20 Normal Mode (Composite) Normal Mode (S-Video) Output Impedance Bits -4 TVOUT Bypass Mode Ω uF 10 %FS 20 %FS 10 % N/A -10 Looking into cvideo_tvout nodes 75 Ω Table 7-47. Dynamic CVIDEO/SD-DAC Specifications PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN Output Update Rate (FCLK) TYP MAX UNIT 54 60 MHz Signal Bandwidth 3 dB 6 MHz Spurious-Free Dynamic Range (SFDR) within bandwidth FCLK = 54 MHz, FOUT = 1 MHz 50 dBc Signal-to-Noise Ration (SNR) FCLK = 54 MHz, FOUT = 1 MHz 54 dB Normal Mode, 100 mVpp @ 6 MHz on vdda_dac 6 TVOUT Bypass Mode, 100 mVpp @ 6 MHz on vdda_dac 20 Power Supply Rejection (PSR) 278 Applications, Implementation, and Layout dB Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 8 Device and Documentation Support TI offers an extensive line of development tools, including tools to evaluate the performance of the processors, generate code, develop algorithm implementations, and fully integrate and debug software and hardware modules are listed below. 8.1 Device Nomenclature To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers of all microprocessors (MPUs) and support tools. Each device has one of three prefixes: X, P, or null (no prefix) (for example, DM50x). Texas Instruments recommends two of three possible prefix designators for its support tools: TMDX and TMDS. These prefixes represent evolutionary stages of product development from engineering prototypes (TMDX) through fully qualified production devices and tools (TMDS). Device development evolutionary flow: X Experimental device that is not necessarily representative of the final device's electrical specifications and may not use production assembly flow. P Prototype device that is not necessarily the final silicon die and may not necessarily meet final electrical specifications. null Production version of the silicon die that is fully qualified. Support tool development evolutionary flow: TMDX Development-support product that has not yet completed Texas Instruments internal qualification testing. TMDS Fully-qualified development-support product. X and P devices and TMDX development-support tools are shipped against the following disclaimer: "Developmental product is intended for internal evaluation purposes." Production devices and TMDS development-support tools have been characterized fully, and the quality and reliability of the device have been demonstrated fully. TI's standard warranty applies. Predictions show that prototype devices (X or P) have a greater failure rate than the standard production devices. Texas Instruments recommends that these devices not be used in any production system because their expected end-use failure rate still is undefined. Only qualified production devices are to be used. For orderable part numbers of DM50x devices in the ABF package type, see the Package Option Addendum of this document, the TI website (www.ti.com), or contact your TI sales representative. For additional description of the device nomenclature markings on the die, see the Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ443). Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 279 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 8.1.1 www.ti.com Standard Package Symbolization aBBBBBtzrYPPP XXXXXXX YYY PIN ONE INDICATOR ZZZ G1 O SPRS916_PACK_01 Figure 8-1. Printed Device Reference NOTE Some devices have a cosmetic circular marking visible on the top of the device package which results from the production test process. These markings are cosmetic only with no reliability impact. 8.1.2 Device Naming Convention Table 8-1. Nomenclature Description FIELD PARAMETER a BBBBB t z FIELD DESCRIPTION Device evolution stage Base production part number Device Tier Device Speed VALUES X Prototype P Preproduction (production test flow, no reliability data) BLANK Production DM505 External DDR device DM504 POP Memory device S Super M Mid L Low B Indicates the speed grade for each of the cores in the device. For more information see Section 3.1, Device Comparison Table and Table 5-1, Speed Grade Maximum Frequency R r Y 280 Device revision Device type DESCRIPTION BLANK SR 1.0 A SR 1.0A B SR 2.0 BLANK Standard devices E Emulation (E) devices J JTAG lock & random key devices Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 Table 8-1. Nomenclature Description (continued) FIELD PARAMETER FIELD DESCRIPTION VALUES D PPP c Package designator Carrier designator ABF BLANK R XXXXXXX DESCRIPTION Secured devices ABF S-PBGA-N367 (15mm x 15mm) Package Tray Tape & Reel Lot Trace Code YYY Production Code, For TI use only ZZZ Production Code, For TI use only O Pin one designator G1 ECAT—Green package designator (1) To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers. These prefixes represent evolutionary stages of product development from engineering prototypes through fully qualified production devices. Prototype devices are shipped against the following disclaimer: “This product is still in development and is intended for internal evaluation purposes.” Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary, TI makes no warranty expressed, implied, or statutory, including any implied warranty of merchantability of fitness for a specific purpose, of this device. NOTE BLANK in the symbol or part number is collapsed so there are no gaps between characters. 8.2 Tools and Software The following products support development for DM50x platforms: Development Tools DM50x Clock Tree Tool is an interactive clock tree configuration software that allows the user to visualize the device clock tree, interact with clock tree elements and view the effect on PRCM registers, interact with the PRCM registers and view the effect on the device clock tree, and view a trace of all the device registers affected by the user interaction with the clock tree. DM50x Register Descriptor Tool is an interactive device register configuration tool that allows users to visualize the register state on power-on reset, and then customize the configuration of the device for the specific use-case. DM50x Pad Configuration Tool is an interactive pad-configuration tool that allows the user to visualize the device pad configuration state on power-on reset and then customize the configuration of the pads for the specific use-case and identify the device register settings associated to that configuration. For a complete listing of development-support tools for the processor platform, visit the Texas Instruments website at www.ti.com. For information on pricing and availability, contact the nearest TI field sales office or authorized distributor. 8.3 Documentation Support The following documents describe the DM50x devices. TRM DM50x SoC for Vision Analytics Technical Reference Manual Details the integration, the environment, the functional description, and the programming models for each peripheral and subsystem in the DM50x family of devices. Errata DM50x Silicon Errata Describes known advisories, limitations, and cautions on silicon and provides workarounds. Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 281 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 8.3.1 www.ti.com FCC Warning This equipment is intended for use in a laboratory test environment only. It generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and has not been tested for compliance with the limits of computing devices pursuant to subpart J of part 15 of FCC rules, which are designed to provide reasonable protection against radio frequency interference. Operation of this equipment in other environments may cause interference with radio communications, in which case the user at his own expense will be required to take whatever measures may be required to correct this interference. 8.3.2 Information About Cautions and Warnings This book may contain cautions and warnings. CAUTION This is an example of a caution statement. A caution statement describes a situation that could potentially damage your software or equipment. WARNING This is an example of a warning statement. A warning statement describes a situation that could potentially cause harm to you. The information in a caution or a warning is provided for your protection. Please read each caution and warning carefully. 8.4 Receiving Notification of Documentation Updates To receive notification of documentation updates — including silicon errata — go to the product folder for your device on ti.com. In the upper right-hand corner, click the "Alert me" button. This registers you to receive a weekly digest of product information that has changed (if any). For change details, check the revision history of any revised document. 8.5 Community Resources The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views; see TI's Terms of Use. TI Embedded Processors Wiki Texas Instruments Embedded Processors Wiki. Established to help developers get started with Embedded Processors from Texas Instruments and to foster innovation and growth of general knowledge about the hardware and software surrounding these devices. 8.6 Trademarks C64x and ICEPick are trademarks of Texas Instruments Incorporated. ARM, Thumb, and Cortex are registered trademarks of ARM Limited. CoreSight is a trademark of ARM Limited. QSPI is a trademark of Cadence Design Systems, Inc. SD is a registered trademark of Toshiba Corporation. 282 Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback DM505 www.ti.com SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 MMC and eMMC are trademarks of MultiMediaCard Association. JTAG is a registered trademark of JTAG Technologies, Inc. MIPI is registered trademarks of the Mobile Industry Processor Interface (MIPI) Alliance. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. 8.7 Electrostatic Discharge Caution This integrated circuit can be damaged by ESD. Texas Instruments recommends that all integrated circuits be handled with appropriate precautions. Failure to observe proper handling and installation procedures can cause damage. ESD damage can range from subtle performance degradation to complete device failure. Precision integrated circuits may be more susceptible to damage because very small parametric changes could cause the device not to meet its published specifications. 8.8 Export Control Notice Recipient agrees to not knowingly export or re-export, directly or indirectly, any product or technical data (as defined by the U.S., EU, and other Export Administration Regulations) including software, or any controlled product restricted by other applicable national regulations, received from disclosing party under nondisclosure obligations (if any), or any direct product of such technology, to any destination to which such export or re-export is restricted or prohibited by U.S. or other applicable laws, without obtaining prior authorization from U.S. Department of Commerce and other competent Government authorities to the extent required by those laws. 8.9 Glossary TI Glossary This glossary lists and explains terms, acronyms, and definitions. Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 283 DM505 SPRS976D – NOVEMBER 2016 – REVISED JULY 2017 www.ti.com 9 Mechanical Packaging Information The following pages include mechanical packaging information. This information is the most current data available for the designated devices. This data is subject to change without notice and revision of this document. For browser-based versions of this data sheet, refer to the left-hand navigation. 9.1 Mechanical Data 284 Mechanical Packaging Information Copyright © 2016–2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 14-Jul-2017 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Pins Package Drawing Qty Eco Plan Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (2) (6) (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) DM505LRBABF PREVIEW FCBGA ABF 367 1000 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 125 DM505LRBABFR PREVIEW FCBGA ABF 367 1000 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 125 DM505MRABF PREVIEW FCBGA ABF 367 90 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 125 DM505MRABFR PREVIEW FCBGA ABF 367 1000 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 125 XDM505XXBABF ACTIVE FCBGA ABF 367 1 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 125 (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) RoHS: TI defines "RoHS" to mean semiconductor products that are compliant with the current EU RoHS requirements for all 10 RoHS substances, including the requirement that RoHS substance do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, "RoHS" products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. TI may reference these types of products as "Pb-Free". RoHS Exempt: TI defines "RoHS Exempt" to mean products that contain lead but are compliant with EU RoHS pursuant to a specific EU RoHS exemption. Green: TI defines "Green" to mean the content of Chlorine (Cl) and Bromine (Br) based flame retardants meet JS709B low halogen requirements of <=1000ppm threshold. Antimony trioxide based flame retardants must also meet the <=1000ppm threshold requirement. (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. Addendum-Page 1 Samples PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 14-Jul-2017 In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. Addendum-Page 2 PACKAGE OUTLINE ABF0367A FCBGA - 2.82 mm max height SCALE 0.900 BALL GRID ARRAY 15.2 14.8 A B BALL A1 CORNER ( 12) 15.2 14.8 ( 10) (1.3) (2.39) 0.25 C C 2.82 MAX (0.99) 0.4 TYP 0.2 AB Y V T P M K H 0.15 0.08 0.1 C 13.65 TYP SYMM 0.65 TYP 0.45 367X 0.35 C A B C NOTE 3 SEATING PLANE NOTE 4 BALL TYP F D B (0.68) TYP (0.68) TYP AA W U R N SYMM 13.65 TYP L J G E C A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 0.65 TYP 4221430/B 06/2014 NOTES: 1. All linear dimensions are in millimeters. Any dimensions in parenthesis are for reference only. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M. 2. This drawing is subject to change without notice. 3. Dimension is measured at the maximum solder ball diameter, parallel to primary datum C. 4. Primary datum C and seating plane are defined by the spherical crown of the solder balls. www.ti.com EXAMPLE BOARD LAYOUT ABF0367A FCBGA - 2.82 mm max height BALL GRID ARRAY (0.65) TYP 1 2 (0.65) TYP 367X 0.365 0.335 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 A B C D E F G H J K L M N P R T U V W Y AA AB SYMM SYMM LAND PATTERN EXAMPLE SCALE:6X ( 0.35) METAL 0.05 MAX METAL UNDER MASK 0.05 MIN ( 0.35) SOLDER MASK OPENING SOLDER MASK OPENING NON-SOLDER MASK DEFINED (PREFERRED) SOLDER MASK DEFINED SOLDER MASK DETAILS NOT TO SCALE 4221430/B 06/2014 NOTES: (continued) 5. Final dimensions may vary due to manufacturing tolerance considerations and also routing constraints. For more information, see Texas Instruments literature number SPRU811 (www.ti.com/lit/spru811). www.ti.com EXAMPLE STENCIL DESIGN ABF0367A FCBGA - 2.82 mm max height BALL GRID ARRAY (0.65) TYP 1 2 (0.65) TYP 362X 0.365 0.335 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 A B C D E F G H J K L M N P R T U V W Y AA AB SYMM SYMM SOLDER PASTE EXAMPLE BASED ON 0.125 mm THICK STENCIL SCALE:6X 4221430/B 06/2014 NOTES: (continued) 6. Laser cutting apertures with trapezoidal walls and rounded corners may offer better paste release. www.ti.com IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated (TI) reserves the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. TI’s published terms of sale for semiconductor products (http://www.ti.com/sc/docs/stdterms.htm) apply to the sale of packaged integrated circuit products that TI has qualified and released to market. Additional terms may apply to the use or sale of other types of TI products and services. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such reproduced documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI products or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that product or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI product or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyers and others who are developing systems that incorporate TI products (collectively, “Designers”) understand and agree that Designers remain responsible for using their independent analysis, evaluation and judgment in designing their applications and that Designers have full and exclusive responsibility to assure the safety of Designers' applications and compliance of their applications (and of all TI products used in or for Designers’ applications) with all applicable regulations, laws and other applicable requirements. Designer represents that, with respect to their applications, Designer has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards that (1) anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, (2) monitor failures and their consequences, and (3) lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate actions. Designer agrees that prior to using or distributing any applications that include TI products, Designer will thoroughly test such applications and the functionality of such TI products as used in such applications. TI’s provision of technical, application or other design advice, quality characterization, reliability data or other services or information, including, but not limited to, reference designs and materials relating to evaluation modules, (collectively, “TI Resources”) are intended to assist designers who are developing applications that incorporate TI products; by downloading, accessing or using TI Resources in any way, Designer (individually or, if Designer is acting on behalf of a company, Designer’s company) agrees to use any particular TI Resource solely for this purpose and subject to the terms of this Notice. TI’s provision of TI Resources does not expand or otherwise alter TI’s applicable published warranties or warranty disclaimers for TI products, and no additional obligations or liabilities arise from TI providing such TI Resources. TI reserves the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its TI Resources. TI has not conducted any testing other than that specifically described in the published documentation for a particular TI Resource. Designer is authorized to use, copy and modify any individual TI Resource only in connection with the development of applications that include the TI product(s) identified in such TI Resource. NO OTHER LICENSE, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, BY ESTOPPEL OR OTHERWISE TO ANY OTHER TI INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT, AND NO LICENSE TO ANY TECHNOLOGY OR INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT OF TI OR ANY THIRD PARTY IS GRANTED HEREIN, including but not limited to any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI products or services are used. Information regarding or referencing third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services, or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of TI Resources may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. TI RESOURCES ARE PROVIDED “AS IS” AND WITH ALL FAULTS. TI DISCLAIMS ALL OTHER WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, REGARDING RESOURCES OR USE THEREOF, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS, TITLE, ANY EPIDEMIC FAILURE WARRANTY AND ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF ANY THIRD PARTY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS. TI SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR AND SHALL NOT DEFEND OR INDEMNIFY DESIGNER AGAINST ANY CLAIM, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY INFRINGEMENT CLAIM THAT RELATES TO OR IS BASED ON ANY COMBINATION OF PRODUCTS EVEN IF DESCRIBED IN TI RESOURCES OR OTHERWISE. IN NO EVENT SHALL TI BE LIABLE FOR ANY ACTUAL, DIRECT, SPECIAL, COLLATERAL, INDIRECT, PUNITIVE, INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES IN CONNECTION WITH OR ARISING OUT OF TI RESOURCES OR USE THEREOF, AND REGARDLESS OF WHETHER TI HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Unless TI has explicitly designated an individual product as meeting the requirements of a particular industry standard (e.g., ISO/TS 16949 and ISO 26262), TI is not responsible for any failure to meet such industry standard requirements. Where TI specifically promotes products as facilitating functional safety or as compliant with industry functional safety standards, such products are intended to help enable customers to design and create their own applications that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Using products in an application does not by itself establish any safety features in the application. Designers must ensure compliance with safety-related requirements and standards applicable to their applications. Designer may not use any TI products in life-critical medical equipment unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special contract specifically governing such use. Life-critical medical equipment is medical equipment where failure of such equipment would cause serious bodily injury or death (e.g., life support, pacemakers, defibrillators, heart pumps, neurostimulators, and implantables). Such equipment includes, without limitation, all medical devices identified by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration as Class III devices and equivalent classifications outside the U.S. TI may expressly designate certain products as completing a particular qualification (e.g., Q100, Military Grade, or Enhanced Product). Designers agree that it has the necessary expertise to select the product with the appropriate qualification designation for their applications and that proper product selection is at Designers’ own risk. Designers are solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such selection. Designer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages, costs, losses, and/or liabilities arising out of Designer’s noncompliance with the terms and provisions of this Notice. Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2017, Texas Instruments Incorporated